Uploaded by Fernando Benedette

Elitefts ptw

advertisement
POWERLIFTING  STRONGMAN  BODYBUILDING  NUTRITION  SPORTS TRAINING
LIVE. LEARN. PASS ON
PROGRAMS
THAT WORK
DECEMBER 2014 FOURTH EDITION BOOK 2
L
A
T
U
R
B WER
PO
ULL,
IF T P
L
D
A
E
FUL D
S,
R
E
W
FL AW
PO
G
H
A
C
P
N
E
NDIN
LO
B
E
E
B
V
R
E
U
R
D
YO
BA
WITH
COME
R
D
E
R
V
A
O
TS
PW
SQUA
ODE U
G
L
N
P
I
X
K
E
RE A
RD-B
O
C
E
R
DRIVE UP YOUR
TOTAL IN
POWERLIFTING
WRESTLING, SOFTBALL, FOOTBALL,
THROWING, CROSSFIT, ICE HOCKEY
PAGE 74
BUILD MAXIMUM
LEAN MUSCLE MASS
BEN HARTMAN ON ARM SPECIALIZATION
ALWYN COSGROVE’S 12-WEEK FAT LOSS
AMIT SAPIR’S MASS BUILDING TRAINING
PAGE 34
ACHIEVE SPORTS
MASTERY
LIFT TO MAKE
A DIFFERENCE
ALL PROCEEDS OF THESE BOOKS BENEFITS
MAKE-A-WISH FOUNDATION OHIO, KENTUCKY, INDIANA
FOOTBALL | HIGHLAND GAMES | OLYMPIC LIFTING
WRESTLING | STRONGMAN | ULTRA-MARATHON
FIGURE COMPETITION | THROWING | BASKETBALL
When your baby is diagnosed with cancer – life changes. Suddenly you are confronted with
the possibility that they won’t have ‘the rest of their lives’ to live out their hopes and dreams.
You hope and you pray that they will, but you are also confronted with the frailty of life in
a very real way. This is a rambling way of getting to my main point — how in the world do I
thank someone who gives her something that I couldn’t? I mean, if she wanted a webkinz,
I could and did get that for her. If she wanted pickles (or anything else for that matter!) at
11:30 p.m. in the hospital, her dad could and did do that. But for “Make-A Wish” to give her
the opportunity to think of one thing she would love to do in her lifetime and for elitefts™ to
offer such a huge donation to make that happen…there just are no words to fully express the
gratitude I have for them all. That is crazy love…I can’t think of another way to describe it.
Every one of them has a special place in my heart. I will never forget their kindness to a little
girl they had not even met when they agreed to give so generously.”
— Mother of a Wish Child
This was part of a letter elitefts received from the very first wish granted in 2008. I have kept this
quote on my phone even since. This one quote not only represents what Make-A-Wish® does,
but also what we do at elitefts.com. It was these common values that brought us together in
2007 and has solidified our relationship ever since.
This past year elitefts.com was presented with the Make-A-Wish, OH,
KY, IN Strength Award. This was in part for the 49 wishes we have helped
grant, the one wish we personally made come true, the hours of volunteer work, over a quarter of a million dollars donated and stepping up in
helping the chapter grow. When elitefts can partner with another organization and truly make a difference, that is something to be pound of.
Unlike most companies who donate to charities, elitefts doesn’t do
things in a selfish way, we truly do this as a team. The money that has
been raised has all been through work we do as staff, athletes, coaches,
columnists, and friends and then turned around and offered as seminars
and ebooks used to raise awareness and donations for Make-A-Wish®.
Your purchase of this manual completes the circle, involving everyone
that is a part of elitefts.com.
PLEASE suggest this manual and the others to everyone you know as
every cent made on these will go to granting even more wishes. You may not have realized this
when you purchased this manual but elitefts.com will not make one cent on these. All proceeds
will go to granting wishes.
As the mother above noted. There are no words we can use to express our
gratitude for you all, so I will end with another quote:
“From what we get, we can make a living; what we give, however,
makes a life.”
— Arthur Ashe
1 The Weekender by Dave Kirschen
2
Fourteen-week Training Program for NAS Strongman Nationals
by Chase Karnes
3
Prioritization Cycle for the Off-Season Bodybuilder
by Ben Hartman
4
5
6
7
Four-day General Athletic Training by Matt Foley
Grip Training by Eric Maroscher
Off-Season Basketball by Skyler Farley
Strength and Explosiveness in Six Weeks
by Marshall Johnson
6
9
13
16
20
26
32
Making Wishes
35
8
Basic Hypertrophy Training by Amit Sapir
36
9
Eight-week Olympic Weightlifting Cycle by Greg Everett
38
10 Beast Training College Football Preparation by Erik Eggers
43
11 Twelve-week Fat Loss Training by Alwyn Cosgrove
54
64
12 Knee Integrity: Building Better Knees by JL Holdsworth
13 Common Training Mistakes of Aspiring Female Competitors by
Alexander Cortez
67
14 Foundational Training by Mike Kozak
15 Creating a More Powerful You by Josh Bryant
16 Equipped Bench Circa-Max Phase by Vincent Dizenzo
71
75
84
Making Wishes
87
17 Off-Season Strength Program for Wrestling by Jerry Handley
88
18 Off-Season Speed and Agility for Football by
Nick Aloi and Mike Inman
96
19 The Stim-Method for Track and Field Athletes by Willie Danzer 98
20 The Knowledge Behind Programs that Work by James Smith
110
21 Shoulder-Blaster Program by Julia Ladewski
123
22 Perfecting Your Bench Work by Scott Yard
126
23 Strength Training Program for Ultra-Marathoners by Bill Allars 130
24 Advanced Powerlifting Training by Bryan Mann
135
25 Strongman Training for Old Dudes by Mark Watts
140
26 Block Periodization Program by Shane Church
144
Making Wishes
27 Summer Football Training by Ron McKeefery
146
147
28 Build Your Sumo and Conventional Deadlift by Casey Williams 149
29 Twelve-week Monkey Bar Progression by Sheena Leedham
152
30 How to Come Back from a Patellar Tendon Rupture
by Thomas E. Deebel
158
31 Twelve-week Peaking Template for Collegiate Throwers
by Nate Harvey
160
Making Wishes
167
32 Upgraded Movement: A Pre-Season Plan for the Football Athlete
by Brett Bartholomew
168
33 In-Season Squat Progression for a Traveling Football Team
by Ted Perlak
171
34 The Nerd Off-Season Program by Dan Fosselman
175
35 Contrarian Approach to Off-Season Highland Games Training
by Mark Valenti and Erin R. Stewart
180
36 The Tactical Preparedness Workout by Chris Smith
190
37 Six-week Weightlifter’s Program by Hank McDonald
196
38 Powerlifting Program by John Patrick
200
39 M2 Deadlift Program by Brian Schwab
202
The Weekender
Dave Kirschen
M
aintaining a powerlifting career for the long
haul is not easy. The training is physically and
mentally demanding, the time commitment
is significant, and injuries are a real and constant
threat. To top it all off, there is little, if any financial
reward for the vast majority of the athletes.
While some lifters are willing to prioritize their
training over all else, this is simply not a reality for
the majority, myself included. While most lifters excel
with somewhere between 3-5 training sessions per
week, outside commitments like work and family
that will make it difficult to maintain that pace year
in and year out. Sometimes, when life throws you
a curveball, the easiest thing to do is give yourself a
week or two off, take care of your priorities, and get
back to the grind whenever you can.
If you decide to have a couple of days in-between
training sessions, it really doesn’t matter which
session you perform first. If training on consecutive
days, keep the bench session first so your shoulders
aren’t already smoked from holding the squat bar.
Of course, you’re probably wondering if it’s possible
to make progress training so little, and I can say from
experience that it is. You probably won’t progress at
the same rate you would training 3-4 times per week,
but if time is scarce, it’s much better to program 2
days and make them all, then it is to miss workouts
and constantly have to re-adjust.
The Weekender isn’t so much a program geared for
progress as it is a way to exercise damage control
when life throws a curveball or two your way.
And for you veterans out there that are always beat
Other times, the distraction will take much longer up, you might even find that you progress faster
to address, requiring you to put your training on the on The Weekender because you’re still training
back-burner for months, if not years.
consistently, but beating yourself up less.
The weekender is a program I’ve used during
stretches of my life where I couldn’t devote a
ton of time to my training, but I still wanted to
stay consistent. It’s a two day a week, conjugate
periodization-based powerlifting program. I call it
the weekender program because while not optimal,
you could conceivably get all or your main lifting
done over the course of a weekend, then have the
rest of the week free to care of business.
Since this is a conjugate program, you can use any
max effort movements you want. If you want to use
this program to prepare for a meet, I would schedule
16 weeks of training, and wave the contest lifts from
85% to 95 % for the first 3 months, deload in week
4 of the final month, then compete in what would be
week 5.
7
The Weekender
elitelifts.
Volume 2
7
If not competing, repeat the previous 12 weeks,
trying to beat your previous bests in each of the max
effort movements. Keep your competition squat/
bench/DL numbers the same until you are able to
enter a meet and establish new prs on the contest
platform.
Dave Kirschen
speed or max-effort days.
Week 1
Day 1 – Max effort floor press – 3 rep max
Day 2 - Max effort Box squat – 3 rep max
Week 2
Day 1 - Max effort board press – 3 rep max
The assistance exercises are up to you. For your Day 2 - Max effort pin pull - 3 rep max
squat/DL sessions, the typical movements are back
extensions, glute-ham raises, straight leg deadlifts,
Week 3
cable pullthroughs, and abs
Day 1 - Speed bench 8 x 2 @ 45%
Day 2 - Speed squat (box) 8 x 2 @ 45%
For upper body, plenty of heavy rows, close grip
bench, dumbbell bench, pulldowns and triceps
Week 4
extensions.
For ideas on more assistance movements, check out Day 1 – competition style bench – 85% x 1
the elitefts.net Exercise index which goes into way Day 2 competition style squat and deadlift – 85% x 1
greater depth than I can here.
Week 1
Day 1 – Max effort bench (special exercise)
Day 2 - Max effort squat (special exercise)
Week 2
Day 1 - Max effort bench (special exercise)
Day 2 - Max effort deadlift (special exercise)
Week 3
Day 1 - Speed bench (45%-55%)
Day 2 - Speed squat (45% - 55%)
Week 4
Day 1 – competition style bench – 85% - 95%
Day 2 competition style squat/DL – 85% - 95%
Week 5
Day 1 – Max effort floor press – 1 rep max
Day 2 - Max effort Box squat – 1 rep max
Week 6
Day 1 - Max effort board press – 1 rep max
Day 2 - Max effort pin pull - 1 rep max
Week 7
Day 1 - Speed bench 8 x 2 @ 50%
Day 2 - Speed squat (box) 8 x 2 @ 50%
Week 8
Day 1 – competition style bench – 90% x 1
Day 2 competition style squat and deadlift – 90% x 1
Week 9
Then repeat, switching out the max effort exercises. Day 1 – Max effort floor press – 1 rep max (try to
Leave your contest lift percentages alone until you beat previous month’s pr).
Day 2 - Max effort Box squat – 1 rep max (try to beat
establish new prs at a meet.
previous month’s pr)
The following is a sample program so you can see
how it all works The max effort exercises can be
changed to any squat, goodmorning or deadlift
variation you want, based on what your needs are
and what tools are available to you. You may also use
whatever accommodating resistance you like on the
Week 10
Day 1 - Max effort board press – 1 rep max (try to
beat previous month’s pr)
Day 2 - Max effort pin pull - 1 rep max (try to beat
previous month’s pr)
8
The Weekender
elitelifts.
Volume 2
8
Week 11
Day 1 - Speed bench 8 x 2 @ 55%
Day 2 - Speed squat (box) 8 x 2 @ 55%
Week 12
Day 1 – competition style bench – 95% x 1
Day 2 competition style squat and deadlift – 95% x 1
As with any program, any extra or feeder workouts
you can fit in will be a huge plus. But this could be
as simple as a few band goodmornings or triceps
extensions a few times per week. If you have gym
access during the rest of the week, great. But if
not, you’ll still be able to either make progress, or
maintain as much as possible until you can get back
to your original schedule.
I should note once again, that the Weekender is by
no means an optimal program for most lifters due to
the low training frequency, but sometimes the best
program is the one that you can fit in your schedule
consistently.
So if you are at a place in your life/career where you
are unable to devote as much time as you’d like to
your training, give The Weekender a run. It might
just be the difference between training and not.
Dave Kirschen has been powerlifting competitively since 1998
and has since reached totals of 1901 in the 181-pound class and
1925 in the 198-pound class. He trains at Eastside Barbell Club
in Palisades Park, New Jersey, and currently manages a fitness
center in New York City. A lifelong fitness professional, he holds
a degree in physical education from SUNY Cortland and lives in
New Jersey with his wife Liz.
Dave Kirschen
Fourteen-week
Training Program for NAS Strongman
Nationals
Chase Karnes
B
elow is my program for the 2014 North
American Strongman Nationals where I’ll be
competing in the Middleweight 200 pound
class. The program is broken down into two 6 weeks
training phases with a deload week after the first
6 weeks and an off week after the second 6 weeks.
This makes for a 14 week long program.
The events for 2014 NAS Strongman Nationals
are:
Day 1:
Press Medley – 225# Keg, 275# Axle, 150# Circus Dumbbell. 1 rep on Keg, 1 rep on Axle, then
max reps on Circus DB. 1 minute time limit. Most
reps win.
Yoke – 700# - 60 ft. with a 60 second time limit.
Fastest time wins.
Carry Medley – 275# Keg for 60 ft., 275# Farmers
for 40 ft., 300# Duck Walk for 20 ft. 75 second time
limit. Fastest time wins.
Car Deadlift – Toyota Camry. Most reps in 1 minute
wins.
Day 2:
Giant Wheel Barrow Push – Push a 1650#
Wheelbarrow 60 ft. with a 60s time limit. Fastest
time wins.
Keg Carry & Load Over Bar – Carry a 225#, 250#
and 275# Keg 10 ft. each and load each over a 54
inch bar.
This program was designed with my strengths and
weaknesses in mind. These are factors I considered
for each event when programming for this
competition:
•
Pressing is one of my strongest events. The
weights are all submaximal for me. On this event I’ll
need to get through the first two implements as fast
as possible and then hit as many reps as possible on
the dumbbell. More than likely I’ll run out of time
before I run out of reps. The goal here is to work on
increasing my strength endurance on the dumbbell
without beating my shoulder to death. I’ll also work
on efficient viper technique of the keg and efficient
axle clean and press technique.
•
The name of the game for yoke is speed. The
weight is very doable for me, I just need to focus
on foot speed and perfecting my technique. I’ll be
working on some speed (dynamic effort) days along
with some heavier (max effort) days hitting 90101% of competition weight.
•
For the carry medley conditioning will be a
big factor. Grip strength is also going to be a factor
on the farmers and duck walk implements. Speed is
also key here and transitions between implements
must be fast and smooth.
•
The car deadlift is typically very heavy at
nationals. The goal here is to peak deadlift strength
while also pushing the squat and car deadlift
implement.
•
Giant wheelbarrow push will come down to
foot speed and grip strength. Since I don’t have this
Fourteen Week
10
implement I’ll let my foot speed work from farmers
and yoke carry me here along with adding some
direct support grip work.
On the keg carry and load it’ll come down
•
to the fastest time. The weights are very doable
and the height isn’t a problem to load to. The focus
here will be moving as fast as possible with smooth
transitions and no wasted steps.
•
NOTE: During phase #2 I was asked to compete
in England in a u90kg strongman competition put
on by the Strongman Champions League. The events
were similar to Nationals with the exception of a
max log press and a squat for reps event. Because of
this I did program log in and hit more rep work on
the back squat. The goal for the log was to peak in
strength, but I needed to keep the axle in my hands
some. In order to accomplish this I programmed a
peaking phase based on my estimated 1RM on log
and just ran those percentages alternating the log
and axle each week.
Chase Karnes
B1. Bench Press – 65% of training max for 3 sets of
5-10
B2. Machine Row – 5 sets of 10-15
C1. Support Grip Work
C2. Hanging Leg Raises – 3 sets of 12-15
Wednesday:
A. Deadlift Week 1: Work up to a training 5RM
Week 3: Work up to a training 3RM
Week 5: Work up to a training 1RM
B. Car Deadlift
Week 1: Work up to a heavy set of 5
Week 3: Work up to a heavy set of 5
Week 5: Work up to a heavy set of 5
C. Rollouts – 80-100 total reps
Thursday:
Keg/Duck Walk Medley – Carry each implement 50
ft.
Week 1: 250#/265# x 2
Week 3: 250#/300# x 2
Week 5: 275#/300# x 2
The training split is 14 days total rotating the entire
6 weeks. In regards to gym lifts Weeks 1, 3, 5 are
the same and weeks 2, 4, 6 are the same in terms
of exercise performed, but other variables change.
Week B. (Weeks 2, 4, 6)
Event days rotate on the same schedule.
Phase 1:
Saturday:
A. Keg Clean & Press – Work up to 230# for:
Week 2: 3x1
Week A. (Weeks 1, 3, 5)
Week 4: 4x1
Week 6: 5x1
Saturday:
B. Circus DB Clean & Press – Work up to % of training
A. Axle Clean & Press – 5/3/1
B. Keg Carry/Farmer Walk/Duck Walk Medley – max for max reps:
Week 2: 85% x As many as possible
Competition Distances
Week 4: 90% x As many as possible
Week 1: 250#/255#/265# x 2
Week 6: 95% x As many as possible
Week 3: 275#/275#/300# x 2
C. Yoke Walk – Competition distance - Work up to:
Week 5: 275#/295#/335# x 2
C. Speed Farmers Walk – Half competition distance. Week 2: 630#
Week 4: 700#
Percentages based off competition weight.
Week 6: 730#
Week 1: 65% x 5 runs w/1m rest
D. Keg Carry & Load Over Bar
Week 3: 70% x 5 runs w/1m rest
230#/250# x 1, 230#/250#/275# x 1
Week 5: 75% x 5 runs w/1m rest
Monday:
A. Strict Overhead – 5/3/1, followed by a training
5RM, 3RM and 1RM on their respective weeks.
Monday:
A. Bench Press – 5/3/1
B1. 1-Arm DB Strict Overhead Press – 3 sets of 8-12
Fourteen Week
B2. Chin Ups – 4 sets of 8-12
C1. Support Grip Work
C2. Hanging Leg Raises – 3 sets of 12-15
Wednesday:
A. Back Squat – 5/3/1
B. Safety Squat Bar Squat – 3 sets of 5-10
C. Rollouts – 80-100 total reps
Thursday:
A. Keg Carry & Load Over Bar
230#/250# x 1, 230#/250#/275# x 1
Deload Week 7
11
Chase Karnes
Week 1: 3x1
Week 3: 4x1
Week 5: 5x1
B. Circus DB Clean & Press –
Work up to % of training max (increased every 3
week wave) for max reps:
Week 1: 85% x As many as possible
Week 3: 95% x As many as possible
Week 5: 90% x As many as possible
C1. Incline Bench – 5/3/1
C1. 1-Arm DB Row – 3 sets of 20
D1. Support Grip Work
D2. Hanging Leg Raises – 3 sets of 12-15
Wednesday:
A. Deadlift – Percentages based off estimated 1RM
Week 1: 80%x3, 75% 3 sets of 3
Week 3: 85%x3, 80%x3
Week A. (Weeks 1, 3, 5)
Week 5: 90%x3, 85%x3
B. Back Squat – 5/3/1
Saturday:
A. Log Clean & Press - Percentage based off of C1. Rollouts – 80-100 total reps
estimated 1RM
C2. GHRs – 3 sets of 10
Week 1: 80%x1, 70% 3 sets of 8
Week 3: 85%x1, 75% 3 sets of 8
Thursday:
Week 5: 90%x1, 85% 3 sets of 3
Keg/Duck Walk Medley - Carry each implement 50
B. Keg Carry/Farmer Walk/Duck Walk Medley - ft.
Competition Distances
Week 1, 3, 5: 250#/300# x 2
Week 1: 250#/255#/265# x 2
Week 3: 275#/275#/300# x 2
Week B. (Weeks 2, 4, 6)
Week 5: 250#/255#/265# x 1, 275#/275#/300# x
Saturday:
1
A. Axle Clean & Press Percentage based off of
C. Speed Farmers Walk - Half competition distance.
estimated LOG 1RM
Percentages based off competition weight.
Week 2: 83%x1, 73% 3 sets of 8
Week 1: 65% x 5 runs w/1m rest
Week 4: 88%x1, 80% 3 sets of 5
Week 3: 70% x 5 runs w/1m rest
Week 6: 93%x1, 90% 2 sets of 2
Week 5: 75% x 5 runs w/1m rest
B. Yoke Walk – Competition Distance – Work up to
710 weeks 2, 4, 6.
Sunday:
C. Keg Carry & Load Over Bar – Competition distance
Prowler Sprints – 45 seconds work : 90 second rest and height.
Week 1: 4 rounds
230#/250#/275# x 2 runs
Week 3: 5 rounds
Sunday:
Week 5: 6 rounds
Prowler Sprints –
Week 2: 4 rounds
Monday:
Week 4: 5 rounds
A. Keg Clean & Press - Work up to 230# for:
Week 6: 6 rounds
Phase 2:
Fourteen Week
12
Monday:
A. Keg Clean & Press - Work up to 230# for:
Week 2: 3x1
Week 4: 4x1
Week 6: 5x1
B. Circus DB Clean & Press - Work up to % of training
max (increased every 3 week wave) for max reps:
Week 2: 90% x As many as possible
Week 4: 85% x As many as possible
Week 6: 95% x As many as possible
C1. Strict Overhead Press – 5/3/1
C2. Chin Ups – 3 sets of 10
D1. Support Grip Work
D2. Hanging Leg Raises – 3 sets of 12-15
Wednesday:
A. Deadlift Percentages based off estimated 1RM
Week 2: 83%x3, 75% 3 sets of 3
Week 4: 88%x3, 80%x3
Week 6: 70%x3
B. Car Deadlift
Week 2: Work up to a heavy set of 5-10
Week 4: Work up to a heavy set of 5-10
Week 6: Work up to a heavy set of 5-10
C1. Rollouts – 80-100 total reps
C2. GHRs – 3 sets of 10
Thursday:
A. Speed Yoke - Half competition distance.
Percentages based off competition weight.
Week 2: 65% x 5 runs w/1m rest
Week 4: 70% x 5 runs w/1m rest
Week 6: 75% x 5 runs w/1m rest
B. Keg Carry & Load Over Bar
230#/250#/275# x 2
Off Week 7
*Exercise with pairings are done as alternating sets
(Example: A1. And A2.). A set of A1. Is performed
followed by a short rest. Then A2. is performed
followed by a short rest. This is repeated until all
sets/reps are completed.
* Training rep max (Work up to a training 5RM for
example) is a heavy set of the respective prescribed
Chase Karnes
rep number without hitting failure or without a
major loss of form. Typically leaving some “in the
tank”.
Chase Karnes is a personal trainer/strength coach located in
Paducah, Kentucky. He holds a bachelor’s of science degree in
exercise science along with his CSCS and NSCA-CPT credentials.
Chase is also a national level Strongman competitor with a
second place finish at the NAS Strongman Nationals in 2012. He
can be reached through his website at www.chasekarnes.com.
Prioritization Cycle for the
Off-Season Bodybuilder
Ben Hartman
C
ompetitions are won in the offseason. Sure,
contest prep obviously plays a major role in
achieving that shredded, polished look on
stage, but real champions are built in the offseason.
I sometimes like to approach my offseason training
by focusing on periods of priority training for weak
body parts. By cycling these periods in and out in 4
week increments an athlete can make measurable,
noticeable gains as well as prevent overuse injuries
from training a body part too often, for too long. Over
the course of each block, progression is the name of
the game. Strive for more weight or reps and better
execution on each successive workout.
4 week: Arm prioritization
M - Quads (3), Hams (2), Calves (1)
-
Squat….ramping sets of 6 (6 @ 135, 185, 225, 275, etc.) until a top set of less than 6
reps
Hack Squat….1-2 warm-ups; 3 x 10
Leg Extension….3 x 20
RDL….ramping sets of 8
Seated Leg Curl….3 x 10
Donkey Calf….1-2 warm-ups, 3 x 10
T - Biceps (3), Triceps (3), Forearms (2)
-
Machine Curl….ramping sets of 8, finish with a drop set
-
-
Barbell Curl….4 x 6
Hammer Curl….3 x 10
Pressdown….ramping sets of 8, finish with
a drop set
Overhead DB Extension….4 x 10
Overhead Rope Extension….3 x 12
Wrist Curl….3 x 20
Reverse Curl….3 x 10
W - off
Th - Chest (2), Back (2), Shoulders (2)
Incline DB Press….1-2 warm-ups; 4 x 8
Machine Flat Press….3 x 10
Neutral Pulldown….1-2 warm-ups; 4 x 8
Seated Machine Row….3 x 10
Machine Lateral….3 x 15
Reverse Pec Deck….3 x 15
F - off
S - Biceps (3), Triceps (3), Forearms (2)
-
Cable Curl….ramping sets of 8, finish with a drop set
Incline DB Curl….4 x 8
Rope Curl….5 x 20 (BFR – blood flow restriction)
Rope Pressdown….ramping sets of 8, finish with a drop set
Prioritization Cycle
-
14
Dips….4 x 8
Overhead EZ Extension….5 x 20 (BFR – blood flow restriction)
Standing DB Wrist Curl….3 x 10
Wrist Roller…3 sets, up and down both ways
Ben Hartman
-
Barbell Row….4 x 8
Reverse-grip Pulldown….3 x 10
Machine Lateral….3 x 15
Reverse Pec Deck….3 x 15
Su - off
Su - off
4 week: Leg prioritization
4 week: Chest prioritization
M - Quads (3), Hams (2), Calves (1)
M - Chest (3), Biceps (3)
-
Incline Barbell Press….ramping sets of 6, finish with a drop set
Flat Machine Press (banded)….4 x 8
Incline DB Fly….3 x 10
Machine Curl….ramping sets of 8
Barbell Curl….3 x 6
Rope Curl….3 x 10
-
Squat….ramping sets of 6
Hack Squat….1-2 warm-ups; 3 x 10
Leg Extension….3 x 20
RDL….ramping sets of 8
Seated Leg Curl….3 x 10
Donkey Calf….1-2 warm-ups, 3 x 10
T - Quads (3), Hams (2), Calves (1)
W - off
Th - Chest (3), Triceps (2)
-
F - off
Flat DB Press (banded)….ramping
sets of 8
Incline Machine Press….4 x 10, finish with
a drop set
Pec Deck….3 x 20
Machine Dips….4 x 10
Pressdown….3 x 15
S - Back (3), Shoulders (2)
-
Pull-ups….50 reps (as many sets as it takes)
-
Squat….ramping sets of 6
Hack Squat….1-2 warm-ups; 3 x 10, finish with a drop set
Leg Extension….3 x 20, finish with a
drop set
RDL….ramping sets of 8
Seated Leg Curl….3 x 10, finish with a drop set
Donkey Calf….1-2 warm-ups, 3 x 10, finish with a drop set
T - Back (3), Biceps (3)
-
Weighted Chin-ups….1-2 warm-ups, 3 x 8
DB Row….4 x 10
Cable Row (neutral)….3 x 15
Machine Curl….3 x 10
Barbell Curl….3 x 8
Rope Curl….3 x 12
W - off
Th - Quads (3), Hams (2), Calves (1)
-
Seated Leg Curl….1-2 warm-ups; 3 x 10, finish with a drop set
Leg Press (banded)….ramping sets of 10, finish with a drop set
Machine Squat….3 x 15
Leg Extension….5 x 20 (BFR – blood flow restriction)
Lying Leg Curl….5 x 20 (BFR – blood flow restriction)
Donkey Calf….1-2 warm-ups, 5 x 10
Prioritization Cycle
15
F - off
S - Chest (3), Shoulders (2), Triceps (2)
-
Bench Press….1-2 warm-ups, 4 x 6
Incline DB Press….1-2 warm-ups, 3 x 10
Cable Fly….3 x 15
Machine Lateral….3 x 15
Reverse Pec Deck….3 x 15
Pressdown….4 x 15
Overhead Rope Extension….3 x 10
Su – off
CEO of Morphogen Nutrition, Ben’s knowledge of training and
nutrition is bolstered by practical experience as both a threesport strength athlete and as a contest prep consultant for
numerous successful competitors. He has a Bachelors degree in
exercise physiology, a Masters degree in nutrition and dietetics,
and a CSCS through the NSCA.
Ben Hartman
4-day General
Athletic Training
Matt Foley
Summer 4 day general condition phase part 1 of 3
exercise
1 leg split squat leg up
bent press
squat
broad jumps
1 arm db press standing
face pulls
good mornings
skulls
sets/reps
3x10
3x10
14/10/6/2/2/6/10/14
8x5
3x10
3x10
3x10
3xamap
incline db press
bent over row
bench
plyo push up
tate press
straight bar curl
rev. lunge
db row
3x10
3x10
14/10/6/2/2/6/10/14
8x5
3x8
3x8
3x10
3x10
standing band crunch
clean
hang power snatch
dollie wipes
5x20
6x5
6x5
6x20
incline close grip
bench
rev. curl
3xamap
pull-ups
shoulder box
deadlift
lateral band holds
step-ups
split squat jumps
close grip strap PU
hammer curl
3x10
3x6
14/10/6/2/2/6/10/14
8x20sec.
3x10
3x10
3xamap
3xamap
3xamap
Four Day General
17
Matt Foley
Summer 4 day accumulation phase
exercise
s e t s / weights
reps
sets/reps
pitch fork
dollie leg curl
squat
3x15
3x15
70%x6x5
3x15
3x15
65%x2,72.5%x2,77.5%x4x5
vert. jump
1leg bent knee dead
shrugs
6x5
3x10
3x15
6x5
3x10
3x15
bench
70%x6x5
65%x2,72.5%x2,77.5%x4x5
dollie wipes
incline football press
inverted row
rev. skulls
strap bicep curls
6x20
3x8
3xamap
3xamap
3xamap
clean and jerk
1 leg band calves
hang power snatch w/squat
band pull through
suitcase lunge
med. Grip chin-ups
10x2
5x20
6x2
6x10
3x10
3x10
dead lift
70%x6x5
65%x2,72.5%x2,77.5%x4x5
bridge
1min
1.30min
weights
s e t s / weights
reps
3x15
3x15
50%x5,60%x3,70%x2,75%x1,80%x1,85%xamap
6x5
3x8
3x15
50%x5,60%x3,70%x2,75%x1,80%x1,85%xamap
3x8
3xamap
3xamap
3xamap
3x8
3xamap
3xamap
3xamap
8x3
10x1
5x2
4x3
3x10
3x10
3x10
3x10
50%x5,60%x3,70%x2,75%x1,80%x1,85%xamap
2min
Four Day General
18
Matt Foley
db overhead press
70%x6x5
65%x2,72.5%x2,77.5%x4x5
rev. grip row
front squat
tricep kickbacks
3x8
3x8
3xamap
3x8
3x8
3xamap
50%x5,60%x3,70%x2,75%x1,80%x1,85%xamap
3x8
3x8
3xamap
Summer 4 day peaking 3 of 3
exercise
s e t s / weights
reps
sets/reps
weights
75%x7x3
70%x1,77.5%x1,82.5%x5x3
50%x5,60%x3,70%x2,75x1,80x1,85x1,90xamap
broad jump
split squat leg up
1/2kneel chop/press
good mornings
db high pull
5x6
5x10
5x10
5x8
5x8
5x6
5x8
5x15
5x8
5x8
bench
75%x7x3
70%x1,77.5%x1,82.5%x5x3
dollie roll out
bentover row
incline fly
close grip bench
hammer curl
7x15
5x10
5x10
5x8
5x8
7x15
5x8
5x8
5x8
5x8
7x15
5x6
5x6
5x8
5x8
clean/4 front squat/4
press/4 overhead squat/4
1 leg squat
jm press
db swing/4 snatch/4
1leg dead/4 push uppull/4
5x
6x
7x
5x5
5x10
5x
4x5
4x10
6x
3x8
3x15
7x
squat
sets/reps
5x6
5x6
5x10
5x8
5x8
50%x5,60%x3,70%x2,75x1,80x1,85x1,90xamap
weights
Four Day General
dead lift
75%x7x3
alt. strap knee tucks
7x20
db overhead press
crossover step-up
db row
strap push-up
19
Matt Foley
70%x1,77.5%x1,82.5%x5x3
50%x5,60%x3,70%x2,75x1,80x1,85x1,90xamap
75%x7x3
70%x1,77.5%x1,82.5%x5x3
50%x5,60%x3,70%x2,75x1,80x1,85x1,90xamap
5x10
5x10
5x10
5x10
5x8
5xamap
5x10
5x6
5xamap
Grip Training
Eric Maroscher
T
his is a program that I have personally used,
developed and tweaked throughout my over
two-decades long competitive powerlifting
career and over some 30 years of weight training
in general. I have seen loads of programs come
and go, some that work well, some that result in no
substantial benefit.
This program can be injected into your larger
training program as its focus is two-fold. First, it
works to increase your grip strength. We all know
that getting the deadlift locked out is useless if you
cannot hold the weight at the top long enough for
the down command. Further, grip, a strong grip is
essential in so many aspects of powerlifting and
overall strength development. Be it gripping the bar
on a 600-700LB bench press, hefting strong man
kegs, deadlifting, Farmers’ Walk, etc., a strong grip is
where it all begins as the barbell, the dumbbell, the
implement is being held in the hands and the tighter
you can lock a vice like grip onto that apparatus, the
more you can ultimately control the trajectory of
that implement. The second focus of this program
is the actual development of the forearm itself. The
ancillary parts of grip are all hit when performing
some hypertrophy aspects to grip development, thus
in addition to a vastly enhanced physical grip, the
forearms will also develop muscular development.
A few points to cover prior to getting into sets and
reps and such… In my experience, grip strength is not
a max effort, speed work thing, nor is it an equipped
vs RAW thing, and finally, in my opinion, grip is not a
percentages thing. Grip is a slow and steady, month
building on month, year building upon year process.
Grip is also, again based on my experience, a higher
rep type of animal vs say a deadlift or squat. The
reason being, much like say calves or your abs, you
use your hands and indirectly your forearms on a
daily basis. Every time you load a 45LB plate onto
a barbell, every time you lift a dumbbell, every time
you lift off for someone or wrap their knees tight,
you are working your grip. You will really notice how
much griping you do when you shake hands with a
non-powerlifter. Their hands are free of callouses
that you have built up over time by grabbing some
type of weight or barbell or lifting implement or
something heavy repeatedly. You will also note
Grip Training
21
how, and I will use the word “pillow-like,” their hand
feels. So although you might not be doing anything
specifically for your grip strength, truly, if you are
serious about your weight training, powerlifting,
strongman, you truly are working your grip, albeit
unintentionally and not to fullest, but you are and
have developed grip strength up to a degree.
Eric Maroscher
to this as time and consistency are the keys to
improved grip work. Think of it like a clean diet. It
is not something that you do over a 6 week cycle, but
something you always chip away at and then after
time, referring to the clean diet, you are now a solid
as a rock 242 vs a sloppy-fast-food-ball-fat 275-er.
Typically this program is a lot of volume for a very
This program will ultimately work in your advantage few movements but a lot of that movement as we
for any movement you do that requires your hands, are trying to exhaust the grip, wear it out if you will,
forearms, fingers to be strong.
as your grip is like your calves, it has tremendous
endurance and excessive reps at a good amount of
There are two types of times that I use this program, weight is what it takes to actually push this area to
one being after a bench or back training day, or on get stronger. Just like sprints can build some cardio,
“scraps” day. Scraps day being a day for those all long distance running (ick) can build tremendous
to left out movements by so many powerlifters who cardio. The muscles involved in your grip works all
are focused on the big three but sometimes forget the time so it takes a lot to work it, as does the grip,
the supplemental movements. Thus scraps in my but obviously not to that degree.
vernacular can include non-big three movements
such as, grip work, calves, abs, GPP, as well as By all means, experiment with this program, keeping
stretching/flexibility/mobility, foam rolling and the what works for you and dumping what does not.
like. On scraps day, there are none of the traditional
movements, but these ancillary movements. The Program:
Training grip after bench press and back is on As I mentioned earlier, grip work follows a bench
purpose as quite frankly, if you train your grip first or deadlift training day….or is incorporated into a
(really train it, not just touch and go) you wouldn’t scrap day.
be able to hold onto the barbell to bench or pull. The first coupling of exercises I will explain so you
Secondly, once you are finished with either of these get the idea and the rest will be in list form for your
two (chest and/or back) you have been using a lot of convenience. I will list them in groupings and you
grip, so you are warmed up and ready to train that can choose from the list and pair them up as you
aspect of your strength.
like. My typical grip work is a combination of two
movements with typically 5 sets per movement. If
Unlike my deadlift, bench or squat routine, my grip the movement is about muscle hypertrophy of the
work is not built like a training cycle, but trained forearm, I go with higher reps with a weight that
all year around. There is a frequency however and allows me to get to X amount of reps until I cannot
that is at least once time every 6 calendar days, but finish the movement. No spotters needed with the
more often than not I train my grip two out of every grip like a bench or squat so you can go until you
four training day. I can get away with this frequency drop the weigh. Also incorporated are a lot of static
because grip training will not stress your central holds and I hold for 8 seconds on virtually all of these
nervous system *unless you are working with as for me, 8 seconds is the amount of time it takes
farmers’ walk apparatus as farmers’ walk work is a to pull a grinder of a deadlift and then hold it until
completely different type of beast.
the judge says down. I am not a fan of holds that
last until I cannot hold on any longer as I feel that
The following are example of my typical grip/ is just taxing your CNS and I see no point for that.
forearm work sessions. There is no magic formula Having said that, the Farmer’s Walk is an exception
Grip Training
22
and if you are training specifically for a duration grip
movement, practicing that is advantageous. Here is
typically how the pairing goes with this first basic
pairing as the example:
Exercise 1 - Old fashioned wrist curls.
Eric Maroscher
Exercise 2 - Reverse wrist curls.
Follow the old fashioned wrist curls moment with
4-5 sets of reverse wrist curls (perhaps the most
neglected body part in the world of powerlifting).
Use an ez curl bar as a straight bar will not work
as well as it puts stress on your wrists. I guarantee
you will be able to use very limited weight for your
reps (same rep configuration as with the prior
movement). As your hands will need to be wider,
you will sit on the bench the same way, but put your
wrists, forearms and elbows on your quads as you
sit on the bench. With both type of wrist curls, it is
not a race, so no herky-jerky momentum curls, but
a nice evenly paced set. Again, like the wrist curls, I
feel higher reps are called for and 25-30 is the range
you are looking for. Unlike the burn of the forearm,
when you hit the wall with the reverse wrist curls
you will know it as either your forearm will cramp
up or it will simply conk out on you.
Although this sounds like something from a 1976
body building magazine, there is nothing better
to start a grip session with as it works the hands,
fingers (as you will bring the bar down to the last
phalanges in your hand).
You will do this on a bench press bench as it is a
wider surface than most stand-alone benches. I
personally use the elitefts deluxe bench press as it is
extremely wide. I lay my entire forearm, from elbow
to wrist on the bench as I sit on the bench long-ways.
It is essential to keep your elbow and forearm on the
bench as not to incorporate your biceps. Use a 45LB
barbell with or without weight on it, depending
on your strength level. The rep range for the first Following these movements, finish off with
set is high, 30-35 reps. Only a few minutes should static holds with the Rolling Thunder.
separate each set, so you will find, if you have picked
the correct weight or your strength, that you will
lose about 10 reps per set. You are going to want
to do 4-5 sets with as many reps as you can burn
through, and burn is the word as if your forearms
are not burning, the weight is too light. Again, you
should hit the wall around 30-35 reps. I like to alter
this movement sometimes by using elitefts fat gripz.
If you are a large handed person, there is a product
from elitefts called fat gripz extreme. Sometimes I
will use the Mastodon bar as it is longer, heavier and
thicker (1 3/8” thick, 8’ long and 60LBS). I have tried
the El Gordo Fat Bar too. That is pretty aggressive,
but does the trick. So, this movement will look like
this:
Sets:
4-5
Reps:
35 reps should be all you can get on the first
set, then each following set is to failure, with no
more than 3-5 minutes between sets.
You are going to want to hold the weight for 8
seconds, or about the time it takes to pull and hold
a grinder deadlift in a meet. Again, with all but a
few exceptions, I am not a big fan of holds over 10
seconds (not including Farmer’ Walk) as you want
to hold for all you are worth for the time it would
take to perform a lift. Load the Rolling Thunder
Grip Training
23
up and pick a weight and add weight for the 4-5
sets of 8 second holds. You will find that your nondominant hand will be considerably weaker. *TIP:
As I am right handed, pretty much any time I
grab a gallon of milk, a suitcase, your lap top, a
dumbbell, load a bar, I do so with the dominant
hand and it becomes stronger. This might sound a
little odd, but I alternate hands when I am loading
bars at the gym. I train on Monday, Wednesday,
Saturday and Sunday. Monday’s and Saturday I
grab weights off of the tree, or dumbbells off of
the rack with my left hand, and Wednesday and
Sunday, the right hand. Sounds strange, but if
you have a significant imbalance of grip strength
with your hands, my guess is you pick up 99%
of the weights and other heavy implements with
your more dominate hand. Food for thought.
The following are the other pairings I put together
for my non-cycled grip work, this time without
explanation, as I am going to make an assumption
that you know most of these movements and the
ones you don’t you can search for online. Again, in
my experience, grip work is a journey, not so much a
destination. It is ongoing so the work does not have
to take a long time, as the volume is significant and
the days in-between are few.
Exercise 1 - Farmers- Walk.
5 trips x ??? weight at 100’ per trip. If you don’t have
a Farmers’ Walk use the afore mentioned fat gripz
on heavy dumbbells. Unless you are a strongman
competitor, I would not do FW more than once every
three weeks as it is an extreme training tool and in
my experience it does impact your central nervous
system and my hands feel tired and almost exhausted
for days.
Exercise 2 - 10LB plate pinch grip
5 sets x 8 seconds per pinch. If 10LB plates are too
light, try 25LBers. Put as many plates together (I.E.
three, 10LB plates) and when the grip goes the plate
in the middle will slip out from between the two
other plates. *Watch out for plates hitting your feet.
Eric Maroscher
Exercise 1 - elitefts Gripper Machine
3 warm-up sets followed by 5 working sets of
2-25 reps. You will need to experiment with weight
until you find that sweet spot where your grip is shot
come the 20th or so rep. These are all done one hand
at a time, so 5 sets for the left, and 5 for the right.
Exercise 2 - elitefts Heavy Grips
These, in my experience, are really hard on your skin.
For the grip athlete, have at it. For me, I am trying to
develop my grip and I want to do so without pulling
the skin off my hands so I cheat and put a mini-face
towel or a part of a t-shirt around the gripper and
squeeze it from there. It is like shrugs, I use straps
as I want my traps to give out first, not my hands.
Same here, I want to stop using the heavy grips after
my hands are shot, not because my skin is getting
ripped to shreds. I will go 5 sets per hand with
8 seconds of the grip being completely closed
in my hand. Some will have to start with a trainer,
then go to a 1, then so on. Some will be able to start
with a 2. There is no wrong amount of starting grip
strength, there is only improving on your strength.
So, 5 sets x 8 second squeezes per set, first with
the right then left hand. *TIP: Keep your arms
strait when you do this as that best mimics the
deadlift.
Exercise 1 - Sled pulls with 4-grenade balls.
Load up your sled and at the end of the rope or chain
(which ever you pull your sled with) attach (2) 4’
grenade balls and pull that heavy sled (walking
forward so you can pull more weight) all over the
parking lot. Minimally 150’ per trip x 5 trips x
???? pounds of weight.
Grip Training
24
Exercise 2 - Standing finger roll curls
Eric Maroscher
wraps =’s one set). Sounds a little silly until your
hands becomes too engorged in blood to continue.
Also, any chance you get to wrap someone’s knees,
do it as a good knee wrap will work your hands.
This link is how we wrap at the Monster Garage
Gym and after wrapping a few pairs of knees, your
hands are shot as they have been worked hard. This
movement falls into the category of “don’t worry
about looking silly wrapping and re-wrapping knee
wraps. Remember, the devil is in the details and
that always works to your advantage when all other
variables are equal. http://youtu.be/mX6ayCLYOnA
Exercise 2 - sandbag grabs
Take your barbell, hold it with a double pronated
grip and allow the barbell to roll to the edge of your
fingers to the point where you almost drop it, hold
it there for a moment then close the barbell back
into our pronated fist grip. 5 sets x a weight you
can do for 20-30 reps. Do not let the bar come in
contact with your thighs during the movement. You
can do this exercise with all four fingers per hand,
or two or one finger at a time once you have built
up some finger strength. You will see 800LB pullers
workout with an empty bar. Less is more with this
movement.
Exercise 1 - Knee wrap roll ups
This is one of the best finger-hand-forearm
movements I have ever found and I stumbled onto
it 20 years ago. I was at a meet and wrapping knee
after knee after knee and after each wrap, I had to
re-roll the knee wrap. You know, you step on the
knee wrap, pull a length of wrap, and then roll it into
a tight little Hostess Hoho looking wrap. Take the
longest knee wrap you have at the gym, make it a
thick one like the elitefts super heavy knee wrap,
and let it unfurl. Then wrap it up as tight as you
can and as quickly as you can. 5 non-stop sets of
wrapping. Rest for a few minutes, then 5 nonstop sets again. Repeat this for 5 total sets (five
This is about as non-sexy of an exercise you can
do. You load up a sandbag with as much sand
weight as you like, I suggest 75LBS to start with,
and from the floor you pick up the bag, deadlift
style, and hold the bag for up to 8 seconds. This
is repeated for 5 sets, (each sets is comprised of
5, 8 second pick-ups). Warning: There is simply
no way to look cool doing this movement, but there
is everything cool about hanging on to that deadlift
bar at the meet.
Grip Training
25
Exercise 1 -Rolling wrist curl bar
This is that steel bar with the hollow barbell sleeve
over it, thus being able to roll the weight up on a string.
I put the bar on the J-hooks of the squat rack or the
arms on the elitefts monolift and with my shoulders
parallel to the floor at chest height, I roll a few kettle
bells (they have big handles and that is simply easier
than using plates) that is on the rope up to the bar
with my hands going forward, then back down, then
up the other direction with my hands going in the
opposite direction. Five sets of each direction with
the right weight will blow your forearms up in the
best of ways. This movement, like the wrist curls
works both grip and forearm size. Choose a weight
that at the top of the rope your hands and grip and
forearms are shot. It will take some experimentation.
Be liberal with the chalk too as it does work abrasively
against the skin of your hands. Lastly, keep your arms
straight out as much as possible, again to best mimic
the straight arms of a deadlift.
Exercise 2 - Dumbbell holds
Again, simple and cheap. Not the plate dumbbells, but
with the all one piece dumbbells, grab the dumbbell
from the weighted side and with your arm straight
down, hold the weight for a count of 8-10 seconds
with a grip that makes this amount of time a
challenge. 5 sets of five holds. Use a face towel if
the dumbbell slips because this is about grip strength,
and losing the weight when your hands and fingers
fatigue. It is not about trying to hold something
slippery.
Eric Maroscher
Remember, you work your grip indirectly all of the
time, so grip work is a slow and steady wins the race
type of thing. Also, consistency with grip work is
more important than the sheer weight as grip comes
over time, not unlike flexibility or endurance. Lastly,
grip work is meticulous and precise, it is not about
heaving the weight nor using momentum, as that
will only serve your ego, not enhance your grip.
Off-Season
Basketball
T
he primary goal of our off-season basketball
raining is to develop starting, reactive, and
maximal strength in the lower body, develop
strength endurance in the upper body, prevent
injuries and increase performance through educating
athletes on quality movement. In the ever growing
world of ‘sport specificity’ the general need for the
ability to initiate movement via overcoming inertia
(i.e. first step out of a defensive stance), the ability
to effectively use the stretch shortening cycle to
quickly get off the ground or change directions, and
the ability to operate at high-levels of strength and
power via possessing a high-strength reserve cannot
be overlooked. A good program is preventative
in nature; therefore, the means of programming/
coaching the movements addresses a majority of
the injury prevention needs along with the athlete’s
awareness of how to properly move and apply force.
At the start of the off-season, it is important
to re-establish proper technique, as athletes have
likely spent little time in the weight room during the
season. It is also important during this time of year
to undo some of the stress imparted over the course
of the season. The lower body session is categorized
as a speed-strength phase using loads between 5060%. Since athletes often perceive such loads as “too
light,” a four second eccentric component is added
with a two second pause on the box. Eccentrics and
pauses also further reinforce technique and the static
Skyler Farley
overcome by dynamic action on the box develops
starting strength. Two birds, one stone. Throughout
the entire off-season, the upper body is trained
primarily with the repetitive effort method. The
idea here is to train the lower body for performance
and the upper body to increase confidence and
hypertrophy. Due to the higher volume and low to
moderate intensities on these days, they are less
intensive on the Central Nervous System.
In the second phase of the off-season, the
emphasis of the lower body transitions to strengthspeed using loads between 60-75%. The volume in
this phase is spread across fewer sets to allow the
athletes to develop a higher level of a-lactic capacity
and to teach them how to effectively “grind” to
some extent in the last few reps. To accommodate
the higher intensities the eccentric component is
removed, while still employing a pause to reinforce
technique and continue to develop starting strength.
In the third phase, the box and pause are
removed to allow athletes to lower at a faster rate,
take off the breaks, and attack the weight. During this
phase, intensities range from 70-85% and clusters
are used to reinforce technique and preserve the
quality of the repetitions.
In the fourth and final phase, maximal effort
methods with intensities ranging from 90-100% are
used. Technique is well-established by this point
and athletes will set a 5RM, 3RM, and 1RM in weeks
Off-Season Basketball
27
Skyler Farley
one through three, respectively. All jump training at this point is reactive in nature with low total volumes.
In all four phases, volume on accessory work is kept high to positively affect body composition, maintain
work capacity, and joint integrity.
Phase One – Day One - Lower
A) Box Squat (42X0)*Upper classmen add 80-120 lb
chain
B1) MB Catch to Box Jump
B2) Clean Pull
C1) 6” DB RFE Split Squat
(40X0)
C2) Band-Assisted Natural
GHR
C3) Weighted Plank
12 x 2@50%
12 x 2@55%
10 x 2@60%
3x5
3x5
3 x 8ea
4x4
4x4
3 x 6ea
5x3
5x3
4 x 4ea
3x4
3x5
3x6
3 x 30s
3 x 45s
3 x 60s
Phase One – Day Two – Upper
A1) Plate Elevated Iso Pushup Hold
A2) Dynamic Blackburn
B) Bb Floor Press (42X0)
C1) SA Db Press
C2) Db Chest Supported
Row
D1) Banded Pushdown
D2) Banded Pull-aparts
D3) Db Zottman Curl
4 x 15s
3 x 20s
2 x 30s
3 x 10
3 x 10
3 x 12ea
3 x 12
3 x 10
4x8
3 x 10ea
3 x 10
3 x 10
4x6
3 x 8ea
4x8
100 total
100 total
3 x 10
100 total
100 total
3 x 10
100 total
100 total
3 x 10
Phase One – Day Three – Total
A1) Seated Box Jump
A2) Overhead Squat
A3) Bird-dog
B1) Trap Bar Deadlift
B2) Side Plank
B3) Speed Skater Hop
C1) Plate Elevated Push-ups
C2) Neutral Grip Pull-ups
C3) Hyper-ext
3x5
3x6
3 x 10ea
3x5
3 x 20s
3 x 5ea
3 x 10
3 x amap
3 x 10
3x4
3x6
3 x 10ea
4x4
3 x 30s
3 x 6ea
4x8
3 x amap
3 x 12
3x3
3x6
3 x 10ea
5x3
3 x 45s
3 x 7ea
5x5
3 x amap
3 x 15
Off-Season Basketball
28
Skyler Farley
Phase Two – Day One – Lower
A1) Static Box Jump (5s
hold in quarter squat)
A2) Banded TKE
B) 2s Pause Box Squat *Upper classmen add 80-120 lbs
chain
C1) Front Loaded KB Bulgarian Split Squat
C2) Weighted Side Plank
D1) Banded Pull-Through
D2) Stability Ball Rollout
3x4
3x3
3x2
3 x 10ea
5 x 5 @60%
3 x 15ea
5 x 4 @67.5%
3 x 20ea
5 x 3@75%
3 x 8ea
4 x 6ea
4 x 4ea
3 x 20s
3 x 10
3 x 12
3 x 30s
3 x 12
3 x 15
3 x 45s
3 x 15
3 x 20
Phase Two – Day Two – Upper
A1) Depth Drop Push-up
A2) PVC Over-and-Backs
B) Paused Board Press
C1) Db Floor Press
C2) SA Db Row
D1) Manual Resistance Lateral Raise
D2) Banded Pull-aparts
D3) Lying Banded Triceps
Ext.
3x5
3 x 10
5x5
3 x 10
3 x 10ea
3 x 10
3x6
3 x 10
5x4
3 x 15
3 x 15ea
3 x 10
3x7
3 x 10
5x3
2 x 20
2 x 10ea; 1 x 20ea
3 x 10
3 x 10
3 x 10
3 x 10
3 x 15
3 x 10
3 x amap
Phase Two – Day Three – Total
A1) Seated Broad Jump
A2) Overhead Squat
A3) Bird-dog with 5s hold
B1) Deadlift
B2) Banded Iso-Pallof Press
C1) Military Press
C2) Neutral Grip Pull-up
C3) Banded Good-morning
3x5
3x7
3 x 4ea
5x5
3 x 20s/ea
3 x 10
25 total
3 x 12
3x4
3x7
3 x 5ea
5x4
3 x 30s/ea
3x8
30 total
3 x 15
3x3
3x7
3 x 6ea
5x3
3 x 30s/ea
4x5
35 total
3 x 20
Off-Season Basketball
29
Skyler Farley
Phase Three – Day One – Lower
A1) 12” Hurdle hop to Box
Jump
A2) SA Db Snatch Complex
(snatch pull – snatch high
pull – snatch)
B) Squat Clusters
C1) Db Reverse Lunge
C2) Dynamic Side-Plank
D1) Natural GHR
D2) Stir-the-Pot
3x5
3x4
3x3
3 x 5ea
3 x 3ea
3 x 1ea
3 x 3.2.2 @70%
3 x 8ea
3 x 10ea
3x4
3 x 10ea
3 x 2.1.1 @77.5%
3 x 6ea
3 x 12ea
3x5
3 x 15ea
3 x 1.1.1 @85%
4 x 4ea
3 x 15ea
3x6
3 x 20ea
Phase Three – Day Two – Upper
A1) Clap Push-up
A2) Behind the Neck Banded Pull-aparts
B) Close Grip Bench *Upper Classmen add 40-60lbs
chain
C1) Incline Db Bench
C2) Inverted Row
D1) Side-lying Db Reverse
Fly
D2) Db Rolling Triceps Ext
3x5
3 x 20
3x6
3 x 20
3x7
3 x 20
5x5
5x4
5x3
3 x 12
3 x 12
3 x 10ea
4 x 10
4 x 10
3 x 12ea
2 x 20
2 x 20
3 x 8ea
3 x 10
3 x 12
3x8
D3) Db Curl
3 x 10
3 x 12
3x8
Phase Three – Day Three – Total
A1) Single-leg Box Jump
A2) SA Db Snatch
A3) Overhead Walking
Lunge *Reinforce Posture
B1) 2” Sumo Deadlift
B2) Banded Pallof Press
C1) Barbell Push-Press
C2) Pull-ups Various Grips
C3) Reverse Hyper
3 x 5ea
3 x 4ea
3 x 8ea
3 x 3ea
3 x 2ea
3 x 8ea
3 x 2ea
3 x 1ea
3 x 8ea
5x5
3 x 15ea
3x5
30 total
3 x 10
5x4
3 x 15ea
4x5
35 total
3 x 12
5x3
3 x 15ea
5x5
40 total
3 x 15
Off-Season Basketball
30
Skyler Farley
Phase Four – Day One – Lower
A1) Single-leg Hurdle
Bound to Box Jump
A2) SA Db Snatch
A3) Banded Bird-dog
B) Squat
C1) Db Walking Lunge
C2) Db RDL
C3) Stir-the-Pot
3 x 3ea
3 x 2ea
3 x 1ea
3 x 3ea
3 x 10ea
5RM
3 x 8ea
3 x 10
3 x 20ea
3 x 2ea
3 x 10ea
3RM
3 x 6ea
3x8
3 x 20ea
3 x 1ea
3 x 10ea
1RM
3 x 5ea
3x6
3 x 20ea
Phase Four – Day Two – Upper
A1) Lying MB Chest Throw
A2) Y-T-W
B) Bench Press
C1) Barbell Bent-over Row
C2) Db Arnold Press
D1) Db Lateral Raise
D2) Barbell Curl
D3) EZ Skull Crusher
3x7
3 x 8ea
5RM
3 x 10
3 x 10
3 x 10
3 x 10
3 x 10
3x6
3 x 8ea
3RM
3 x 12
3 x 12
3 x 12
3 x 12
3 x 12
3x5
3 x 8ea
1RM
4 x 10
4 x 10
4 x 10
4 x 10
4 x 10
Phase Four – Day Three – Total
A1) Barbell Squat Jump
A2) Rotational MB Throw
A3) Rotating Plank
B) Sumo Deadlift
C1) Push-Jerk
C2) Various Grips Pull-ups
C3) Reverse Hyper
3x7
3 x 5ea
3 x 10ea
5RM
4x4
40 total
3 x 10
3x7
3 x 4ea
3 x 10ea
3RM
5x3
45 total
3 x 12
3x7
3 x 3ea
3 x 10ea
1RM
6x2
50 total
3 x 15
It is recommended that this program include four days of running: two high-CNS acceleration and
change of direction days and two low-CNS aerobic tempo days. True speed and acceleration days always
precede day one, lower-body sessions and never exceed 40 yards in distance. The general sequence
throughout the four phases is as follows: hill sprints, sled resisted sprints, contrast sprints, flying sprints.
Aerobic capacity tempo days always follow after day two, upper-body sessions and generally range in 100200 yards in distance. The general sequence throughout the four phases is as follows: med ball tempo
throws, 100 yard sprints (submaximal), 200 yard sprints (submaximal), 100 and 200 yard sprints combined
(submaximal). The acceleration and change of direction days fall on the non-lifting day. These days focus
on the three primary qualities of changes in direction: acceleration, deceleration, and re-acceleration. The
general sequence of training throughout the four phases is highly-dependent on the athletes’ progress and
readiness. Drills become more complicated through adding reactive components as athletes’ readiness
permits. Aerobic capacity tempo days also fall on day three, total-body days. These days are performed
Off-Season Basketball
31
Skyler Farley
on the basketball court, to condition the athletes’ tissues to run on hard surfaces. The general sequence
throughout the four phases is as follows: down and backs in 11s, two down and backs in 22s, 8 sideline
touches in 30s, double suicides in 55s.
Skyler Farley was hired as an Assistant Strength and Conditioning Coach at Charlotte in June of 2013. He is responsible for all
facets designing and implementing the strength and conditioning programs for women’s basketball, as well as men’s tennis.
From 2012-13, Skyler served as the Graduate Assistant Strength and Conditioning Coach at his alma mater, the University of
Kansas. During this time, he worked with track and field, women’s rowing, and women’s tennis and assisted with men and women’s
basketball.
For the three seasons prior to becoming a GA, he was an intern strength and conditioning coach at KU, working with all 16 varsity
athletic teams. During this time, he also completed summer internships with the University of South Florida and University of
North Carolina at Chapel Hill.
Farley earned his Bachelor’s degree in Exercise Science KU in 2012. He is a Certified Strength and Conditioning Specialist through
the NSCA and a Level 1 Sports Performance Specialist through USAW.
He was born in Anchorage, Alaska and was raised in a military family moving 10 times before landing in Charlotte, N.C.
He resides in Charlotte and enjoys training for and competing in powerlifting and is passionate about his faith.
Strength & Explosiveness
in Six Weeks
I
was trying to come up with a mini training
program that would help me utilized how I liked
to train, with what will make me stronger that in
neglect. DED Strength is the mini program I came
up. Defiant Every Day Strength is a combination of
strength training and explosive DE training. I had
gotten to the point where I was extremely annoyed
with only being strong on meet day, peak strength
you could call it. I didn’t only want to be strong at the
acculmination of a training program, I wanted to be
just plain old strong every day! So I started to think
about the unique ways that I like to train and had
to figure out what they were missing. I absolutely
love training with lots of accommodating resistance.
Whether it be chains, bands, or both. If you know me
at all you know that I love AR because it takes my
mind off the numbers game. I quit focusing on the
weight on the bar, because you really have to clue,
and just focused on training as hard as possible.
Using very heavy resistance with low bar weight
teaches you to be as explosive as possible. If you
aren’t explosive you will not make it through the top
end of that resistance. Also it helps me stay healthy,
the weight is less during the eccentric part of the
lifts when most of your joints and tendons are in
a comprised position. The problem with this type
of training was that I was starting to get weaker
when I lifted just the straight weight. The eccentric
part of my lift was actually starting to decline. I felt
weak lowering the bar. When I would press though
it would be strong, but the decent wore me out. I
Marshall Johnson
had to stop and think about what I was leaving out.
You’re program is only as strong as its weaknesses.
I needed to add strength training along with my
explosive AR training. I had remembered that I had
read something in a strength and conditioning book
about combining strength training with plyometric
or explosive lifts. I apologize for not remembering
the name of the book. So I came up with a short 6
week training program that fits very well into those
gaps between meets and programs that a lot of us
sometimes have. The program would consist of two
main lifts followed by two less compound building
movements. It was dividing between four training
days a week. Three of the four, squat, bench, and
deadlift, fit easily already into most powerlifters
regimine. The fourth day was an Olympic lifting day
whether it was snatches, cleans, or clean and jerk.
When I think about being strong in general I can’t
help but think that working on your Olympic lifts
will contribute to that. I actually had to learn how
to Olympic lift this summer while I was testing DED
Strength. If you do not know how to Olympic lift
www.elitefts.com has many resources to help you
get started.
Getting started and developing your plan:
-6 week plan
-You should have a rep range and weight end goal for
both your start and your finish
-For your first lift you need to choose a rep range
Strength and Explosiveness
33
that puts you somewhere between power and
hypertrophy(strength). It is going to be something
different for everyone. You need to pick a rep range
that just starts to put you into that lactic acid burn.
The weight should be heavy enough to keep you
from hypertrophy rep ranges but light enough to do
multiple sets. For myself my rep ranges were 6 reps
for squat, 10 reps for bench, and 5 reps for deathlifts.
All of this work is done raw.
*Example week 1-6(end goal is 385x10)
Bench
315x10x4
325x10x4
335x10x4
355x10x4
370x10x4
385x10x4
Squat(end goal 500x6x4)
315x6x4
365x6x4
405x6x4
425x6x4
455x6x4
500x6x4
Deathlift(end goal 635x5)
495x5x4
525x5x4
545x5x4
585x5x4
610x5x4
635x5x4
Marshall Johnson
bench, deadlift) but the change is in the weight, AR,
and rep range. You will start with a weight and AR of
your choice. But you will have to add weight or AR
or both after every set so do not set your first set to
heavy. You will do 4 sets of 5 trying to be explosive as
possible. Some parts of the movement main change
on this second lift. For example my squats move to
the box, and my deathlifts are usually done off a
deficit. Deathlifts off a huge deficit against massive
AR is probably one of my most favorite movements.
You are making the lift pretty much as hard as
possible. The key with these lifts is to be as explosive
as possible, if you aren’t explosive you won’t make
it through the lifts because of the heavy AR or just
being fatigued from the first lift.
*The Olympic lift day is unique. There is no second
lift, instead the snatches or cleans are super setted
with box jumps. I would first warm up with light
squats and shoulder mobility work to prepare
myself for the lift. After I was warm I would then
start my oly lift that I had chosen. So for example I
would do my 4 sets of 10 and then immediately head
right to 4 sets of 10 box jump. After those super sets
were finished I ended the day with some form of ab
work 4 sets of 20
Second lift example:
Squat&Bench: Choose an intial weight and AR that is
of moderate difficutly.
-do an explosive set of five
-add AR or weight or both, do an explosive set of 5
-repeat this until you have hit 4 sets of 10
Deathlift is a little more unique:
*Olympic lift day(end goal 185x10x4 snatch)
-Start with an initial bar weight and AR but also start
95x10x4
with a very small deficit and hit an explosive set of 5
115x10x4
-Add more bar weight, AR, or both, but also add
135x10x4
another small deficit
150x10x4
-Repeat this until you have hit 4 explosive sets of 5
165x10x4
*For example I like to start with a 1in deficit and end
185x10x4
with about a 7in deficit. I like hitting those last sets
See you set yourself up to hit that desired rep and set with the bar pretty much resting on my foot.
range at the end of the 6 weeks. You progressively Third and fourth lifts:
overload for 6 weeks.
These lifts are more hypertrophy based and are there
*Second lift
to help you get blood moving and some strength
-The second lift is still the main movement(squat,
Strength and Explosiveness
34
via less compound movements focusing on individual
muscles. You will do 4 sets of 12-15 reps.
Squat: Hammy curls, leg extension, split leg squat,
Bench: tricep press down, skulls, band pull aparts,
dumb bell side raise, lat pull down
Deathlift: GHR, stiff leg deathlift, hammy curls,
Fifth and final lift is an ab movement, always hit abs
every training session. You will do 4 sets of 20
Week 1 example
Tuesday oly lifts
-
Squat and shoulder mobility warm up
Snatch 4 sets of 10 superset with box jumps
4 sets of 10
Abs 4 sets of 20
Wednesday Deathlift
-
Deathlift 4 sets of 5
Deficit Deathlift with AR 4 sets of 5
Stiff Leg 4 sets of 12
GHR 4 sets of 12
Abs 4x20
Friday bench
-
Bench 4 sets of 10
Bench 4 sets of 5 with AR
Skulls 4 sets of 12
Tricep pressdown 4 sets of 20
Abs 4 sets of 20
Sunday Squat
-
Squat 4 sets of 6
Box squats with AR 4 sets of 5
Leg ext 4 sets of 12
Hammy curl 4 sets of 12
Abs 4 sets of 20
*Things to remember
1. Be explosive as possible in those second lifts
2. Choose weights and AR wisely
3. Pic reasonable goals
4. Have fun with it, this is just a 6 week mini program
between your main training prep
I used myself and two of my training partners as guinea
pigs for this mini program. All three of us experience
every day strength gains that were noticeable when
our main training cycles started. Sometimes we
Marshall Johnson
all have bigger breaks in between meets and
find ourselves struggling to find direction and
motivation during those down times. This is a
fun, short, and effective way to spend those down
times. It also keeps you healthy because you are
still working with maximal effort but with sub
maximal real weight. It will help keep you fresh
and working hard.
Like many lifters, Marshall Johnson started out as a
bodybuilder and has only been powerlifting for three years
now. Now, he’s a rising name in powerlifting with a 1000-lb
squat.
Strength and Explosiveness
35
Marshall Johnson
May, 17
Columbus, OH
I WISH TO HAVE AN iPAD2.
May was diagnosed with a bone growth
May was diagnosed with a bone growth
disorder at birth. Her life-threatening medical
condition strictly limits how much weight she
is able to lift. May is not allowed to carry
textbooks.
When she was visited by her Wish-Granting
Volunteers, May knew exactly what she
wanted: an iPad2. She shared with her
volunteers that she wanted to use the tablet,
which weighs only a little over a pound, to
download the books she needs for school.
May was overwhelmed with joy when her
wish came true. In addition to doing her
school work, May can now read about her
favorite sports team, Ohio State basketball,
and her favorite player, Jared Sullinger.
“Ever since her wish came true, May has
been so happy,” shared May’s mom,
Elizabeth. “Everywhere she goes, the iPad
goes with her. She is able to download
books for school, watch movies and play
games. It is just wonderful!”
Basic Hypertrophy
Training Amit Sapir
T
his is a basic 4 days a week hypertrophy
program. This should be done for 6 weeks.
It will incorporate both strength work and
“intensity techniques” to keep volume high.
This program is for intermediate lifters and will fit
anyone who would like to maintain a strength base
and build mass.
DAY 1 LEGS
BACK SQUATS 5 sets X 10/8/6/4/20 reps
DAY 2 CHEST & SHOULDERS
INCLINE BENCH PRESS 5 sets X 10/8/6/4 + drop
set: 10/10/10 reps
SUPERSET:(use the same weight for both) 3 sets X
12/10/8 reps
Flat dumbbell flies (lower the weight slowly.. 4-5
seconds on the way down and press fast)
+
Flat dumbbell press
WIDE GRIP WEIGHTED DIPS 3 sets X 10/8/6 + 1
LUNGES 3 sets X 15/12/10 reps + drop set : 8/8/8 bodyweight set to failure
reps
SEATED MILITARY BARBELL PRESS (behind neck) 3
sets X 12/10/8 reps
SUPERSET:
Hack squat machine 3 sets x 15 reps, 12 reps, drop
set: 10/10/10 reps
+
Stiff leg deadlift 3 sets x 15 reps, 12 reps, drop set:
10/10/10 reps
SUPERSET: 2 Supersets of 12 reps each
Standing dumbbell laterals
+
Rear delt laterals(face down on bench @45 degrees).
*For a 3rd set do a drop set of each exercise
individually of 10/10/10 reps, drop the weight after
SUPERSET:
Lying hamstring curls 3 sets x 15 reps, 12 reps, drop every 10 reps.
set: 10/10/10reps
STANDING WIDE GRIP UPRIGHT ROWS
+
Leg extensions (sets/reps same as hamstring curls) *pinky finger on ring of the bar
3 sets X 15 reps, 12 reps + drop set: 10/10/10 reps
Basic Hypertrophy Training
37
DAY 3 BACK & TRAPS
OLYMPIC DEADLIFTS (it’s a deadlift with a shrug at
the end) *video attached
5 sets X 8/6/4/2/20
* the last set of 20 reps is normal deadlifts without
the shrugs, it should burn!)
http://youtu.be/SB5Zz0PV-zY
WEIGHTED PULL-UPS (neutral grip)
5 sets X 10/8/6/5 + bodyweight to failure
SUPERSET
Bent over barbell rows. 3 sets x 12/10/8 reps
+
Rope Pullovers. 3 sets x 18/15/13 reps
SUPERSET
Wide grip pull downs. 3 sets x 12/10/8 reps. (5
second negative for first 1/2 of the set)
+
Seated cable rows (or rowing machine)
3 sets
x 12/10/8 reps (3 second pause at the peak
contraction for first 1/2 of the set)
http://youtu.be/NYfsxKDG9qc
RACK DEADLIFTS
3 sets x 12 reps
MACHINE SHRUGS (or barbell/dumbbell shrugs)
3 sets x 15/12/10
* pause at the top for 3 seconds for the first half of
the set
DAY 4 ARMS
CLOSE GRIP BENCH PRESS. 5 sets x 10/8/6/4 +
drop set: 10/10/10
SUPERSET. 3 sets x 15 reps, 12 reps + drop set:
10/10/10
Rope pushdowns
+
Overhead rope extensions
Amit Sapir
EZ BAR DECLINE SKULLCRUSHERS
4 sets x 12/12/10/10 reps
* 2 sets close grip, 2 sets wide grip
CLOSE GRIP PUSH-UPS ON BENCH 2 sets to failure
STANDING EZ BAR CURLS 3 sets x 8+8+8
http://youtu.be/-b3sYuR6Az4
INCLINE DUMBELL CURLS (set bench at 45 degrees)
3 sets x 15/12 + drop set: 10/10/10
SUPERSET. 3 sets x 15/12 + drop set: 10/10/10
Hammer curls
+
Concentration curls
ABS AT THE END OF EVERY WORKOUT
3 sets x 15 reps of decline crunches with weight
behind your neck
3 sets to failure -Knee raises on roman chair
3 sets x 12-15 reps - lying knee raises (video
attached)
http://youtu.be/MvGF7PrFqPE
Eight-week Olympic
Weightlifting Cycle
Greg Everett
T
his is a simple 8-week weightlifting training
cycle using 3-position snatches and cleans,
power snatches and power cleans, and plenty
of pulls, squats and classic snatch and clean & jerk.
It will test for max snatch, clean & jerk, and either
front or back squat at the end of week 8.
-
65%, 70% x 4 sets
Snatch Pull - 90% (of sn) x 3 x 2,
95% x 3 x 2
Back Squat - 70% x 5 x 5
Push Press - 70% x 5 x 5
Tuesday
If you don’t have accurate 1RMs for these exercises,
you can adjust the weights by feel to be more
Power Clean - 70% x 3 x 5
appropriate on week 1. After that, attempt to increase
Power Jerk - 60% (of split jerk) x 3 x 5
weights according to the percentages prescribed to
Overhead Squat - 70% x 3 x 5
maintain the same approximate progression. For
example, if in your 3-position snatches on Monday, Wednesday
your final 4 sets are done at what amounts to 75%
of your 1RM instead of 70%, simply bump up all
3-Position Clean (floor, below knee, above
subsequent prescriptions for that exercise by 5%.
knee) + Jerk - 60%, 65%, 70% x 4 sets
Notation is weight x reps x sets (e.g. 90% x 3 x 2
Clean Pull - 90% (of cln) x 3 x 2,
means 90% of 1RM for 3 reps for 2 sets). If no weight
95% x 3 x 2
is assigned, notation is sets x reps (e.g. 3 x 5 means 3
Front Squat - 70% x 3 x 5
sets of 5 reps). If no weight is assigned, select weight
Good Morning - 3x5
by feel.
WEEK 1
For all exercises this week, if the prescribed weights
feel good, you can increase weights on your final
sets, but don’t push to maximum effort.
Monday
-
3-Position Snatch (floor, below knee, above knee) - 60%, Thursday
-
Power Snatch - 70% x 3 x 5
Snatch High-Pull - 70% (of sn) x 3 x 5
Snatch Push Press + Overhead Squat - 70%
(of sn or ohs) x 5+1 x 5
8 Week Olympic Weightlifting
39
Saturday
-
Snatch - 60%x2, 70%x2, 80%x2, heavy single
Clean & Jerk - 60%x2+1, 70%x2+1, 80%x2+1,
heavy single
Back Squat - 75% x 3 x 5
SLDL - 3x5
WEEK 2
For all exercises this week, if the prescribed weights
feel good, you can increase weights on your final
sets, but don’t push to maximum effort.
Monday
-
3-Position Snatch (floor, below knee, above knee) - 60%, 65%, 70%, 75% x 3 sets
Snatch Pull - 95% (of sn) x 3 x 2,
100% x 3 x 2
Back Squat - 75% x 5 x 5
Push Press - 75% x 5 x 5
Tuesday
-
Power Clean - 75% x 3 x 5
Power Jerk - 65% (of split jerk) x 3 x 5
Overhead Squat - 75% x 3 x 5
Wednesday
-
3-Position Clean (floor, below knee, above
knee) + Jerk - 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%
x 3 sets
Clean Pull - 95% (of cln) x 3 x 2, 100% x 3 x2
Front Squat - 75% x 3 x 5
Good Morning - 3x5
Greg Everett
Thursday
-
Power Snatch - 75% x 3 x 5
Snatch High-Pull - 75% (of sn) x 3 x 5
Snatch Push Press + Overhead Squat - 75% (of sn or ohs) x 5+1 x 5
Saturday
-
Snatch - 60%x2, 70%x2, 80%x2, heavy single
Clean & Jerk - 60%x2+1, 70%x2+1, 80%x2+1, heavy single
Back Squat - 80% x 3 x 5
SLDL - 3x5
WEEK 3
Monday
-
3-Position Snatch (floor, below knee, above knee) - 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%,
max
Snatch Pull - 100% (of sn) x 3 x 4
Back Squat - 70% x 5, 75% x 5, 80% x 5, 5RM
Push Press - 70% x 5, 75% x 5, 5RM
Tuesday
-
Power Clean - 70% x 3, 75% x 3, 80% x 3, 3RM
Power Jerk - 60% (of split jerk) x 3, 65% x
3, 70% x 3, 3RM
Overhead Squat - 70% x 3, 75% x 3, 80% x 3, 3RM
Wednesday
-
3-Position Clean (floor, below knee, above
knee) + Jerk - 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, max
Clean Pull - 100% (of cln) x 3 x 4
8 Week Olympic Weightlifting
-
40
Front Squat - 70% x 3, 75% x 3, 80% x 3, 3RM
Good Morning - 3x5
Thursday
-
Power Snatch - 70% x 3, 75% x 3, 80% x 3, 3RM
Snatch High-Pull - 75% (of sn) x 3 x 3, 80% x 3 x 2
Snatch Push Press + Overhead Squat - 70% (of sn or ohs) x 5+1, 75% x 5+1, 80%
x 5+1, max 5+1
Saturday
-
Snatch - 60%x2, 70%x2, 80%x1, heavy single
Clean & Jerk - 60%x2+1, 70%x2+1, 80%x1+1, heavy single
Back Squat - 70% x 3, 75% x 3, 80% x 3, 85% x 3, 3RM
SLDL - 3x5
WEEK 4
This is a recovery week. You’ll probably feel beat
up until the end of the week. Next week we start
pushing again.
Monday
-
Snatch - 60%x2, 65%x2x2, 70%x2x3
Snatch Pull - 90% (of sn) x 2 x 2,
95% x 2 x 2
Back Squat - 70% x 3 x 5
-
Power Clean - 70% x 2 x 5
Power Jerk - 60% (of split jerk) x 2 x 5
Push Press - 70% x 3 x 3
Tuesday
Greg Everett
Wednesday
-
Clean & Jerk - 60% x 2+1, 65% x 2+1 x 2, 70% x 2+1 x 3
Clean Pull - 90% (of cln) x 2 x 2,
95% x 2 x 2
Front Squat - 70% x 2 x 5
Thursday
-
Power Snatch - 70% x 2 x 5
Snatch Push Press + Overhead Squat - 70% x 3+1 x 4
Press - 3 x 5
Saturday December 22 2012
-
Snatch - 65%x2, 70%x2x2, 75%x1x2, 80%x1x3
Clean & Jerk - 65%x2+1, 70%x2+1x2, 75%x1+1x2, 80%x1+1x3
Back Squat - 75% x 2 x 4
WEEK 5
Like in previous weeks, take up the weight in the last
sets if you’re feeling good. Don’t push to maximum
effort.
Monday
-
Snatch - 60%x3, 65%x3, 70%x2, 75%x2x4
Snatch Pull - 100% (of sn) x 3 x 4
Back Squat - 70%x3, 75%x3x4
Push Press - 70%x5, 75%x5, 80%x3x3
-
Power Snatch - 70%x3, 75%x3, 80%x2x4
Power Clean + Power Jerk - 75%x1+1 x 5
Overhead Squat - 80% x 2 x 5
Tuesday
8 Week Olympic Weightlifting
41
Wednesday
-
Clean & Jerk - 60%x3+1, 65%x3+1, 70%x2+1, 75%x2+1x4
Clean Pull - 100% (of cln) x 3 x 4
Front Squat - 70%x2m 75%x2, 80%x2x3
SLDL - 3x5
Thursday
-
Power Snatch - 70%x2, 75%x2, 80%x1x4
Power Clean + Power Jerk
- 75%x2(1+1) x 5
Snatch Push Press + Overhead Squat - 70%x3+1, 75%x3+1, 80%x3+1
Saturday
-
Snatch - 60%x2, 70%x2, 75%x2, 80%x1, 85%x1, heavy single
Clean & Jerk - 60%x2+1, 70%x2+1, 80%x1+1, 85%x1+1, heavy single
Back Squat - 75% x 3, 80% x 3 x 4
SLDL - 3x5
WEEK 6
Take up the weight in the last sets if you’re feeling
good. Don’t push to maximum effort.
Monday
-
Snatch - 60%x3, 65%x3, 70%x2, 75%x2, 80%x2x3
Snatch Pull - 100% (of sn) x 3 x 2, 105% x 3x2
Back Squat - 70%x3, 75%x3, 80% x 3 x 3
Push Press - 70%x5, 75%x5, 80%x3, 85%
x3x2
Tuesday
-
Power Snatch - 70%x3, 75%x3, 80%x2x2,
Greg Everett
-
85%x2x2
Power Clean + Power Jerk - 75%x1+1 x 3, 80%x1+1x2
Overhead Squat - 80% x 2 x 2, 85% x  2 x 3
Wednesday
-
Clean & Jerk - 60%x3+1, 65%x3+1, 70%x2+1, 75%x2+1, 80%x2+1x3
Clean Pull - 100% (of cln) x 3 x 2,
105% x 2 x 2
Front Squat - 70%x2, 75%x2, 80%x2, 85%x2x3
SLDL - 3x5
Thursday
-
-
Power Snatch - 70%x2, 75%x2, 80%x1x2, 85%x1x2
Power Clean + Power Jerk - 75%x2(1+1) x 2, 80%x2(1+1)x2
Snatch Push Press + Overhead Squat
70%x3+1, 75%x3+1, 80%x3+1, 85%x3+1x2
Saturday
-
Snatch - 60%x2, 70%x2, 75%x2, 80%x1, 85%x1, 90%x1, heavy single
Clean & Jerk - 60%x2+1, 70%x2+1, 80%x1+1, 85%x1+1, 90%x1+1, heavy single
Back Squat - 75% x 3, 80% x 3 x 2, 85% x 3x2
Good Morning - 3x5
WEEK 7
Monday
-
Snatch - 60%x3, 65%x3, 70%x2, 75%x2, 80%x2, 2RM
Snatch Pull - 100% (of sn) x 3, 105% x 3, 110% x 3 x 2
8 Week Olympic Weightlifting
-
42
Back Squat - 70%x3, 75%x3, 80% x 3, 3RM
Push Press - 70%x3, 75%x3, 80%x2, 85%x1, 1RM
Tuesday
-
Power Snatch - 70%x3, 75%x2, 80%x1, 85%x1, 1RM
Power Clean + Power Jerk - 75%x1+1 x 2, 80%x1+1x3
Overhead Squat - 70%x2, 75%x2, 80%x1, 85%x1, 1RM
Wednesday
-
Clean & Jerk - 60%x2+1, 65%x2+1, 70%x2+1, 75%x2+1, 80%x2+1, 2+1RM
Clean Pull - 100% (of cln) x 3, 105%x3, 110%x3x2
Front Squat - 70%x2, 75%x2, 80%x2, 85%x2, 2RM
SLDL - 3x5
Thursday
-
Power Snatch - 70%x2, 75%x2, 80%x1, 85%x1x3
Power Clean + Power Jerk - 75%x1+1, 80%x1+1, 85%x1+1, 1+1RM
Snatch Balance - 70%x3x2, 75%x3x3
Saturday
-
Snatch - 60%x2, 70%x2, 75%x2, 80%x1, 85%x1, 90%x1, heavy single
Clean & Jerk - 60%x2+1, 70%x2+1, 80%x1+1, 85%x1+1, 90%x1+1, heavy single
Back Squat - 75% x 2, 80% x 2, 85% x 2, 2RM
Good Morning - 3x5
WEEK 8
Greg Everett
Monday
-
Snatch - 75%x2, 80%x1, 85%x1x3
Clean & Jerk - 75%x1+1, 80%x1+1, 85%x1+1
Clean Pull - 90% (of cln) x2, 95%x2x2
Back Squat - 75%x3, 80%x2, 85%x2x2
Tuesday
-
Snatch - 75% x 1 x 6
Power Clean & Jerk - 75%x1+1, 80%x1+1,
85%x1+1x3
Wednesday
-
Snatch - 75%x2, 80%x1x3
Snatch Pull - 90% (of sn) x 2 x 3
Front Squat - 75%x2, 80%x1, 85%x1
-
Power Snatch - 75%x2, 80%x2, 85%x2x3
Clean & Jerk - 70%x1+1, 75%x1+1x2
Thursday
Saturday
-
Snatch - max
Clean & Jerk - max
Front or Back Squat - max
Catalyst Athletics was founded in 2006 by Greg Everett in San
Diego county and relocated to Sunnyvale, CA in 2008. Catalyst
was a continuation of NorCal Strength and Conditioning in
Chico, CA, in which Everett was partnered with Robb Wolf and
Nicki Violetti. The Performance Menu journal was started by the
three in February 2005 and was taken over exclusively by Everett
in 2008, at which time it was merged with Catalyst Athletics to
form the company as it now exists.
Beast Training College
Football Preparation
Target Athlete:
Programing Duration:
Primary Focus:
Secondary Focus:
B
Erik Eggers
High School/College Football Player having solid Strength
Base
8 Week Offseason Training Cycle – Season Preparation
Increasing Explosive Power and Conditioning/GPP
Increasing Strength
east Training LLC designed this program to prepare a college athlete for his upcoming football season.
The athlete had been away from the game for several years, but had retained an above-average level
of strength from his general programming. Our goal was to focus on increasing his endurance, general
physical preparedness (“GPP”), and explosive power during this eight week programming cycle.
My dream is to play Division 1 College Football. I have one year of eligibility remaining. I haven’t played in
two years. I am going to walk-on to the program and I need you to train me and help me prepare physically
and mentally.
I didn’t believe him at first. It wasn’t that I didn’t believe he wanted to play. I did; I guess. It was just that
initially I doubted he was going to devote the time to perform the necessary work. I knew it was going to be
a tremendous amount of hard work and two years away from the game is a long time.
“Alex, listen. I have a lot going on right now, work, the gym, my kids’ sports, so I need you to really think
about this. If this isn’t something you are going to totally commit to, please don’t waste our time. I want you
to go home and really consider how badly you want this.”
“I want it badly,” he said.
“Come back this weekend and we can talk about it some more.”
Beast Training Eight Week
44
Erik Eggers
Alex came back and the rest is history.
My words sound harsh in retrospect - he must’ve caught me after an extra-long day. I was serious though.
We were either going to do it all the way or help facilitate Alex’s move into the next phase of his life (without
football).
Coincidentally, a week or so after I decided I was going to help Alex achieve his goal I attended a breakfast
meeting with his former High School Head Coach. We were discussing how Beast could best serve his latest
crop of football players. I’d casually mentioned I was in touch with Alex and he had come in to see me to
discuss making a football comeback and attempting to walk-on to a D1 program.
“Ah, it’s been too long. He’s been away from the game too long. He can’t do it, I don’t think,” he said, shaking
his head and pausing to grab a sip of lukewarm diner coffee. “It’s been too long.”
I’m not so sure about that. Where there is a will, there is a way.
The coach’s comments got me fired-up. I was angry he was doubting Team Alex – and now I was definitely
part of the team; I was all-in – those comments, that doubt galvanized my determination to provide whatever
guidance and assistance I could. We were going to crash the D1 Football Party with simple, yet effective and
intelligent programming. Coupled with Alex’s iron determination we were going to maximize his chances
of achieving the goal.
The complete Story of Alex is beyond the scope of this programming article, but it suffices to say he decided
he was committed to his stated goal. He did the programming (and more). He committed to making the
sacrifices and doing the work, which paved the way for what I consider one of the greatest sports triumphs
I have ever been fortunate enough to be involved with.
I’ve told him his story trumps that of Daniel “Rudy” Ruettiger, the young man who, against all odds, played
college football at Notre Dame. He thinks I’m joking. I assure you, I am not. I truly believe if we ever seriously
get pen to paper and memorialize Alex’s journey toward achieving his lifetime goal, we’ll have told a tale to
inspire generations to come.
As I look back, I am amazed at the simplicity of the programming. I believe in the end the program worked so
well because of the consistency with which it was performed. Remember, one of the keys to the development
of power and strength is showing up for all of the training. Alex did just that.
THE PROGRAM
Traditionally Beast employed the following split for our three-day a week football trainees:
TRAINING SESSION 1: Lower Body Strength
TRAINING SESSION 2: Upper Body Power/Strength
TRAINING SESSION 3: Lower Body Explosive Power
Beast Training Eight Week
45
Erik Eggers
HOWEVER, because this particular athlete already had an above-average strength base yet had been away
from football for so long, we were decided to primarily focus on his development of explosive power.
Additionally we felt an additional day to focus on GPP was optimal.
TRAINING SESSION 1: Lower Body Explosive Power/Strength
TRAINING SESSION 2: Upper Body Power/Strength
TRAINING SESSION 3: Hill Sprints or Prowler Sprints
TRAINING SESSION 4: Lower Body Explosive Power/Strength
Specific comments on the programming in the tables can be found throughout. We have placed the comments
after each table where applicable.
We began each workout with a dynamic warmup to properly prepare the body to handle the workload.
WEEK 1
TRAINING SESSION 1:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
Exercise:
5
Jumps
3
Jumps
Squats (reps listed)
5
Jumps
3
Jumps
3
Jumps
5
65%
GHR
10
10
Box Jumps
Band Resisted Box Jumps
Weighted Box Jumps
5
5
Jumps
75%
5
85%
AMRAP
85%
Prowler Sprints
Grappler Twists
TRAINING SESSION 2:
Upper Body Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
2 Board Bench
5
65%
5
75%
5
85%
AMRAP
85%
DB Bench
12
15
Exercise:
Lying Tri Extensions
12
15
15
Beast Training Eight Week
Body Weight Chins
46
AMRAP
Erik Eggers
AMRAP
AMRAP
Abdominal Circuit
30 Yds
TRAINING SESSION 3: Hill
Sprints or Prowler Sprints
30 Yds
TRAINING SESSION 4:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
Hex Deadlift
5
5
65%
65%
5
5
75%
75%
5
5
85%
85%
Backwards Sled Drags
30 Yds
5
85%
AM- 85%
RAP
30 Yds
Exercise:
Power Clean
30 Yds
30 Yds
Abdominal Circuit
Box Jumps – We do most of our jumps from a standing position (we don’t allow a step or a run-up to
the box). Jumps were initially performed on a box of moderate height. We increased the height to make
the jumps more challenging in subsequent weeks with the goal of exploding off the floor and sticking the
landing in the middle of the box. Band-resisted jumps were performed with an elitefts™ Pro Monster Mini
Resistance Band around the athletes waist to provide light resistance. Weighted jumps were performed
with very light dumbbells in each hand (i.e. 5 to 15lbs).
Prowler Sprints – we performed these with moderate weight – 30 yard sprints with a strict one minute
rest in between sets to simulate the cadence of a football game.
Grappler Twists – we typically performed 3 sets of fifteen reps with moderate weight.
2-Board Bench– we utilized a 2-Board bench throughout the cycle to reduce some of the shoulder stress
caused by full range of motion; other bench variations could be easily substituted without significantly
impacting the program.
AMRAP – As Many Reps as Possible. Here we prefer to leave one rep in the tank (stopping just shy of
complete failure).
Abdominal Circuit – our abdominal circuit varies. I am partial to a sample circuit I first saw on Joe Defranco’s
YouTube page. It consists of sprinter sit-ups, v-ups, toe touches, and hip ups. I believe that consistency with
abdominal training trumps exercise selection, so whatever exercises you ultimately choose, be consistent.
Hill Sprints or Prowler Pushes – exercise prescription for Hill Sprints is challenging – I suggest doing
them until you feel as though you are going to drop if you do one more. With regard to Prowler Pushes,
Beast Training Eight Week
47
Erik Eggers
please see above. We are prescribing one or the other – not both. If possible utilize a training cadence
similar to the pace of a football game (i.e. no more than one minute rest in between sets).
Power Clean – I am not a big proponent of the power clean because it is a very technical lift and can place
a lot of stress on an athlete’s elbows and wrists (especially when done with poor form). This particular
athlete was adept at the movement (he also really enjoyed performing them), so we incorporated it in his
training. Notwithstanding the aforementioned, I am partial to the benefits of triple extension – I recommend
substituting explosive Jump Shrugs for any athlete less versed in the power clean. We’ve done Jump Shrugs
with both a traditional barbell and a hex deadlift bar.
WEEK 2
TRAINING SESSION 1:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
Exercise:
5
Jumps
3
Jumps
Squats (reps listed)
5
Jumps
3
Jumps
3
Jumps
3
70%
GHR
10
10
Box Jumps
Band Resisted Box Jumps
Weighted Box Jumps
3
5
Jumps
80%
3
90%
AMRAP
90%
Prowler Sprints
Grappler Twists
TRAINING SESSION 2:
Upper Body Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
2 Board Bench
3
70%
3
80%
3
90%
AMRAP
90%
DB Bench
12
15
AMRAP
Exercise:
Lying Tri Extensions
Body Weight Chins
Abdominal Circuit
TRAINING SESSION 3: Hill
Sprints or Prowler Sprints
12
15
AMRAP
15
AMRAP
Beast Training Eight Week
48
Erik Eggers
TRAINING SESSION 4:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
5
12
12
65%
5
12
12
75%
5
12
12
85%
5
85%
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
95%
AMRAP
95%
Exercise:
Power Clean
Romanian DL
Bulgarian Split Squat
Abdominal Circuit
WEEK 3
TRAINING SESSION 1:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
Exercise:
5
Jumps
3
Jumps
Squats (reps listed)
5
Jumps
3
Jumps
3
Jumps
5
75%
GHR
10
10
Box Jumps
Band Resisted Box Jumps
Weighted Box Jumps
3
5
Jumps
85%
3
10
Prowler Sprints
Grappler Twists
TRAINING SESSION 2:
Upper Body Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
2 Board Bench
5
75%
3
85%
3
95%
AMRAP
95%
DB Bench
12
15
AMRAP
Exercise:
Lying Tri Extensions
Body Weight Chins
Abdominal Circuit
12
15
AMRAP
15
AMRAP
Beast Training Eight Week
49
Erik Eggers
TRAINING SESSION 3: Hill
Sprints or Prowler Sprints
TRAINING SESSION 4:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
Hex Deadlift
5
5
65%
75%
5
3
75%
85%
5
3
85%
95%
Backwards Sled Drags
30 Yds
5
85%
AM- 95%
RAP
30 Yds
Exercise:
Power Clean
30 Yds
30 Yds
Abdominal Circuit
On or about the third week of training, Alex called me one evening and asked if he should be waking in the
middle of the night to perform an additional training session. He’d been watching a Ray Lewis video and
was inspired to do more work. We simply told him to trust in the program and that he needed his sleep to
recover from the training.
Trust in the programming!
WEEK 4 DELOAD
TRAINING SESSION 1:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
Set 4
%
Exercise:
Box Jumps
GHR
5
Jumps
10
5
Jumps
10
5
Jumps
10
Grappler Twists
TRAINING SESSION 2:
Upper Body Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
5
10
50%
5
10
50%
5
15
50%
Exercise:
2 Board Bench
Body Weight Chins
Abdominal Circuit
TRAINING SESSION 3: Hill
Sprints or Prowler Sprints
Beast Training Eight Week
50
Erik Eggers
TRAINING SESSION 4:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
5
50%
5
50%
5
50%
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
Exercise:
Hex Deadlift
Abdominal Circuit
WEEK 5
TRAINING SESSION 1:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
Exercise:
Box Jumps Medium
Banded Box High
5
Jumps
5
Jumps
5
Jumps
5
Jumps
5
Jumps
5
Jumps
Max Jump Attempts
Squats (reps listed)
5
GHR
10
65%
5
75%
5
85%
AMRAP
85%
10
Prowler Sprints
Grappler Twists
TRAINING SESSION 2:
Upper Body Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
2 Board Bench
5
65%
5
75%
5
85%
AMRAP
85%
DB Incline Bench
12
15
12
15
15
AMRAP
AMRAP
AMRAP
Exercise:
Lying Tri Extensions Elbow
Out
Body Weight Chins
Abdominal Circuit
TRAINING SESSION 3: Hill
Sprints or Prowler Sprints
Beast Training Eight Week
51
Erik Eggers
TRAINING SESSION 4:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
Hex Deadlift
5
5
65%
65%
5
5
75%
75%
5
5
85%
85%
Backwards Sled Drags
30 Yds
5
85%
AM- 85%
RAP
30 Yds
Exercise:
Power Clean
30 Yds
30 Yds
Abdominal Circuit
Max Jump attempts in Week 5 were performed as single jumps to determine the maximal box height in
which athlete could stick the landing (again from a standing position).
Lying Tri Extensions Elbow Out – We perform these on an incline bench with the bells always in contact
with one another; begin from a top position and lower the bells together, with elbows out, until they touch
the chest; then extend to the top position using the triceps. There is a video on elitefts™ YouTube page that
shows a demonstration of this exercise – “Elitefts.com: EX index - Elbows Out Extensions s/s BW exten.”
WEEK 6
TRAINING SESSION 1:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
70%
5
3
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
80%
5
3
90%
AMRAP
AMRAP
90%
%
90%
Set 4
AMRAP
%
90%
Exercise:
Squats (reps listed)
5
3
GHR
10
Broad Jumps
10
10
Prowler Sprints
Grappler Twists
TRAINING SESSION 2:
Upper Body Power/Strength
2 Board Bench
Set 1
3
%
70%
Set 2
3
%
80%
Set 3
3
Beast Training Eight Week
DB Bench
Lying Tri Extensions Elbow
Out
Body Weight Chins
52
Erik Eggers
12
15
12
15
12
15
AMRAP
AMRAP
AMRAP
Abdominal Circuit
TRAINING SESSION 3: Hill
Sprints or Prowler Sprints
TRAINING SESSION 4:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
5
85%
Exercise:
Power Clean
Lateral High Hurdles
Backwards Sled Drags
Prowler Sprints
5
65%
5
30 Yds
30 Yds
5
75%
5
30 Yds
30 Yds
5
85%
5
30 Yds
30 Yds
30 Yds
30 Yds
Abdominal Circuit
Broad Jumps – these were simple broad (or long) jumps for distance from a standing position. We always have
the athlete attempt to stick the landing. Concentrate on good form with these and utilize arm swing.
Lateral High Hurdles – this is a lateral bounding exercise that can be performed either over a bench or a high
hurdle.
WEEK 7
TRAINING SESSION 1:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
75%
5
3
%
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
85%
5
3
95%
AMRAP
AMRAP
95%
%
Set 4
%
Exercise:
Squats (reps listed)
5
5
GHR
10
Broad Jumps
10
10
Prowler Sprints
Grappler Twists
TRAINING SESSION 2:
Upper Body Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
Beast Training Eight Week
53
Erik Eggers
Exercise:
2 Board Bench
5
DB Bench
12
15
12
15
12
15
AMRAP
AMRAP
AMRAP
Lying Tri Extensions Elbow
Out
Body Weight Chins
75%
3
85%
3
95%
AMRAP
95%
%
Set 4
%
85%
Abdominal Circuit
TRAINING SESSION 3: Hill
Sprints or Prowler Sprints
TRAINING SESSION 4:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
Exercise:
Power Clean
Lateral High Hurdles
Backwards Sled Drags
Prowler Sprints
5
65%
5
30 Yds
30 Yds
5
75%
5
30 Yds
30 Yds
5
85%
5
30 Yds
30 Yds
5
Set 1
Set 2
Set 3
%
Set 4
%
Set 4
%
30 Yds
30 Yds
Abdominal Circuit
WEEK 8 DELOAD
TRAINING SESSION 1:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
%
%
Exercise:
Box Jumps
GHR
5
Jumps
10
5
Jumps
10
5
Jumps
10
Grappler Twists
TRAINING SESSION 2:
Upper Body Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
5
10
50%
5
10
50%
5
15
50%
Exercise:
2 Board Bench
Body Weight Chins
Beast Training Eight Week
54
Erik Eggers
Abdominal Circuit
TRAINING SESSION 3: Hill
Sprints or Prowler Sprints
TRAINING SESSION 4:
Lower Body Explosive
Power/Strength
Set 1
%
Set 2
%
Set 3
%
5
0.5
5
0.5
5
0.5
Set 4
%
Exercise:
Hex Deadlift
Abdominal Circuit
BIO ERIK EGGERS
Erik Eggers graduated from the University of Connecticut with a BS in Finance. He is a Certified Strength and Conditioning Specialist
(“CSCS”) with the National Strength and Conditioning Association (“NSCA”) and has been involved in resistance training for the past
25 years. In competitive Powerlifting, Erik has held state records in the International and American Powerlifting Associations (“IPA”
and “APA”) and in Gene Rychlak’s Revolution Powerlifting Syndicate (“RPS”). Erik founded Beast Training (“Beast”), a warehouse
Strength and Conditioning facility located in Trumbull, Connecticut, where he served as its Strength and Conditioning Coordinator
from 2010 to 2013. Erik enjoys writing horror fiction and is an avid reader, particularly favoring the works of Stephen King, Chuck
Palahniuk, and Cormac McCarthy. He is periodically haunted by the “Deadlift Devil,” a fiendish apparition and source of woe who
frequently besieges his training platform, not unlike the ghost of Jacob Marley in the Charles Dickens’ classic, “A Christmas Carol.”
(Web: www.beastgym.com; YouTube: BeastTrainingLLC; Instagram: @beastllc, and Twitter @BEASTTRAINING)
12 Week Fat Loss
Alwyn Cosgrove
12 WEEK FAT LOSS TRAINING PROGRAM
Alwyn Cosgrove
Team Elitefts
12 Week Fat Loss
56
Alwyn cosgrove
Frequency Of Training
Note: when two sessions are listed for the same day, perform the strength training portion first.
Stage 1
Sun
Mon
Tue
Wed
OFF
Strength
B
Cardio
B
OFF
Strength
A
OFF
OFF
Strength
B
OFF
Strength
A
Cardio A
Tue
Wed
Strength
A
Cardio A
OFF
Strength
B
Cardio B
OFF
Strength
A
Cardio A
OFF
Strength
B
Cardio A
OFF
Strength
A
Cardio A
OFF
Strength
B
Cardio B
OFF
Strength
A
Cardio A
OFF
Strength
B
Cardio B
OFF
Strength
A
Cardio A
OFF
Cardio
B
Strength
B
Cardio B
OFF
Strength
A
Cardio A
OFF
Strength
B
Cardio B
OFF
Week Nine
Sun
Cardio
A
Mon
Strength
A
Cardio B
Wed
Strength
B
Thu
Cardio
A
Fri
Strength
A
Cardio B
Week Ten
Cardio
A
Strength
B
Cardio B
OFF
Strength
A
Cardio A
Cardio
B
Strength
B
Cardio A
OFF
Week
Eleven
Cardio
A
Strength
A
Cardio B
OFF
Strength
B
Cardio A
Strength
A
Cardio B
OFF
Week
Twelve
Cardio
A
Strength
B
Cardio B
OFF
Strength
A
Cardio A
Strength
B
Cardio A
OFF
Week One
Cardio
A
Strength
A
Week Two
Cardio
A
Week Three
Cardio
A
Strength
B
Cardio B
Strength
A
Week Four
Cardio
A
Stage 2
Sun
Week Five
OFF
Week Six
Cardio
B
Week
Seven
Week Eight
Stage 3
OFF
Strength
B
Cardio B
Mon
Tue
OFF
Thu
Fri
Strength
A
Sat
OFF
Cardio
B
Strength
B
Cardio A
Strength
A
OFF
Cardio
B
Strength
B
OFF
Thu
OFF
Cardio
B
Fri
OFF
Sat
Sat
OFF
12 Week Fat Loss
57
Exercise Protocols
Alwyn cosgrove
Cardio B:
We have two interval training modalities that we are
going to use for the duration of the program.
This second routine is a Heart rate based method.
With this method, work until your heart rate reaches
85% of your max, then recover until your heart rate
is at 70% or less. Obviously this means that the
Cardio A:
work and recovery time will be all over the place.
This is a general type of interval program. It’s not However, the cool part is that the “periodization”
complicated, it’s not pretty, but it’s extremely is built in. Just do as many rounds as you can
effective. Basically we’re beginning on a 1:2 work in the given time frame for the entire duration.
to rest ratio and progressing by week nine to a This will change as fitness improves, and may
1:1 ratio. In the example I’ve given I have used change day to day based on fatigue levels.
one minute work intervals. This is the upper limit
as I don’t believe most people can work for longer Weeks 1-4
than this at maximum intensity. However I have no
problems with you working for only 30 seconds, and Warm up for 3-5 mins
resting for one minute and working up to the one Perform as many work and recovery cycles based
on HR as you can in 20 mins.
minute work interval.
Recover with a slow walk for 3-5 mins.
The typical question I get asked as regards this type
of training is “how hard do I work?” The work period Weeks 5-8
should be around 8 or 9 on a scale of 1-10, and the
Warm up for 3-5 mins
recovery period should rate about a 5.
Perform as many work and recovery cycles based
on HR as you can in 25 mins.
The workout:
Recover with a slow walk for 3-5 mins.
Warm up 3-5 mins.
Weeks 9-12
Workout for the given “rounds”
Cool down 3-5 mins
Warm up for 3-5 mins
Perform as many work and recovery cycles based
Weeks 1-4:
One minute high intensity work, Two minutes easy on HR as you can in 30 mins.
Recover with a slow walk for 3-5 mins.
cardio, Repeat for 6 to 8 rounds
Strength Training
Weeks 5-8:
1 min high intensity work (higher than weeks 1-4),
90s recovery, Repeat for 8 to 10 rounds
The Complexes
Weeks 9-12:
One of the key components to this program is the
1 min high intensity work (again, this should use of barbell or dumbbell complexes. A barbell
continually be at a higher level), 1 min off, Repeat complex can be defined as two or more movements
for 10 to 12 rounds
performed in a sequence without rest using the
same load. Each Movement is performed through
a set number of reps before moving to the next
movement.
12 Week Fat Loss
58
Alwyn cosgrove
The advantage of this type of training is obvious – in a short period of time, in a limited
space, with limited equipment you can get a lot accomplished. The metabolic effect of
this type of work is unparalleled – you get increased work demand, use more muscle
groups, increase work capacity and massively increase caloric expenditure.
We will alternate between the use of two complexes in this program, however the
possibilities are endless and the trainee should not be afraid to come up with their own
variations. The rep ranges change every four weeks so adjust the loads accordingly.
Complex A:
Bent over Row
Hang Clean
Front Squat – push press
Back Squat
Good Morning
Wks 1-4: 4 x 8
Wks 5-8: 5 x 4
Wks: 9-12: 5 x 6Complex B:
Deadlift
Clean Pull
High pull
Reverse Lunge
Push Press
Wks 1-4: 4 x 8
Wks 5-8: 5 x 4
Wks: 9-12: 5 x 6
The Circuits:
The bulk of the program involves around a more traditional type of training. Each
workout will involve four exercises, alternating between upper and lower body
exercises, performed for various reps (according to the program phase) with short to
non-existent rest periods.
Circuit A:
Weeks 1-4Weeks 5-8
Bulgarian Split Squat
Push Ups
SHE
Seated Cable Row/DB Row
Squat
Inverted Row
SHELC
T-push Ups.
Weeks 9-12
Dynamic Lunge
Incline DB press
Romanian Deadlift
Bent over Row
12 Week Fat Loss
59
Alwyn cosgrove
Circuit B:
Weeks 1-4Weeks 5-8
Hip thigh Extension.
DB Military Press
DB Squat
Wide Grip Pulldown
Weeks 1-4:
Step Up
Close Grip Pulldown
Static Lunge
Db Rotational Press
Weeks 9-12
Deadlift
Prone Pike
Explosive Squat
Chins
Perform a total of three strength workouts per week on non-consecutive days. Alternate between
workouts A and B.
Energy system work:
Workout A
Order
Exercise
A Complex Sets
4
B1
Bulgarian Split Squat
Workouts one and four
4
Workouts two and five
2
Workouts three and six
3
Reps
8 ea.
6 each
20 ea.
12 ea.
Rest
90s
90s
30s
60s
B2
Push Ups
(use load/elevated feet for the low reps)
Workouts one and four
4
6 90s
Workouts two and five
2
20
30s
Workouts three and six
3
12
60s
B3
Supine Hip Extension
Workouts one and four
4
6
Workouts two and five
2
20.
Workouts three and six
3
12.
B4
Seated Cable Row/ DB row
Workouts one and four
4
6
Workouts two and five
2
20.
Workouts three and six
3
12.
90s
30s
60s
90s
30s
60s
Note:
A1, A2, A3 etc are supersets. Perform one set of each exercise in a circuit format, until you have completed all the work
sets.
Workout B
Order
Exercise
A Complex Sets
4
B1
Hip thigh Extension
Workouts one and four
3
Workouts two and five
4
Workouts three and six
2
Reps
8 ea.
Rest
90s
/ Single leg Glute bridge
12 60s
6
90s
20
30s
12 Week Fat Loss
60
B2
DB Military Press
Workouts one and four
Workouts two and five
Workouts three and six
B3
DB Squat
Workouts one and four
Workouts two and five
Workouts three and six
Alwyn cosgrove
3
4
2
12
6
20
60s
90s
30s
3
4
2
12 6 20
60s
90s
30s
B4
Wide Grip Pull down
3
Workouts one and four
Workouts two and five
4
Workouts three and six
2
/Pull Up
12 each
6 ea.
20 ea.
60s
90s
30s
Note:
A1, A2, A3 etc are supersets. Perform one set of each exercise in a circuit format,
until you have completed all the work sets.
Motion – again, concentrate on moving one vertebra at a time,
until you are in the fully stretched position. Weeks 5-8:
Perform a total of three strength workouts per week on nonconsecutive days. Alternate between workouts A and B.
Workout A
Order
Exercise
A Complex
Sets
5
Reps
4 ea.
B1
Squat
Workouts one and four 4
4
90s
Workouts two and five 2
12.
30s
Workouts three and six
3
8.
Rest
20s
60s
B2
Inverted Row
Workouts one and four 4
4
90s
Workouts two and five 2
12.
30s
Workouts three and six
3
8.
60s
B3
SHELC
Workouts one and four 4
Workouts two and five 2
Workouts three and six
B4
T-push ups
Workouts one and four 4
Workouts two and five 2
Workouts three and six
4
90s
12.
30s
3
8.
60s
4
90s
12.
30s
3
8.
60s
12 Week Fat Loss
61
Alwyn cosgrove
Note:
A1, A2, A3 etc are supersets. Perform one set of each exercise in a circuit format,
until you have completed all the work sets.
Workout B
Order
Exercise
A Complex
Sets
5
Reps
4 ea.
B1
Step Up
Workouts one and four 3
8 each
60s
Workouts two and five 4
4 ea.
90s
Workouts three and six
2
12 ea.
B2
Close Grip Chins
Workouts one and four 3
8 60s
Workouts two and five 4
4 90s
Workouts three and six
2
12 B3
Split Squat
Workouts one and four 3
Workouts two and five 4
Workouts three and six
Rest
120s
30s
30s
8 each
60s
4 ea.
90s
2
12 ea.
30s
B4
DB Rotational Shoulder Press
Workouts one and four 3
8 each
60s
Workouts two and five 4
4 ea.
90s
Workouts three and six
2
12 ea.
30s
Note:
A1, A2, A3 etc are supersets. Perform one set of each exercise in a circuit format,
until you have completed all the work sets.
Weeks 9-12:
Perform three times per week on non-consecutive days. Alternate
between workouts A and B.
Energy system work:
Workout A
Order
Exercise
A Complex
Sets
5
B1
Dynamic Lunge
Workouts one and four
4
Workouts two and five
2
Workouts three and six
3
B2
Inc DB Press
Workouts one and four
4
Workouts two and five
2
Reps
6 ea.
Rest
90s
5 each 90s
15 ea.
10 ea.
30s
60s
5
15
90s
30s
12 Week Fat Loss
Workouts three and six
62
3
Alwyn cosgrove
10
B3
Romanian Deadlift
4
5 each 90s
Workouts one and four
Workouts two and five
2
15 ea.
Workouts three and six
3
10 ea.
B4
Bent Over Row
Workouts one and four
4
Workouts two and five
2
Workouts three and six
3
5 each 90s
15 ea.
10 ea.
60s
30s
60s
30s
60s
Note:
A1, A2, A3 etc are supersets. Perform one set of each exercise in a circuit format,
until you have completed all the work sets.
Workout B
Order
Exercise
A Complex B1
DB Deadlift
Workouts one and four
Workouts two and five
Workouts three and six
Sets
5
Reps
6 ea.
Rest
90s
3
4
2
10
5 15 90s
60s
30s
B2
Prone Pike –push up combo
3
10 ea.
Workouts one and four
Workouts two and five
4
5 ea.
Workouts three and six
2
15 ea.
B3
Explosive Squat/Jump Squat
Workouts one and four
3
10
Workouts two and five
4
5 Workouts three and six
2
15 B4
Wide Grip Pull ups/Pull downs
Workouts one and four
3
10
Workouts two and five
4
5 Workouts three and six
2
15 Note:
90s
60s
30s
90s
60s
30s
90s
60s
30s
A1, A2, A3 etc are supersets. Perform one set of each exercise in a circuit format,
until you have completed all the work sets.
12 Week Fat Loss
63
Alwyn cosgrove
Alwyn Cosgrove
Alwyn is a Tae kwon-do international champion and has utilized his personal
experience as an athlete and combined it with the advanced theories of European
Sports Science and the principles of modern strength and conditioning systems.
He worked with a wide variety of clientele, including several Olympic and
national level athletes, five World Champions and professionals in a multitude
of sports including boxing, martial arts, soccer, ice skating, football, fencing,
triathlon, rugby, bodybuilding, dance and fitness competition.
http://www.alwyncosgrove.com
Knee Integrity:
Building Better Knees
JL Holdsworth
I
have trained several world champions in Brazilian
Jiu Jitsu: white, blue, purple, brown belts and I’ll
have a black belt world champion soon. Two joints
that take a lot of punishment and are the primary
injury spots for BJJ athletes are the shoulders and
knees. When Vitor Oliviera (current 6th best absolute
black belt in the world) came to start training with
me two years ago, he had some knee issues. I needed
to find a way to strengthen everything around
the joint so he could compete more often and at a
higher level. Although this program started with
BJJ athletes in mind, we use it for all of our athletes
and have had tremendous success in rehabbing and
preventing new knee injuries.
or knees (like myself), the jumping may not be an
option, as you must be able to do it pain free for it to
be an exercise choice for you.
Let’s start by looking at the exercises in this program.
I have divided the exercises into two categories:
Strength work and Density work. In all of these
exercises, how you perform them is of utmost
importance. Cheating, or not doing them correctly
could result in a negative effect on your knee health. I
have included some basic exercises without pictures
as they are commonly done or have been written
about extensively. Although with some exercises,
you may wonder why I prescribe them, but you have
to remember that in order to really protect the knee,
The injury itself, your level of fitness, how much you must strengthen everything around it.
pain and where the pain is coming from will
determine how often or at what level of resistance Strength Work
you can perform the following exercises. Obviously,
someone needs to start out very light if just coming Step back - Start at a comfortable height to complete
off an injury and work up slowly as to not agitate it. and add height as you progress. 18’’ being the target
I like to use the 80% rule. Do 80% of what you think goal for this exercise. Bring your heel to back end of
you are capable and if you don’t hurt the next day, box, step back lightly touching heel to the ground &
then you can bump it up a little.
coming back up.
For healthy athletes the jumping work is very
Step Down (w/variations)- Healthy individuals
important and helps to build stronger ligaments,
should be able to do this off of a 10’’ box but I have
tendons and cartilage. For people with bad injuries
Knee Integrity
65
had people start as low as 3’’. Start with your toe at
the very edge of the box. Slowly and under control
step down off the box tapping your heel gently to
the ground and returning back up. Once you have
mastered this off at least an 8’’ box then you can
move up to the banded version. This combines a
TKE (Terminal Knee Extension) with the step down.
Lastly, you can move on to the heel elevated banded
version. This is extremely difficult for someone who
has had knee issues and should be saved until the
other versions have been mastered.
JL Holdsworth
extended and pull back slowly (don’t jerk) through
your full range of motion. Keep the foot close to the
ground at all times.
Sled leg curl/Leg extension - Load a pulling sled
with a weight that you can complete the whole
exercise with in good form. Loop the end of a pulling
strap around your ankle. Place your supporting
foot several inches behind your foot (ahead for
extensions) with the strap. Pull the sled through the
full range of motion while maintaining your posture.
Step back and repeat (step forward for extension).
TKE- Choke a band around a stationary object and
put it behind your knee. Let your knee bend slightly Quadruped internal isometric (perturbation &
then fully lock out the knee joint, contracting the rotation) - Choke a mini band around something
quads as much as possible.
stationary. Start on all fours with the band around
your ankle pulling you towards the stationary object.
Banded anterior tib pumps - Sit on the ground Ensure that your hip and knee is at 90° with your
with legs straight out in front. Wrap a band, that is ankle is direct line with your knee (Left pic). Pick
choked on an object, around your toes. Then allow your knee and toe off the ground an inch and hold
the foot to be pulled into plantar flexion (toe down) isometrically in that position. Perturbation (middle
and then pull up and squeeze into dorsiflexion (toe pic) is where you hold same position but someone
up).
moves the band and you try to keep foot still, resisting
and stabilizing against movement. Rotation (right
Standing calf raise - Make sure that you do these pic) is where you let the band externally rotate your
hip and then bring it back to the start position and
one leg at a time and get a 2s hold at the top.
hold for 2s.
Leg extension - Make sure that you do these one leg
at a time and get a 2s hold at the top. Depending on Quadruped external isometric (perturbation &
the knee injury this may limit your range of motion rotation) - Same set up as above but the band will
and/or ability to do this exercise.
be pulling your ankle towards the stationary object
from the outside. Make sure to let the band go over
GHR - If you don’t know what this is by now then top of the leg that is closest to whatever you attach
band to. Obviously the other two variations are the
go to elitefts.com and do a search.
same.
Banded adductor - Choke band to a stationary
object. From a standing position hook band around Guard (Partner) external/internal isometric
ankle and bring it across in front of your other foot. (perturbation & rotation) - In BJJ, you use the
Let it return and repeat. Hold for 2s each contraction. guard position but this is also great for team or group
Banded leg curl - Sit on a bench that is far enough settings where you need to get more people through
from the object you have choked the band to so quicker. This is great for any athlete and you will
that there is never slack in the band. Adjust band quickly see some weaknesses show through.
thickness based on your strength level. Hook the Density work (for relatively healthy athletes)
band around your ankle. Start with the leg fully
Knee Integrity
66
One leg Land & stick hop - This exercise is done
just as the pictures below, only on the ground and
not on a balance pad. Make sure that you can land
and hold for one second with good balance before
moving on to the balance pad.
One leg Land & stick over hurdle (height based
on athlete ability) - Same concept as exercise
below only you jump over a hurdle and stick landing
on the other side. Start with a 6’’ hurdle and then
move to 12’’ and finally an 18’’ hurdle.
One Leg Land & stick on balance pad - Start
with one leg on balance pad. Hop up and land in
good position with butt slightly back and weight
decelerated through glutes and hamstrings.
Depth Jumps - Start at a height that is 75% of the
persons max box jump for double legged. Unless
they can do this with good form they should not
move on to single leg depth jumps. Start at 50% of
max for single leg depth jumps. These are only for
your most advanced athletes who are healthy, this is
not for rehabbing purposes.
So now that you know how to do the exercises, let
me explain how to use them. For rehab purposes,
you can use them as your primary workout. For
everyone else I recommend either putting it before
lower body workouts or scheduling other days of
the weeks to complete the work. For BJJ and other
combat athletes, I recommend doing them 2x/wk.
For other athletes with healthy knees, 1x/wk can be
sufficient. But if you have the time, doing both days
would be beneficial as well
In the table all exercises with A1, A2 are referring to
a circuit and should be done consecutively. The rest
interval is not after each exercise but rather after
the circuit is completed. Sets/reps and the level of
difficulty can all be adjusted based on health of knee
and work capacity of athlete. The examples below
are examples to start with.
JL Holdsworth is one of the most experienced, knowledgeable,
JL Holdsworth
and educated strength coaches in the world. His unique blend
of experiences as a collegiate athlete, strength coach at the
University of Kentucky, professional powerlifter, (forced)
rehabilitation expert, grip strength specialist, and small business
owner gives him a unique perspective and range of knowledge
that most coaches don’t have. Owner of The Spot Athletics, JL has
helped produce numerous state, national, and world champions
in various sports. His personal best competition lifts to date
are a 905-pound squat, a 775-pound bench, and an 804-pound
deadlift. Although he has many letters behind his name from
certifications and a degree, the most important letters to JL are
BAMF.
Common Training Mistakes
for Aspiring Women Competitors
Alexander Cortez
O
ne of the fastest growing categories in
bodybuilding right now is the bikini,
physique, and figure divisions. At any show,
there is an ample amount of female competitors,
and classes are becoming increasingly crowded.
1. Not Training Heavy Enough
Women as a gender tend to have less overall
type II muscle fiber than men do, and this often
makes them predisposed to be better and more
comfortable with higher repetitions. This presents
To use general terms, for any women competing a common problem, as many women simply do not
in any physique category, the dedication to train lift weights heavy enough to build any appreciable
is identical to that of any bodybuilder. However, muscle, and instead spend time training endurance
there are unique training considerations that over and over again, with no progress to show for it.
need to be considered for women that are truly
interested in dedicating themselves to a competition This is partly a psychological issue, as I have
and the overall lifestyle of a physique athlete. found with many of my female clients, they are
often upset initially that they can only do 5-6
Having a solid amount of experience training female reps with a weight, and they are determined to
clients, I can definitely say that women present do 10. Because of this, I always breakdown to
their own unique set of challenges that arise them the basics of muscle building physiology,
during training, and for the uniformed trainer or the differences in fiber sizes, how muscle is
trainee, progress can be incredibly slow or grind remodeled through damage, progressive overload,
to halt. Often times this is simply due to lack of and overall, why they HAVE TO lift heavy (relative
awareness of certain issues that may be inhibiting to them) if they truly want to see body changes
progress. Or it could be lack of understanding of
the unique training needs that women present. Working with bikini competitors, I have encountered
the same common issue over and over again of
Regardless, I decided to break down and analyze a woman being told that she needs to fill out X
as many of these common and not so common muscle group, say glutes and hamstrings, but
problems as I could. Some of these are extremely she continues to do the exact same workouts she
basic, other not so much. For all the women that was doing prior, with no differences in weight.
are new to training, and even for the ones that are
not, this list should hopefully be an informative look As you can imagine, one of the first changes I will
that helps to guide you in making your own process suggest making is incorporating lower rep sets
more effective.
in the 3-8 repetition range, and recommending
Common Mistakes
68
Alexander Cortez
alternating 3-4 weeks period of heavier lifting with
3-4 week periods of higher volume. Combined with
proper diet, this spurs new muscle growth that may
not have been happening prior.
The exercise hierarchy of effectivity, and basic
muscle physiology explain this. If you want to create
major changes, you must use major movements, and
that starts with the execution of the basics.
It goes without saying that women do not have
the same testosterone levels or natural levels of
strength as men. Men have not only larger muscles,
but greater levels of neuromuscular innervation.
Let me qualify this statement first, there has been
some confusion in today’s training environment
as to what the term “plyometrics” signifies. I’m
not referring to technical plyometrics, but the
now common definition of repeated jumps. If this
statement is confusing, understand that plyometrics
were first conceived as a low volume, very specific
way of training explosive reaction and power in
athletes. They had precise jumping and landing
guidelines. The usage of them was on a low
volume basis for short periods of time in training.
2. Undeveloped Mind Muscle Connection
Subsequently, many women who have never
lifted will often have trouble “feeling” a muscle
working when they first attempt to lift weights.
4. Not Utilizing “Plyometrics”
Addressing the psychology of this issue, women are
often fixated on the “toning and burning” mentality,
and they want the movements they do to give them
that fatigued sensation. Problem though, is that they Now, plyometrics are simply a catch all
end up fixating on triceps kickbacks and that seated term that refers to anything that is “jumpy”,
abductor machine, and not a squat or a pushup is done. and covers everything from box jumps to
hops, leaps, and everything else in between.
I always explain this to my novice female clients
that they shouldn’t expect to automatically “feel So yeah, plyometrics. If you are a female
the burn” when lifting heavy weights on compound physique athlete of any kind, I would really
movements, especially for lower reps. After a session recommend incorporating them into training.
or two when they report back being more sore than
they ever have been in their life, they usually drop Why is this? Simple, they are an explosive movement
that stimulates the growth of type II muscle fibers.
the “toning” mindset readily.
Additionally, I’ve had many women express to me
that their lower half got much leaner after utilizing
3. Favoring Isolation Movements
plyometrics in their training. Not so scientific, but
Following the lack of mind/muscle connection I’ll take it as evidence that clearly they are doing
and fitting into the “burn” mindset, women something beneficial.
often
which
in the
easier
gravitate towards isolation movements,
by their very nature are far more acute 5. Not Enough Volume or Intensity
small muscles they stimulate, and much
to “feel” than the compound movements. Whenever I open women’s health magazines, I’m
always disappointed to see how low volume and
While these movements can have their place, low intensity the routines are. Often it is nothing
the majority of training should not be comprised but a few “activation” type bodyweight movements.
of this. There is no replacement for properly As such, it seems to be a common issue with novice
performed squats, presses, pulls, and rows. female lifters that they will end up following either
one, or both of these lower volume or low intensity
routines.
Common Mistakes
69
For example, I’ve observed a woman may do
something like a dumbbell shoulder press, 3 sets
of 15, and not once during any set do they strain,
struggle, or really exert too much of an effort to
move the weight.
Add in a similar set for some lateral raises, and that
concludes the entirety of the shoulder training.
As you can imagine, no one is going to make
progress training this way.
Your working sets should be with weights heavy
enough that you must exert mental focus and effort
to complete the set. You should not be able to throw
this kind of weight around easily. It is the kind of
weight where proper form is crucial to avoid injury,
and necessary to maximize results.
6. Neglecting Strength Development
These all intertwine with each other, clearly.
Neglecting strength is a common issue, and one I
feel arises simply because women are not often told
that they are unable to get strong in the first place.
Alexander Cortez
they were gymnasts, dancers, or crossfitters, they
all trained with bodyweight movements. While
most men wont get “big” with just bodyweight,
bodyweight exercises are absolutely fantastic
for women’s muscular growth. They are easy to
progress, easy to assess, quick to recover from,
and they can be utilized in most every workout.
Any women who can rep out 10 chin-ups, 20 pushups
and bust out high reps of jump squats, is going to
have excellent upper and low body development
while being very lean. While these might seem like
difficult goals, like anything else, they take time.
See an example in this month’s training section
on what a solid program looks like for a female
competitor with bodyweight work incorporated
into it.
8. Neglecting Weak Points
Men certainly do this as well, but it is the inverse
of women. For most men, upper body is the
greatest area of focus, and legs get neglected.
For women, the lower body tends to be their
strong suit, and upper body is secondary.
It certainly takes more time for women
than men to build their strength in the big Depending on your division, some women need
lifts, but in no way is it impossible. All it more upper body development than others. If
requires is dedicated training and patience. you are competing in fitness, figure, physique, I
can say without hesitation that your upper half
For many professional female physique athletes should be getting trained high frequency around
I have spoken with, their strength levels are, in 4x weekly. The upper body for women can take far
fact, how they gauge their physique progress. longer to develop than the lower body, and should
Over the years in which they trained, they be prioritized in training. An example of this high
realized there was a direct correlation to the frequency would be the following
progress in the mirror and the weights on the bar.
Day 1-Lower body - quad focus, abdominals
This is a mindset more women need to adopt in Day 2-Upper body - chest and back
training, and not just focus on the short term.
Day 3-Lower body - deadlifts, hamstring and glute focus
7. Not Enough Bodyweight Movements
Day 4-Upper body - shoulders, arms, abs
The most developed and impressive female Day 5-Upper body - back training
physiques I have seen have all had one thing in
common; high volume bodyweight training. Whether
Common Mistakes
70
In this way, you are working back 3x weekly (with
chest, with deadlifts, and a dedicated back day) and
the pressing muscles twice weekly. Depending on
recovery, you could even add in another light pump
day for shoulders or arms, if you wished.
9. Neglecting Stabilizers and Synergists
Say you are a woman that is training hard and
heavy, and you are making progress—but you start
getting anterior shoulder pain that won’t go away,
or you have patella pain that comes and goes.
This is not uncommon. Women have smaller joints
and more lax connective tissue than men, and
while high volume works well, it also increases
the chance of overuse injuries or general joint
aggravation.
To remedy this, perform the following as part of
your warm-up:
Upper body days - extra rotator cuff work, band
pull aparts for the rhomboids and rear delts.
Lower body days - high rep hyperextensions for
glutes and low back, pulse lunges for VMO and
glute medius.
Maintaining a balance of pushing/pulling
movements (2:1 ratio being the best), as well as
lower body unilateral work, will go a long ways
towards preventing injuries.
10. Not Modifying Training According to
Menstrual Cycle
Depending on where a woman is at in her monthly
menstrual cycle, she could be feeling high energy,
feeling sluggish, be experiencing extra water
retention, having higher or lower pain tolerance,
or potentially be at greater risk for an injury.
Alexander Cortez
For both the trainers and trainees, it is important
to be aware of this. There is evidence that female
athletes are actually more likely to get ACL tears
during the week of menstruation, and even
for someone not competing on the field, this is
relevant information. Temporary anemia would
make it wise to taper back the volume, and
changes in estrogen and testosterone levels can
make a particular week a bad time to push heavy.
Every woman is a bit different, make sure your
training is working with your body and not against it.
Overall, an aspiring female competitor should
realize that this lifestyle is one that is constant
learning process, and be willing to question and
change things that are not working. Hopefully these
insights can help both the women and men out there
be better athletes and better trainers as well. Should
anyone have any questions, as always feel free to ask
me in the Q&A, or directly on Facebook as well.
Alexander is a new addition to the EliteFTS team, and is fiercely
proud of it. A former ballet dancer who became an iron disciple
after using traditional barbell lifting to recover from injury,
Alexander lives and works by the mantra of being strong(er).
In 2008 after injuries he needed a cane just to walk, but after
reading Dave Tate’s Under the Bar, he made a choice that he
would never be weak again. Coming from a non-traditional
athletic background, with a degree in Dance Choreography,
Alexander is an intense study of the psychology and science of
how and why we train. Currently dually studying for his CSCS
and masters in exercise science, he has trained hundreds of
clients as a personal trainer since 2009, and will be lifting in his
first powerlifting meet in 2013. He currently is a fitness coach at
UFC Gym in Corona, CA, and he has begun writing on strength
and life on his blog, Godsofstrength.com
Foundational
Training Mike Kozak
I
have been in the private sector of strength
and conditioning for over 10 years now. One
major thing that I have learned is that properly
developing 12 – 14 year old athletes is critical to the
ongoing success of my business. First of all, there
is no shortage of average young athletes in Central
Ohio. I have written an article on this in the past: if
you are looking to only cater to the elite athletes, you
might want to rethink your business plan. Secondly,
if you do a great job of training these kids, you are
setting yourself up to get their business for 5 or
more years.
Taking into consideration that my average 13
year old athlete either plays 2 or more sports or
participates in year round practice for one sport, my
typical foundational program is set up for 2 days per
week of training. Our sessions are set up for 75 - 90
minutes of training that are comprised of flexibility/
mobility, plyometrics, speed or agility training and
then strength and power development. Early in the
week, our speed focus is linear and later in the week
our focus is lateral acceleration/deceleration. Our
plyometrics are set up to match the speed emphasis
- so typical linear and vertical plyos are set for
early in the week and lateral hops and set for later
in the week. We also do some agility ladder drills
on our lateral days. Keep in mind that our speed/
agility work is kept to 6 – 10 sets of drills lasting 2
– 6 seconds. We are not just running kids through
30 minutes of hurdle and cone drills for the sake
of saying we do SAQ. The goal of that portion of
the program is to learn proper movement skills and
then continueing to work on putting force into the
ground at the right angles.
The 12 week program I have provided is broken
down into three, four week phases. With that being
said, these are templates and nothing is set in stone
for each kid. I know everyone fears the dreaded
cookie cutter program - in this instance everyone
starts with the same cookie, but it is decorated
differently for each kid. For instance, Phase 2 has “1
leg squat or variation” programmed on Day 1. Some
young kids just simply do not have the strength to
bodyweight ratio to do this, so we might use a step
up instead. For bodyweight exercises like pushups,
our ultimate goal is to do QUALITY push ups from
the floor. But my average 12 – 14 year old needs
to begin with the hands on an elevated box or bar.
As time goes on, we lower the box and progress to
the floor. However, I have some pretty advanced
12 year olds that put there feet on box for push ups.
My suggestion would be to take the templates that I
have provided and begin to tailor them to the needs
of each individual kid that you train. For some, you
might not have to make any changes. For others,
you might have to change half the exercises. It is not
uncommon in our gym for a kid to have a sheet that
Foundational training
72
Mike Kozak
has all kinds of exercises crossed out, notes made and arrows pointing everywhere. If that is what it takes
for kid to get a quality workout, then that is what we do.
One more note. We rotated various weighted carrys or famers walks on a week to week basis. You will see
these programmed on Day 1. We start all new kids with a basic 2 arm farmers carry with KBs. As time
goes on, we might move to suitcase (1 arm) carries or other versions that we feel are appropriate. The
same goes for our sled work. Our beginners always begin with sled pushes. As time goes on, we progress
to walks, backward drags and lateral drags.
Mike Kozak is the owner of SOAR Fitness Systems in Lewis Center OH. For questions about this program, email him at mikekozak03@
gmail.com.
Day 1
Date
Foundational Training - Level 1
Date
Date
Date
Foam Roll/warm up
1 leg plyo
paired with breathing/
brace in supine
Hop and stick
in ladder
Hop and stick
Box blast
in ladder
Box blast
Box jump
2x5
3x5
3x6
3x6
Prone bridge
2x20sec
2x25sec
2x30sec
2x30sec
2x -
3x
3x
3x -
2x5e
3x5e
3x6e full
3x8e full
2x8
3x8
3x10
3x10
2x8e
2x8e
3x8e
3x10e
2x4
2x4
2x5
2x5
2x5e
2x5e
2x5e
2x5e
2x50yds
2x250yds
2x50yds
2x50yds
T and Y 2x
10sec
T and Y
2x10sec
Linear speed
Hip program
Push up – reps then ISO box or bar if nec
Split squat 5 sec ISO from
bottom up weeks 1 and 2
TRX row - last rep ISO
1 leg RDL – bodyweight
or with cable
2 leg glute bridges - 5sec
MB fwd overhead throw
w step
Farmers walk
Day 2
Foam Roll/warm up
Date
Date
Date
Date
Ladder/lateral hops
Agility – lateral accel/
decel
Shoulder stability/mobility
T – 2x10sec
T – 2x10sec
Foundational training
MB push press throw or
box jump
Side bridge variation
DB chest press
Front Squat - KB if nec last rep ISO
Band assisted NG Chin up
– finish w ISO –
2 leg hip lift on floor
Sled Pushes
MB chest pass
73
2x5
3x5
3x6
3x6
2x15sec e
2x6
2x15sec e
2x8
2x20sec e
3x8
2x20sec e
3x10
2x8
3x8
3x10
3x10
2xmr
3xmr
3xmr
3xmr
2x8
4x10yds
3x8
4x10yds
3x10
4x15yds
3x10
4x15yds
2x10
2x10
2x12
2x12
mr - max quality reps
Day 1
Date
Foam Roll/warm up
1 leg plyo
2 leg plyo
Linear speed
Supine hip flex hold
Olympic Progression using
MB
Prone bridge - toes on box
Inc DB
1 leg squat or variation
1 arm cable row
1 leg RDL - cable
Half get up
MB slam
Day 2
Mike Kozak
e – each side
Foundation Phase 2
Date Date
Date
1 leg box
Box jump w
apr
1 leg box
Box jump w
apr
1 E leg box
1 leg E box
E box jump
E box jump
2x10sec
2x10sec
2x12sec
2x12sec
3x5
3x5
3x5
3x5
2x20sec
3x6
3x6e
3x8e
3x6e
2x8e
2x10
2x25sec
3x8
3x8e
3x8e
3x6e
2x8e
2x10
2x30sec
3x10 8 6
3x10e
3x10e
3x8e
2x10e
2x12
2x30sec
3x8
3x6e
3x10e
3x8e
2x10e
2x12
Date
Farmers walk
Date Date
Date
Foam Roll/warm up
Ladder/lateral hops
Agility
Shoulder circuit - wall
slides, quadruped rotations
KB swing – nec
progression
Side bridge variation
3x8
3x8
3x10
3x10
2x15sec
2x15sec
2x20sec
2x20sec
Push ups
3x
3x
3x
3x
Foundational training
Front squat – KB or bar
Chin up
SB Leg curl - ecc if nec
Sled drags or pushes
H. Kn chop – MB
74
Mike Kozak
3x6
3x
3x6
3x8
3x
3x8
3x10
3x
3x10
4x6
3x
3x10
2x10
2x10
2x12
2x12
Stretch
Day 1
Foundational Training - Level 3
Date
Date
Date
Date
Foam Roll/warm up
Power skip
Forward Hurdle jump
Linear speed
Supine cable hip flexion
Snatch - DB or bar
Prone bridge -1 leg
Bench press
FE split squat - or
progression
Seated row
1 leg RDL
Half get up w hip lift
MB H. Kn Rot throw
2x5e
2x12
2x5e
2x12
2x6e
2x12
2x6e
2x12
2x10e
2-3x3
2x12sec e
3x6
2x10e
2-3x3
2x12sec e
3x8
2x10e
2-3x 4
2x15sec e
3x10 8 6
2x10e
2-3x4
2x15sec e
3x6
3x6e
3x8e
3x10e
3x6e
3x8
3x6e
2x6e
2x10
3x10
3x6e
2x6e
2x10
3x12
3x8e
2x8e
2x12
3x8
3x8e
2x8e
2x12
Stretch
Day 2
Date
Date
Foam Roll/warm up
Ladder/lateral hops
Agility
Blackburn holds - T W Y
DB squat jump
Side bridge – feet on box
H. Kn. DB military
KB or TB dead lift
Chin up
Hip thrust – back on bench
- band or chain resisted
Half Kn cable chop
Sled work
TRX row
Farmers walk
Date
Date
2x10sec
3x5
2x15sec
3x6e
3x5
3x
2x10sec
3x5
2x15sec
3x6e
3x5
3x
2x10sec
3x6
2x20sec
3x8e
3x6
3x
2x10sec
3x6
2x20sec
3x8e
3x6
3x
3x8
3x8
3x10
3x10
2x10e
2x10e
2x10e
2x10e
2xmr
2xmr
2xmr
2xmr
Creating a More
Powerful You
Josh Bryant
O
power.
n the field of play, the determining factors
between the all-stars and those picking
splinters out of their rear ends are speed and
For the no longer competiti-ve sportsmen,
possessing power can mean reigning victorious in
any situation; from a self-preservation situation
at the local kick n’ stab, to a gold medal at the next
dwarf tossing competition.
Power simply means the ability to develop force
rapidly. Developing high amounts of force slowly is
great for powerlifting… but not much else.
This program is all about creating a more powerful
you!
If you are not technically proficient in the Olympic
Lifts, do not do this program.
Guidelines
When weights are not given for accessory
movements, the instructions are simple, go as
heavy as possible without sacrificing technique and
completing the allocated number of reps. On dips
and pull-ups, add weight if applicable.
If specified weights feel too light, move the weight
faster. DON’T add weight to the bar, don’t do extra
reps.
Remember, moving the bar faster creates higher
Creating
a More powerful You
amounts of force and power.
The Routine
Week 1
Day 1
Clean
Low Hang Clean
Front Squat
Pendlay Row
RDL
Day 2
Bench
Speed Bench
Push Press
Dumbbell Incline
Tricep Extensions
Hammer Curls
Day 3
Snatch
High Hang Snatch
Back Squat
Speed Squat
Step-ups
Day 4
Deadlift
Power Clean
Power Snatch
Week 2
Day 1
Clean
Low Hang Clean
76
Josh Bryant
Weight %
70, 72.5, 75, 72.5, 75, 77.5
60
72
Sets
Reps
5, 3, 1, 5, 3, 1
5
5
5
8
Rest Interval
As Needed
2-3 min.
2-3 min.
1-2 min.
2-3 min.
80
70
75
3
6
5
3
3
5
3
4
5
10
10
20 (10 each
arm)
As Needed
1 min.
2-3 min.
90 sec.
90 sec.
90 sec.
3
3
6
3
5, 3, 1, 5, 3, 1
5
3
4
16 (8 each
leg)
As Needed
2 min.
As Needed
1 min.
2-3 min.
70
60
60
6
3
3
1
5
5
45 sec
2 min.
2 min.
Weight %
72.5, 75, 77.5, 75, 77.5, 80
62
Sets
Reps
5, 3, 1, 5, 3, 1
5
Rest Interval
As Needed
2-3 min.
70, 72.5, 75, 72.5, 75, 77.5
60
82
70
3
5
3
3
3
Creating a More powerful You
Front Squat
Pendlay Row
RDL
Day 2
Bench
Speed Bench
Push Press
Dumbbell Incline
Tricep Extensions
Hammer Curls
Day 3
Snatch
High Hang Snatch
Back Squat
Speed Squat
Step-ups
Day 4
Deadlift
Power Clean
Power Snatch
Week 3
Day 1
Clean
Low Hang Clean
Front Squat
Pendlay Row
RDL
Day 2
Bench
Speed Bench
77
Josh Bryant
75
5
3
3
5
5
8
2-3 min.
1-2 min.
2-3 min.
82
70
77
2
8
5
3
3
5
3
4
5
10
10
20 (10 each
arm)
As Needed
1 min.
2-3 min.
90 sec.
90 sec.
90 sec.
3
2
8
3
5, 3, 1, 5, 3, 1
5
3
4
16 (8 each
leg)
As Needed
2 min.
As Needed
1 min.
2-3 min.
70
65
65
6
3
3
1
5
5
45 sec
2 min.
2 min.
Weight %
75, 77.5, 80, 77.5, 80, 82.5
65
77
Sets
3
5
3
3
Reps
5, 3, 1, 5, 3, 1
5
5
5
8
Rest Interval
As Needed
2-3 min.
2-3 min.
1-2 min.
2-3 min.
85
70
1
10
3
4
As Needed
1 min.
72.5, 75, 77.5, 75, 77.5, 80
62
85
70
Creating a More powerful You
Push Press
Dumbbell Incline
Tricep Extensions
Hammer Curls
Day 3
Snatch
High Hang Snatch
Back Squat
Speed Squat
Step-ups
Day 4
Deadlift
Power Clean
Power Snatch
Week 4 (Deload)
Day 1
Clean
Low Hang Clean
Front Squat
Pendlay Row
RDL
Day 2
Bench
Push Press
Hammer Curls
Day 3
Snatch
High Hang Snatch
Back Squat
78
80
Josh Bryant
5
10
10
20 (10 each
arm)
2-3 min.
90 sec.
90 sec.
90 sec.
3
1
10
3
5, 3, 1, 5, 3, 1
5
3
4
16 (8 each
leg)
As Needed
2 min.
As Needed
1 min.
2-3 min.
82.5
65
65
5
3
3
5,4,3,2,1
5
5
as needed
2 min.
2 min.
Weight %
60
60
60
60% of working weight
60% of working weight
Sets
3
3
3
2
2
Reps
5
5
5
5
5
Rest Interval
90 sec.
90 sec.
90 sec.
90 sec
90 sec.
60
50
light
3
3
3
5
5
10
90 sec.
90 sec.
90 sec.
50
50
60
3
3
3
5
5
5
90 sec.
90 sec.
90 sec.
75, 77.5, 80, 77.5, 80, 82.5
65
87
70
5
3
3
5
Creating a More powerful You
Day 4
Deadlift
Week 5
Day 1
Clean
Clean Pulls
Front Squat
Neutral Grip Pull ups
GHR
Day 2
Bench
Speed Bench
Push Press
Seated Military DB
Press
Dips
Day 3
Snatch
Snatch Pulls
Back Squat
Speed Squat
Day 4
Deadlift
Power Clean
Power Snatch
Week 6
Day 1
Clean
Clean Pulls
Front Squat
Neutral Grip Pull ups
79
Josh Bryant
60
5
1
90 sec
Weight %
80, 82.5, 85, 82.5, 85, 87.5
95 (Of Full Clean)
80
Heavy as possible
Sets
3
4
4
3
Reps
5, 3, 1, 3, 2, 1
3
4
5
6
Rest Interval
As Needed
2 min.
3 min.
2 min.
90 sec.
87
75
82
3
6
4
4
2
3
3
8
As needed
1 min.
3 min.
90 sec.
3
6 to 10
90 sec.
80, 82.5, 85, 82.5, 85, 87.5
95 (Of Full Snatch)
90
75
3
3
6
5, 3, 1, 3, 2, 1
3
2
3
As Needed
2 min.
3 min..
1 min.
70
70
70
6
3
3
1
4
4
45 sec
2 min.
2 min.
Weight %
82.5, 85, 87.5, 85, 87.5, 90
97
82
Heavy as possible
Sets
Reps
5, 3, 1, 3, 2, 1
3
4
5
Rest Interval
As Needed
2 min.
3 min.
2 min.
3
4
4
Creating a More powerful You
80
GHR
Day 2
Bench
Speed Bench
Push Press
Seated Military DB
Press
Dips
Day 3
Snatch
Snatch Pulls
Back Squat
Speed Squat
Day 4
Deadlift
Power Clean
Power Snatch
Week 7
Day 1
Clean
Clean Pulls
Front Squat
Neutral Grip Pull ups
GHR
Day 2
Bench
Speed Bench
Push Press
Seated Military DB
Press
Dips
Josh Bryant
3
6
90 sec.
2
8
4
4
2
3
3
8
As needed
1 min.
2 min.
90 sec.
3
5 to 8
90 sec.
82.5, 85, 87.5, 85, 87.5, 90
97
92
75
3
2
8
5, 3, 1, 3, 2, 1
3
2
3
As Needed
2 min.
3 min..
1 min.
70
70
70
6
3
3
1
4
4
45 sec
2 min.
2 min.
Weight %
85, 87.5, 90, 87.5, 90, 92.5
100
85
Heavy as possible
Sets
3
4
4
3
Reps
5, 3, 1, 3, 2, 1
3
4
5
6
Rest Interval
As Needed
2 min.
3 min.
2 min.
90 sec.
92.5
75
87.5
1
10
4
4
2
3
3
8
As needed
1 min.
2 min.
90 sec.
3
5 to 7
90 sec.
90
75
85
Creating a More powerful You
Day 3
81
Snatch
85, 87.5, 90, 87.5, 90, 92.5
Snatch Pulls
Back Squat
Speed Squat
100
95
75
Day 4
Deadlift
Power Clean
Power Snatch
Josh Bryant
5, 3, 1, 3, 2, 1
As Needed
3
1
10
3
2
3
2 min.
3 min..
1 min.
85
70
70
5
3
3
5,4,3,,2,1
4
4
as needed
2 min.
2 min.
Weight %
87.5, 90, 92.5, 90, 92.5, 95
105
90
Heavy As Possible
Sets
3
3
3
3
Reps
3, 2, 1, 2, 1, 1
1
3
8
6
Rest Interval
As Needed
2 min.
3 min.
2 min.
90 sec.
95
80
90
3
6
4
3
1
2
2
5 to 7
As needed
1 min.
2 min.
90 sec.
87.5, 90, 92.5, 90, 92.5, 95
105
97.5
80
3
3
6
3, 2, 1, 2, 1, 1
1
1
2
As Needed
2 min.
3 min..
1 min.
80
6
1
1 min.
Week 8 (Deload),
Repeat Week 4
Week 9
Day 1
Clean
Clean Pulls
Front Squat
Wide Grip Pull ups
GHR
Day 2
Bench
Speed Bench
Push Press
Dips
Day 3
Snatch
Snatch Pulls
Back Squat
Speed Squat
Day 4
Deadlift
Creating a More powerful You
Power Clean
Power Snatch
Week 10
Day 1
Clean
Clean Pulls
Front Squat
Wide Grip Pull ups
GHR
Day 2
Bench
Speed Bench
Push Press
Dips
Day 3
Snatch
Snatch Pulls
Back Squat
Speed Squat
Day 4
Deadlift
Power Clean
Power Snatch
Week 11 (Deload for
next week’s max out)
Day 1
Clean
Front Squat
Day 2
Bench
82
Josh Bryant
75
75
3
3
3
3
2 min.
2 min.
Weight %
90, 92.5, 95, 92.5, 95, 97.5
107.5
92.5
Heavy As Possible
BW
Sets
3
2
3
3
Reps
3, 2, 1, 2, 1, 1
1
3
8
6
Rest Interval
As Needed
2 min.
3 min.
2 min.
90 sec.
97.5
80
92.5
2
8
3
3
1
2
2
5 to 6
As needed
1 min.
2 min.
90 sec.
90, 92.5, 95, 92.5, 95, 97.5
107.5
100
80
3
2
8
3, 2, 1, 2, 1, 1
1
1
2
As Needed
2 min.
3 min..
1 min.
75
75
75
6
3
3
1
3
3
30 sec
2 min.
2 min.
Weight %
75
75
Sets
3
3
Reps
3
3
Rest Interval
2 min.
2 min.
75
3
3
2 min.
Creating a More powerful You
Push Press
Day 3
Snatch
Back Squat
Day 4
Deadlift
Week
12
Week!)
83
Josh Bryant
70
3
3
2 min.
75
75
3
3
3
3
2 min.
2 min.
60
5
1
2 min.
(Max
Noah Bryant is a 2-time NCAA Champion and 4-time All-American in the shot put, with a personal record of
20.80 m. He holds the school record in the shot put at the University of Southern California. Noah represented
the United States in the 2007 World Track and Field Championships and the 2011 Pan-American Games. He
was regarded as one of the strongest shot putters in the world, with a 210 kg (462-pound) clean and 150
kg (330-pound) snatch. He is a Certified Strength and Conditioning Specialist by the National Strength and
Conditioning Association and has over five years experience coaching some of the best NCAA Track and
Field athletes in the country. You can visit his website at NoahStrength.com.
Josh Bryant, MS, CSCS, trains some of the strongest and most muscular athletes in the world in person at Metroflex Gym in Arlington,
Texas, and via the Internet. Josh has won many national and world titles in powerlifting and strongman and was the youngest person
in powerlifting history, at 22, to bench press 600 pounds raw. Josh has squatted 909 pounds in the USPF, officially bench pressed 620
pounds and deadlifted 810 pounds – both raw. He is not all brawn; he has a Master’s degree in Exercise Science, along with other
prestigious certifications. He is the co-author of Amazon # 1 selling book, Jailhouse Strong, along with other best-selling strength
and conditioning books. To learn more about Josh Bryant or to sign up for his free training tips newsletter, visit www.JoshStrength.
com
Equipped Bench
Circa-Max Phase
Vincent Dizenzo
T
his is the six week peaking cycle I used for
a meet. This was preceded by my regular
conjugate programming. It pushed me over
the top to finally hit the 900-pound equipped bench
I had been searching for. I was ac=tually only doing
two other exercises on these days. In addition, I was
only training one other day and it was moderate
weight/very low volume squatting and deadlifting.
I had to cut work to an absolute minimum to get
through this training. The weight along with the (un)
accommodating resistance that was required on top
of the strain of wearing the gear itself was brutal.
I think assistance and additional days of training is
dependent on one’s level of development.
Below you will see my actual program and numbers.
That means you get to learn this program like I
did. That is, if you want to implement it — don’t
hate me, it’s that whole teach a person to fish
thing. I extrapolated the numbers I needed for the
ME (Max Effort) portion from an article I read by
Jim Wendler on elitefts.com for a Circa Max Squat
Cycle. The DE (Dynamic Effort) numbers came from
email correspondence with Dave Tate. You can see
the notes and ideas directly following the six-week
program. I really had to reverse engineer a bunch
of numbers to get there, but the results were well
worth it.
creating a training cycle. It’s not something taken
lightly, especially when you are trying to reach the
next level. That does not necessarily mean for the
sport itself, but how it relates to your own lifting.
Man, as I work on this I realize how instrumental
Dave Tate was in reaching this goal. Dave really is
the friggin’ man! If you need help setting something
up for yourself just hit me up on the elitefts Q&A. I
might not be as brilliant as Dave, but I have developed
some programming chops myself.
Week 1:
ME Bench: (3x2 @55%) Shirted bench 500 + mini
and avg short bands + 4 chains to 2 board 2x2, to 1
board 1x2
DE Bench: 170 + 140 lbs of band tension 2x3
140 + 180 lbs of band tension 2x3
140 + 180 lbs of band tension + 40 lbs of chain 2x3
140 + 180 lbs of band tension + 80 lbs of chain 2x
Week 2:
ME Bench: (3x2 @60%) Shirted bench 550 + mini
and avg short bands + 4 chains to 2 board 2x2, to 1
board 1x2
ME
Bench
(w/Swiss
Angle
Press
I also think it’s good to see the process that goes into Bar): 170 + 140 lbs of band tension 2x3
Equipped Bench Circa-max Phase
85
170 + 180 lbs of band tension 2x3
170 + 180 lbs of band tension + 40 lbs of chain 2x3
170 + 180 lbs of band tension + 80 lbs of chain 2x3
Week 3:
ME Bench: (1x1 @50%, 1x1 @55%, 2x2 @65%)
Vincent Dizenzo
squat-phase/
*These were email notes Dave Tate sent
me:
Shirted bench 500 + mini and avg short bands + 4
chains to 2 board 1x1, 550 1x1, 590 2x2
This may or may not help but is a cycle
I used years ago at Westside that put 50
DE
Bench(w/Swiss
Angle
Press pounds on my bench. My thought process
Bar): 200 + 140 lbs of band tension 2x3 was the band overload was great but
200 + 180 lbs of band tension 2x3
200 + 180 lbs of band tension + 40 lbs of chain 2x3 the bands also made me faster out of
200 + 180 lbs of band tension + 80 lbs of chain 2x3 the bottom and I always wondered if
my lockout suffered because while the
Week 4:
tension was higher I was getting there
ME Bench: 640x1 to 2 board, 730x1 to 1 board,
faster because of the increased eccentric
835x1 to chest
contraction. So I used both bands and
DE
Bench
(w/Swiss
Angle
Press chains. Using boards is different so I
Bar): 200 + 140 lbs of band tension 2x1 would modify to what you have in some
200 + 180 lbs of band tension 2x1
200 + 180 lbs of band tension + 40 lbs of chain 2x1 way. Maybe just lower the band tension
200 + 180 lbs of band tension + 80 lbs of chain 2x1 some and make up the different (the top
weight) with chains.
Week 5:
ME Bench: worked up to 460 raw for a single (This
was just to feel some weight the week before the Circa- Maximal Band and Chain Phase
meet)
Application: This cycle is designed for intermediate
DE Bench: Blast strap circuit 2 sets x10 (pushups, and advanced lifters who need added lockout
strength. If heavy band tension tends to beat you
tri ext, rows, curls, scarecrows)
up, but you’re still in need of lockout help, this cycle
will help you. It’s intended for lifters who can bench
Week 6:
press over 450 pounds, and it uses a mix of bands
Meet 900 lb bench *Goal Realized!
and chains to reach the desired top weight. If you
bench under 450 pounds, adjust the chain weight so
*The article Circa Max Squat article Jim the top weight for the heaviest sets does not exceed
Wendler wrote that was the original 85% of your one-rep shirted max or 90-95% of your
one-rep, non-shirted max.
inspiration for my Circa Max Bench
Cycle
http://articles.elitefts.com/ Week 1: use suggested band tension for all
training-articles/the-circa-maximal- dynamic sets
25% for 2 sets 3 reps with 20 pounds of chain per
Equipped Bench Circa-max Phase
86
side 25% for 2 sets 3 reps with 40 pounds of chain
per side 25% for 2 sets 3 reps with 60 pounds
of chain per side 25% for 2 sets 3 reps with 80
pounds of chain per side
Week 2: use suggested band tension for all
dynamic sets
30% for 2 sets 3 reps with 20 pounds of chain per
side 30% for 2 sets 3 reps with 40 pounds of chain
per side 30% for 2 sets 3 reps with 60 pounds
of chain per side 30% for 2 sets 3 reps with 80
pounds of chain per side
Week 3: use suggested band tension for all
dynamic sets
35% for 2 sets 3 reps with 20 pounds of chain per
side 35% for 2 sets 3 reps with 40 pounds of chain
per side 35% for 2 sets 3 reps with 60 pounds
of chain per side 35% for 2 sets 3 reps with 80
pounds of chain per side
Suggested Band Tensions (based on max bench
press)
100-200 -pounds – Bands not recommended
201-300 pounds – 30-40 pounds of band tension at
the top of the lift
301-400 pounds – 40-50 pounds of band tension at
the top of the lift
401-500 pounds – 70 - 80 pounds of band tension at
the top of the lift
501-600 pounds – 70 - 80 pounds of band tension at
the top of the lift
601-700 pounds– 100-120 pounds of band tension
at the top of the lift
800 plus pounds – 140-160 pounds of band tension
at the top of the lift
*My Correspondence back with Dave
Okay, here’s the outline for the circa max:
5/23: Shirt (55%)495 w/300 lbs band tension to a
1 or 2 board for 3x2
Vincent Dizenzo
5/30: Shirt (60%) 545 w/300 lbs band tension to 1
or 2 board for 3x2
6/6: Shirt 495 1x1, 545 1x1, (65%) 585 2x2, all
with 300 lb band tension to 1 or 2 board
6/13: Opener to chest around 820 or so
6/20: Deload of some sort
6/28 Meet
*Dave’s response
I think this is on point. Only suggestion is adding
some chain. Maybe kick back the band tension to
240 and add 60 pound of chain at the top.
Vincent Dizenzo began competing as an amateur full meet lifter
in the 220-pound class. Two ruptured discs caused him to focus
on the bench press, and he eventually became a top ranked
bencher. His best bench is 830 pounds in the 275-pound class and
850 in the 308-pound class. He has a raw bench of 605 pounds as
a super heavyweight and 600 pounds in the 308-pound weight
class. Vincent won Bench America and has competed in the
Arnold Classic. He has also competed in Strongman competitions.
He is the host of the Just Big radio show.
Monte, 6
Indianapolis, IN
I WISH TO GO TO WALT DISNEY
® RESORT
WORLD- RESORT
WORLD
Monte is a humorous 6 year-old boy who could talk
all day long! He enjoys playing with small toys like
bouncy balls and action figures. He especially loves
going outdoors and having water gun fights with his
sister!
Monte is recovering from a kidney (renal) transplant.
A kidney transplant is a surgical procedure primarily
performed on patients with end-stage renal disease
or when the individual’s kidneys have failed. The
kidneys filter waste from the blood and remove it
from the body in the form of urine. They also help
maintain the body’s fluid and electrolyte balance. If
your kidneys stop working, waste builds up in your
body and can make you very sick.
When Wish-Granting volunteers met with Monte, he
knew exactly what he wanted to wish for: to go to
Walt Disney World® Resort. Monte is excited for a lot
of things as the trip is being planned. For one, he
loves all kinds of food and can’t wait to eat as much
as he can at the park! Also, since his surgery he
hasn’t been able to spend a lot of time outdoors. This
will be a great chance for him to get to soak up the
sun! Monte is thrilled that he gets to go to Disney,
meet all of his favorite characters, and have a great
Thank you for making wishes like Monte’s
come true.
time with his family.
Off-Season Strength
Program
Jerry Handley
T
his program is designed specifically for wrestlers with an early-intermediate training age (typically
the later high school years) looking to build overall strength using traditional (barbell, bodyweight)
and “nontraditional” (strongman, kettlebell) exercises.
About the Coach
Jerry Handley, M.S., M.S.
CSCS, SCCC, Barwis Methods Master Performance Coach
Owner of Viking Performance Training LLC in Morgantown, WV
Former Strength and Conditioning Coach at West Virginia University
Jerry Handley is the founder and head coach of Viking Performance Training LLC. Jerry was a strength and conditioning coach for
West Virginia University for over 10 years, where he was directly responsible for the strength and conditioning of some of WVU’s
most successful athletic programs in that time.
Handley has coached multiple Olympians and other athletes have found success on the international level, with multiple athletes
winning Gold at the prestigious Pan-American Games. Handley-trained teams at WVU won numerous conference championships while
at West Virginia University in various sports and multiple national championships in rifle. Outside of collegiate and international
athletics, Handley has focused on nationally competitive strongman and powerlifting training as well as martial arts competitors.
Handley has Master’s Degrees in Exercise Physiology as well as Athletic Coaching Education. He is a Certified Strength and
Conditioning Specialist through the National Strength and Conditioning Association, as well as a Strength and Conditioning Coach
Certified through the Collegiate Strength and Conditioning Coaches Association.
As well as his work training elite athletes, Handley has spent years competing in mixed martial arts, amateur boxing, kickboxing, and
submission grappling tournaments.
Off-Season Strength program
89
Jerry Handley
Pre-Test Week (should perform this routine after several weeks of training basic strength or strength endurance)
Day 1
Power Clean
Bench Press
DB Posterior Delt Raise
RDL
Manual Resistance Neck
Work to a max single (start light, take several sets to warm up as weight increases)
Work to a max triple (start light, take several sets to warm up as weight increases)
3x12
3x10 Light
1x12 ea
Forward/Backward/Side/Side
Hang Power Clean
Squat
Chinups
Reverse Hyper
Fat Bar Biceps Curls 3x10
Band Triceps Pushdown
Isometric Neck Holds
Work to a max single (start light, take several sets to warm up as weight increases)
Work to a max triple (start light, take several sets to warm up as weight increases)
3x10
3x10 Light
Day 2
Day 3
3x10
1x 12-sec. each
Forward/Backward/Side/Side
Clean
Work to a max single (start light, take several sets to warm up as weight increases)
Front Squat
Work to a max triple (start light, take several sets to warm up as weight increases)
Towel Chinups
3x Max Reps
Conditioning
2-KB (kettlebell) Clean + Squat + Press: Choose a weight you can only do 3-5 reps with,
And perform 21 total reps in as fast a time as possible (record time).
If over 9:00, reduce weight next time. If under 5:00, increase weight.
End of week, plug in maxes (Cleans) to following program. Do NOT update maxes while in
middle of program.
For the max triples, use a low-rep estimated max calculator as follows, then plug in the max:
(Weight lifted for 3RM) x (0.03) x (reps lifted…which should be 3) + (weight lifted) =
estimated max
Week 1 of 7 Rest between sets in primary compound movements- 2 to 4:00 (recover!)
Rest between sets in auxillary exercises- 1 to 2:00 (recover but keep pace up)
Day 1
90
Off-Season Strength program
Power Clean
Squat
RDL
Pullups
Grip
Day 2
3-sec Pause Bench Press
Push Press
Military Press
3x5
Pendlay Row
KB Lunge
Strongman
Press
5x3 65%
6x
50% 5x
65% 5x4 75%
4x8
3x10
Gripper (3x8) or Forearm Roller (3x4)
8x3
3x5
60%
1:00 Rest
3x8
3x8
Overhead Medley (x2)-
*if no implements, use fat bars and fat grip dumbbells
Day 3
Jerry Handley
Atlas Stone, Single arm KB, Log Clean and Clean
Pause Squat
Front Squat
Chinups
Reverse Hyper
KB Swing
Isometric Neck Hold
5x3 70%
8x3 60%
3x5 75%
3x10
3x10
2x10
1x :15 each
Hang Power Clean
Bench Press
Inverted Row
DB Posterior Delt Raise
Pistol Squat
Conditioning
3x3 65%
6x
50% 5x
65% 3x4 80% 3x2 80%
3x10
3x10
3x5 onto difficult height
Prowler High Handle / Low Handle Push: 3x4 total (:30 Rest reps, 2:30
Rest sets)
Day 4
1:00 Rest
Week 2 of 7 Rest between sets in primary compound movements- 2 to 4:00 (recover!)
Rest between sets in auxillary exercises- 1 to 2:00 (recover but keep pace up)
Day 1
Power Clean
Squat
RDL
Pullups
Grip
Day 2
5x3 70%
6x
50% 5x
65% 6x5 75%
5x7
3x7 Weighted if possible
Gripper (2x8, 1x max reps) or Forearm Roller (3x5)
3-sec Pause Bench Press
Push Press
2x4
4x4
50%
8x3
70%
1:00 Rest
Off-Season Strength program
91
Jerry Handley
Military Press
3x5
Pendlay Row
KB Lunge
Strongman
4x8
3x8
Atlas Stone- load to 48” to heavy stone, do 3 reps
*if no implements, do 3x7 Zercher Squats
Clean
Pause Squat
Front Squat
Chinups
Reverse Hyper
KB Swing
Isometric Neck Hold
2x3 70% 3x2 75%
4x
50% 8x3 70% 1:00 Rest
3x5 75% 1x max reps 75%
3x8 Weighted if possible
3x8
2x10
1x :15 each
Day 3
Day 4
Hang Power Clean
3x3 70%
Bench Press
6x
50% 5x
65% 3x6 80% 3x3 80%
Inverted Row
4x10
DB Posterior Delt Raise
4x10
Pistol Squat
3x7 onto same height as last week
Conditioning
2-KB (kettlebell) Clean+Squat+Press: 21 reps fast as possible; same guideline as before
Week 3 of 7 Rest between sets in primary compound movements- 2 to 4:00 (recover!)
Rest between sets in auxillary exercises- 1 to 2:00 (recover but keep pace up)
Day 1
Power Clean
Squat
RDL
Pullups
Grip
5x2 75%
6x
50% 5x
70% 7x4 82.5%
5x5
4x6 Weighted if possible
Gripper (2x8, 1x max reps + max hold) or Forearm Roller (4x6)
Day 2
3-sec Pause Bench Press
2x4 60% 6x3 75% 1:00 Rest
5x3
Push Press
Military Press
2x5
Pendlay Row
4x6
KB Lunge
3x8
Strongman
Atlas Stone- load to 48” to heavy stone, do 3 reps, Yoke Carry 5x10yd (heavier each time)
*if no implements, do 3x7 Zercher Squats and Carry a Bar with bands/chains on it
Day 3
Off-Season Strength program
Clean
Pause Squat
Front Squat
Chinups
Reverse Hyper
KB Swing
Manual Resistance Neck
Day 4
92
Jerry Handley
3x2 75% 2x2 80%
4x
60% 6x3 75% 1:00 Rest
2x5 80% 1x max reps 60%
3x6 Weighted if possible
3x8
3x8
x9 each
Hang Power Clean
3x3 75%
Bench Press
6x
50% 5x
70% 3x5 85% 3x3 85%
DB or KB Chinese Row
3x10
3x12
DB Posterior Delt Raise
Pistol Squat
3x5 onto lower height than last week
2-KB (kettlebell) Clean+Squat+Press: 21 reps fast as possible; Conditioning
same guideline as before
Day 1
Week 4 of 7 Rest between sets in primary compound movements- 2 to 4:00 (recover!)
Rest between sets in auxillary exercises- 1 to 2:00 (recover but keep pace up)
Power Clean
Squat
RDL
Pullups
Grip
Day 2
Clap Pushups
3x5
1-sec Pause Bench Press
Military Press
3x6
Bent Over Row
KB Step Up
Strongman
3x2 75% 2x2 80%
6x
50% 5x
65% 4x
80% 6x3 87.5%
5x3 Start moderate, work to heavy triple
3x10 Bodyweight or light weight
Gripper (1x10 light, 2x5 heavy) or Forearm Roller (1x6 light, 2x3 heavy)
alternate with
Med Ball Overhead Drop
6x3 65% 1:00 Rest
3x5
4x8
4x6
Carry Circuit 3x15yd (Atlas Stone, Farmer’s Walk, Zercher Carry, Yoke)
*if no implements, do Zercher, DB Farmer’s, Zercher again, and Unsteady Barbell)
Day 3
Box Jumps
3x3 alternate with
CleanWork to heavy single
3-sec Pause Squat
6x2 65% 1:00 Rest
Towel Chinups
3x10
Reverse Hyper
3x10
Single-leg KB Deadlift
3x5
Manual Resistance Neck
x7 each
Continuous Squat Jumps 3x6
93
Off-Season Strength program
Jerry Handley
Day 4
Hang Clean
3x3 70%
Behind the neck Push Press 2x5
Bench Press
6x
50% 5x
65% 4x
80% 4x4 90%
DB or KB Chinese Row
4x8
DB Posterior Delt Raise
3x15
Pistol Squat
4x5 weighted, onto same height than last week
Conditioning
Prowler High Push + Prowler Backwards Drag: 3x5x 15yd each (:30 Rest reps, 2:30 rest sets)
Week 5 of 7 Rest between sets in primary compound movements- 2 to 4:00 (recover!)
Rest between sets in auxillary exercises- 1 to 2:00 (recover but keep pace up)
Day 1
Power Clean
Squat
RDL
Pullups
Grip
Day 2
Clap Pushups
3x5
1-sec Pause Bench Press
Military Press
4x5
Bent Over Row
KB Step Up
Strongman
*if no implements, do DB Farmer’s
Day 3
Work to heavy single
6x
50% 5x
70% 4x
80% 4x3 92.5%
3x8
4x6 Weighted if possible
Gripper (1x10 light, 3x5 heavy) or Forearm Roller (1x6 light, 3x3
heavy)
alternate with
2x3 60% 6x2
Med Ball Overhead Drop
75% 1:00 Rest
3x5
4x6
4x6
Farmer’s Walk, work to max 15yd Carry
Box Jumps
Clean
3-sec Pause Squat
Towel Chinups
Reverse Hyper
Single-leg KB Deadlift
Isometric Neck Hold
3x3 alternate with
Continuous Squat Jumps 3x6
2x1 80% 3x1 85%
2x3 60% 6x2 75% 1:00 Rest
3x7 Weighted if possible
3x8
4x4
2x :15 each
Hang Clean
Behind the neck Push Press 3x3
Bench Press
DB or KB Chinese Row
DB Posterior Delt Raise
3x2
Day 4
75%
5x
50%
4x6
3x15
4x
70%
3x
85%
3x3
95%
Off-Season Strength program
94
Jerry Handley
Pistol Squat
3x5 lower height
Conditioning
Prowler High Push 15yd+Low Push 15yd+Stone Load 48” (or 1rep heavy Zercher) 6x, 1:30 Rest
Day 1
Week 6 of 7 Rest between sets in primary compound movements- 2 to 4:00 (recover!)
Rest between sets in auxillary exercises- 1 to 2:00 (recover but keep pace up)
Power Clean
Squat
RDL
Pullups
Grip
Work to heavy single, then 3x3x75% of heavy single
5x
50% 4x
70% 3x
85% 3x2 96%
4x6
5x5 Weighted if possible
Gripper (1x10 light, 3x5 heavy) or Forearm Roller (1x6 light, 3x3 heavy)
Clap Pushups
4x5
1-sec Pause Bench Press
Bent Over Row
Strongman
alternate with
Med Ball Overhead Toss
2x3 60% 5x2 80% 1:00 Rest
5x5
Log Clean and Press, work to max single
Box Jumps
Clean
3-sec Pause Squat
Towel Chinups
Single-leg KB Deadlift
Isometric Neck Hold
5x3 alternate with
Speed Box Jumps 5x5
Work to heavy single, then 3x2x80% of heavy single
2x3 60% 5x2 80% 1:00 Rest
4x5 Weighted if possible
3x3
2x :15 each
Hang Clean
Power Jerk
Bench Press
DB or KB Chainsaw Row
DB Posterior Delt Raise
Pistol Squat
Conditioning
same
4x1 80%
2x3
5x
50% 4x
65% 3x
80% 2x
90% 2x2 100%
3x5
2x15
2x5 same height with weight
2-KB (kettlebell) Clean+Squat+Press: 21 reps fast as possible; guideline as before
Day 2
*if no implements, do Fat Bar
Day 3
Day 4
4x5
Rest 5:00, then Atlas Stone to Shoulder: max reps 2x1:00 (Rest 1:30).
*if no stones, do max reps KB swing 2x :45 + max Reps Zercher squat 2x :45
Rest 5:00, then Prowler High 15yd + Prowler Low 15yd + Burpees x7 (10x, Rest :30)
Week 7 of 7 Rest between sets in primary compound movements- 2 to 4:00 (recover!)
Rest between sets in auxillary exercises- 1 to 2:00 (recover but keep pace up)
95
Off-Season Strength program
Day 1
Power Clean
Squat
DB Posterior Delt Raise
RDL
Day 2
Clean
Bench Press
Towel Chinups
Jerry Handley
Work to max
Work to max
2x12
2x10 Light
Work to max
Work to max
Max Reps
Day 3
Front Squat
Work to max
Pullups
Work to max weighted triple
Chinups
Work to max weighted triple
Conditioning
2-KB (kettlebell) Clean+Squat+Press: 21 reps fast as possible; same guideline as before
Rest 3:00
6x 3:00 on / 1:00 rest
Rounds 1 & 4: 1:30 ea- shots in resistance band, box jump up-sprawl on floor down
Rounds 2 & 5: 1:30 ea- Jumping MB Slams, heavy KB load and unload to 48” height
Rounds 3 & 6: 1:30 ea- Walking lunge, walking reverse lunge
Jerry Handley is the founder and head coach of Viking Performance Training LLC. Jerry was a strength and conditioning coach for
West Virginia University for over 10 years, where he was directly responsible for the strength and conditioning of some of WVU’s
most successful athletic programs in that time. While at WVU, Handley worked with every varsity sports program through his
career. Handley has Master’s Degrees in Exercise Physiology as well as Athletic Coaching Education. He is a Certified Strength and
Conditioning Specialist through the National Strength and Conditioning Association, as well as a Strength and Conditioning Coach
Certified through the Collegiate Strength and Conditioning Coaches Association. Jerry has worked alongside some of the nation’s
top strength coaches, including several years with Mike Barwis (former WVU and Michigan Director of Strength and Conditioning,
founder of Barwis Methods), Chris Allen (Director of Strength and Conditioning at Arizona), and Mike Joseph (Director of Strength
and Conditioning at WVU). Jerry’s work with Barwis has earned him a Level 8: Master Performance Coach distinction.
Off-season Speed
and Agility Nick Aloi & Mike Inman
T
he purpose of this program is to develop
the speed of your football players through
addressing all the energy systems that the
body requires to both recover and produce speed.
This program is multifaceted and aims to increase
both the conditioning and the running power of
football players. By addressing aerobic power, speed
technique, alactic capacity and alactic power/speed
development your athletes will get faster. Below is a
description of all of the components of the program.
Aerobic Power: Aerobic power is the backbone of
recovery from speed work and is crucial to football
players. Football is primarily a game of intense
intervals with a short rest time. During these
intervals primarily anaerobic systems are used.
The body to recover from the use of anaerobic
systems uses the aerobic energy system. To create
better Aerobic power timed runs, tempo runs,
and set distance runs will be incorporated. These
techniques are characterized by longer run times
that should last 3-10 minutes, have 1-5 minute rest
times and 2-5 repetitions per workout. The benefits
from training this system last from 28-35 days and
do not need to be addressed as frequently as the
other aspects of the program.
Speed technique: Speed techniques are the arm and
leg actions of the program. These are addressed
heavily in the beginning of the program to establish
proper running mechanics. These proper mechanics
teach your athletes to run more efficiently. These are
programmed by addressing them methodically and
broken down into parts. For the arm actions you
can start from a seated position with one arm, than
progress to using both arms in a standing position
for time and repetitions. The main focus should be
on keeping the elbows locked in at 90 degrees and
the arm swing going from cheek to cheek. For leg
actions find a wall and lean your arms against it at
a 45 degree angle keeping everything in line. It can
be progressed the same way as the arm actions from
single leg to double leg work for reps and times.
Insure that the toes stay high the knees stay up and
a quick ground strike.
Alactic Capacity: This work is primarily the energy
system used in football. It incorporates agilities
and short intense interval work. The agility work is
broken up into 3 focuses. 1. Decelerations- Focusing
on starting and stopping from a good athletic
position. Stopping and landing in a strong stance
from multiple angles. 2. Pre-programmed agility
drills- pre-programmed agilities include anything
with cones such as 5-10-5 the T-drill the L-Drill as
well as the box drill and 3. Reactive/Chaos drillsThese include pre-programmed agilities but with
Off-Season Speed and Agility
97
a reactionary component. Meaning the athletes
does something on a coach’s queue whether it is
a deceleration or a cutting move that the coach
controls. It is important to note that for the game of
football it doesn’t matter if you can run fast only one
time it is the ability to reproduce speed play after
play that matters in the long term progression of the
game.
Alactic Power/ Speed Development: This is where
the athletes develops his speed and power. It focuses
on improving acceleration and top end speed. It
is broken down into 4 primary parts 1. BuildupsBuildups are a gradual acceleration to a top speed
at the end of a set distance. For example in a 40 yard
buildup the athlete starts slow at the beginning and
should be at top speed by the end of the forty yards.
Buildups should be between 30 and 60 yards. They
should not be running at top speed for more than 5
yards. 2. Accelerations- Accelerations are an all-out
sprint for 10-40 yards. You can start these position
specific stance, from a seated position, blind as well
as from a falling start. Falling starts are a great way to
reinforce a good forward lean while accelerating 3.
In and outs- Are transitions from jogging to sprinting
2-3 times for a given yardage. An example would be
jog ten yards sprint 10 yards then jog ten and finish
with a ten yard sprint. It is important to note that
all of the yards covered go into determining the
volume of the workout. It is not only the sprinting
that counts. The transitions between jogging and
sprinting should be quick and immediate right at
the marker. 4. Flying sprints- Flying sprints are
characterized by a buildup period up to 10 yards
than on a set cone an immediate production of
power into a full on sprint for the rest of the allotted
yards. The max sprint should only last between 10
and 40 yards. Full recovery is needed between each
repetition for all of your speed development work at
least 3 minutes in length. To get fast you need to run
fast and to run fast you need to be fully recovered.
Nick Aloi and Mike Inman are Graduate Assistant
Sports Performance Coaches at Salisbury University
in Salisbury, Maryland. Both Nick and Mike work
Nick Aloi & Mike Inman
with and develop the training programs for the
Football team at SU. If you have any questions about
the program please contact Nick at na47522@gulls.
salisbury.edu or Mike at minman1@gulls.salisbury.
edu .
The Stim Method
Willie Danzer
T
his program was used by our high-level
collegiate track-and-field shotputters who
had at least three years of experience in
our program. More importantly, the throwers
who used this program had attained a certain
degree of competition success, and their general
strength was approaching the upper level of model
characteristics for high level shotputters (Table
17) as seen in Dr. Anatoliy Bondarchuk’s book,
Transfer of Training in Sports.
The purpose behind using Dr. Yuri Verkhoshansky’s
Stim Method was to intensify the general
training by more advanced means as a way to
illicit further progress in general power outputs,
something that was seen as a need for these athletes
at that time in their careers. Both athletes used the
exact framework (volume, intensity, rest intervals,
etc.) that Dr. Verkshonsky prescribed. However, the
exercises were varied for each athlete based on their
intrinsic athletic nature and abilities (reactive vs.
brute strength).
A high-low training week was utilized wherein
the Stim Method was used on high-stress days,
and lower stress auxiliary exercises were used on
low-stress days. A traditional seven-day week was
abandoned at this time, and the primary temporal
consideration was the number of days between
sessions, regardless of what calendar day training
sessions fell on. The training days were programmed
by working backwards from the upcoming meet.
During the course of the program, methods of autoregulation (both objective and subjective) were
utilized to determine the degree of stress of each
training day. The Stim Method was crosschecked
against their vertical jump heights, which were
tested daily, to determine how much volume would
be used during a given training session. If the athlete
was at, or above, their personal best vertical-jump
height for this time period, they performed the
planned volume for the day. If their jump was below
their best, the volume was lowered accordingly.
Depending on how low the jump result was, the
volume was adjusted downwards incrementally. If
the result of jump testing was especially low on a
scheduled high intensity day, an auxiliary session
was performed in place of the Stim Method.
The opinion of the athletes (how they felt), as well as
their performance during throws practice earlier in
the day, was also taken into consideration regarding
their readiness for the training session. During the
time of this program, a trend of recovery and higher
levels of performance were noticed, and were used
to help peak for meaningful meets.
Lastly, this program was used for eight to twelve
individual training sessions depending on their
recovery. It should be noted that these sessions
were run primarily over Christmas break due to the
extremely long duration of the training sessions, as
well as due to how taxing these training sessions
were. Please use caution when performing this
99
The stim-method For track
Willie Danzer
program and ensure that athletes are qualified for it, and that it is an appropriate plan of action for the
needs of the athletes.
It should be noted that another important consideration that you, as a coach, should make is that you,
as well as your athletes, must have enough time in a given training session to perform the workout as
intended by Dr. Verkhoshansky. The rest periods recommended are important to the success of the Stim
Method and cannot be compromised. Also realize that context is everything, and the specific program was
written specifically for the individual athletes (their nature, needs, timing, abilities, etc.) who performed
this program.
Willie Danzer earned his bachelor’s degree from the University of Northern Iowa in 2006 and received his
Master’s at Northwestern State in Sports Administration in 2008. Danzer is an NSCA certified Strength and
Conditioning Specialist, a certified USA Weightlifting Level-I club coach and is also a certified American
Powerlifting Association referee.
Bobby
Week 29
Day 1-Heavy Shot Day
E-I-C
A1. Heavy Shot Put Technique
A2. Discus or Hammer
Tech
B1. Standing Heavy Throws
(20lb) Volume determined
by Coach Shelby
%
C1. Box Squat
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
C1a. Hurdle Jumps
Pair
C1b. Stretch if Necessary
D1. Narrower Grip Bench
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
D1a. Plyo Push Ups
Pair
D1b. Stretch if Necessary
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower Body Band
Stretch
60/70/80/90
Bobby and John
Day 2
1--1--1
X--X--X
1--15--1
1--1--1
Load
BW
60/70/80/90
X--X--X
SxR
RI
x1/x1/x1/2x2
4min Set
8 Min Series
3x6 Jumps
4min Set
x1/x1/x1/2x2
4min Set
8 Min Series
3x6 Push Ups
4min Set
SxR
RI
1--15--1
Week 29
E-I-C
%
Load
100
The stim-method For track
Accessory Circuit
B1. RDL (USE STRAPS)
Series
B2. ANY TRICEP
Series
B3. Incline Bench DB Row
Series
B4. ANY BICEP
Series
B5. McGill Sit-Ups
Series
B6. Any Shrug
Series
B8. TRX Fatman Pull Up to
External Rotation
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower Body Band
Stretch
1--1--1
Willie Danzer
155+
1--1--1
2x8-12
1--1--1
100+ Total
1--1--1
BW
1--1--1
N/A
2x15e
2x15
1--1--1
Bobby
Week 29
Day 1-Heavy Shot Day
E-I-C
A1. Heavy Shot Put Technique
A2. Discus or Hammer
Tech
B1. Standing Heavy Throws
(20lb) Volume determined
by Coach Shelby
%
C1. Box Squat
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
C1a. Hurdle Jumps
Pair
C1b. Stretch if Necessary
D1. Narrower Grip Bench
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
D1a. Plyo Push Ups
Pair
1--1--1
60/70/80/90
X--X--X
X--X--X
2x8-12
2x8-12
1--1--1
1--15--1
1--1--1
2x8-12
BW
2x8-12
Load
SxR
RI
x1/x1/x1/2x2
4min Set
8 Min Series
3x6 Jumps
4min Set
x1/x1/x1/2x2
4min Set
8 Min Series
3x6 Push Ups
4min Set
BW
60/70/80/90
101
The stim-method For track
D1b. Stretch if Necessary
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower Body Band
Stretch
1--15--1
John
Week 29
Day 1-Heavy Shot Day
A1. Heavy Shot Put Technique
A2. Discus or Hammer
Tech
E-I-C
%
C1. Box Squat
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
C1a. Free Squat
Pair
C1b. Stretch if Necessary
D1. Narrower Grip Bench
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
D1a. Bench Press
Pair
D1b. Stretch if Necessary
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower Body Band
Stretch
1--1--1
John and Bobby
Day 2
Accessory Circuit
B1. MR Reverse Hypers
Series
B2. ANY TRICEP
Series
B3. Incline Bench DB Row
Series
B4. ANY BICEP
Series
Willie Danzer
Load
SxR
RI
60/70/80/85
x1/x1/x1/2x3
4min Set
8 Min Series
X--X--X
30
3x6
4min Set
1--15--1
1--1--1
60/70/80/85
x1/x1/x1/2x3
4min Set
8 Min Series
X--X--X
30
3x6
4min Set
Load
SxR
RI
155+
2x8-12
1--15--1
Week 29
E-I-C
1--1--1
%
1--1--1
1--1--1
1--1--1
2x8-12
100+ Total
2x8-12
2x8-12
N/A
102
The stim-method For track
B5. McGill Sit-Ups
1--1--1
Series
B6. Any Shrug
1--1--1
Series
B8. TRX Fatman Pull Up to 1--1--1
External Rotation
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower Body Band
Stretch
John
Day 3-Heavy Shot Day
A1. Heavy Shot Put Technique
A2. Discus or Hammer
Tech
C1. Box Squat
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
C1a. Free Squat
Pair
C1b. Stretch if Necessary
D1. Narrower Grip Bench
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
D1a. Bench Press
Pair
D1b. Stretch if Necessary
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower Body Band
Stretch
Bobby
Day 1-Heavy Shot Day
A1. Heavy Shot Put Technique
A2. Discus or Hammer
Tech
B1. Standing Heavy Throws
(20lb) Volume determined
by Coach Shelby
Week 29
Willie Danzer
BW
2x15e
2x15
BW
2x8-12
Load
SxR
RI
E-I-C
%
1--1--1
60/70/80/85
x1/x1/x1/2x3
4min Set
8 Min Series
X--X--X
30
3x6
4min Set
1--15--1
1--1--1
60/70/80/85
x1/x1/x1/2x3
4min Set
8 Min Series
X--X--X
30
3x6
4min Set
SxR
RI
1--15--1
Week 29
E-I-C
%
Load
103
The stim-method For track
C1. Box Squat
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
C1a. Hurdle Jumps
Pair
C1b. Stretch if Necessary
D1. Narrower Grip Bench
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
D1a. Plyo Push Ups
Pair
D1b. Stretch if Necessary
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower Body Band
Stretch
Bobby and John
Day 2
Accessory Circuit
B1. RDL (USE STRAPS)
Series
B2. ANY TRICEP
Series
B3. Incline Bench DB Row
Series
B4. ANY BICEP
Series
B5. McGill Sit-Ups
Series
B6. Any Shrug
Series
B8. TRX Fatman Pull Up to
External Rotation
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower Body Band
Stretch
Bobby
1--1--1
60/70/80/90
X--X--X
1--15--1
1--1--1
Willie Danzer
x1/x1/x1/2x2
4min Set
8 Min Series
3x6 Jumps
4min Set
x1/x1/x1/2x2
4min Set
8 Min Series
3x6 Push Ups
4min Set
Load
SxR
RI
155+
2x8-12
BW
60/70/80/90
X--X--X
1--15--1
Week 29
E-I-C
1--1--1
%
1--1--1
1--1--1
2x8-12
100+ Total
1--1--1
1--1--1
2x8-12
BW
1--1--1
1--1--1
Week 29
2x8-12
2x15e
2x15
BW
2x8-12
N/A
104
The stim-method For track
Day 1-Heavy Shot Day
E-I-C
A1. Heavy Shot Put Technique
A2. Discus or Hammer
Tech
B1. Standing Heavy Throws
(20lb) Volume determined
by Coach Shelby
%
C1. Box Squat
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
C1a. Hurdle Jumps
Pair
C1b. Stretch if Necessary
D1. Narrower Grip Bench
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
D1a. Plyo Push Ups
Pair
D1b. Stretch if Necessary
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower Body Band
Stretch
60/70/80/90
John
1--1--1
X--X--X
1--15--1
1--1--1
Willie Danzer
Load
BW
60/70/80/90
X--X--X
SxR
RI
x1/x1/x1/2x2
4min Set
8 Min Series
3x6 Jumps
4min Set
x1/x1/x1/2x2
4min Set
8 Min Series
3x6 Push Ups
4min Set
SxR
RI
1--15--1
Week 29
Day 1-Heavy Shot Day
A1. Heavy Shot Put Technique
A2. Discus or Hammer
Tech
E-I-C
%
Load
C1. Box Squat
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
C1a. Free Squat
Pair
C1b. Stretch if Necessary
D1. Narrower Grip Bench
1--1--1
60/70/80/85
x1/x1/x1/2x3
4min Set
8 Min Series
X--X--X
30
3x6
4min Set
1--15--1
1--1--1
60/70/80/85
x1/x1/x1/2x3
4min Set
105
The stim-method For track
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
D1a. Bench Press
Pair
D1b. Stretch if Necessary
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower Body Band
Stretch
John and Bobby
Day 2
Accessory Circuit
B1. MR Reverse Hypers
Series
B2. ANY TRICEP
Series
B3. Incline Bench DB Row
Series
B4. ANY BICEP
Series
B5. McGill Sit-Ups
Series
B6. Any Shrug
Series
B8. TRX Fatman Pull Up to
External Rotation
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower Body Band
Stretch
John
Willie Danzer
8 Min Series
X--X--X
30
3x6
4min Set
Load
SxR
RI
155+
2x8-12
1--15--1
Week 29
E-I-C
%
1--1--1
1--1--1
2x8-12
1--1--1
100+ Total
1--1--1
2x8-12
1--1--1
BW
1--1--1
N/A
2x15e
2x15
1--1--1
Week 29
2x8-12
Day 3-Heavy Shot Day
A1. Heavy Shot Put Technique
A2. Discus or Hammer
Tech
E-I-C
%
C1. Box Squat
1--1--1
60/70/80/85
BW
2x8-12
Load
SxR
RI
x1/x1/x1/2x3
4min Set
106
The stim-method For track
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
C1a. Free Squat
Pair
C1b. Stretch if Necessary
D1. Narrower Grip Bench
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
D1a. Bench Press
Pair
D1b. Stretch if Necessary
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower Body Band
Stretch
Willie Danzer
8 Min Series
X--X--X
30
3x6
4min Set
1--15--1
1--1--1
60/70/80/85
x1/x1/x1/2x3
4min Set
8 Min Series
X--X--X
30
3x6
4min Set
1--15--1
Bobby
Week 29
E-I-C
%
C1. Box Squat
1--1--1
60/70/80/90
Day 1-Heavy Shot Day
A1. Heavy Shot Put Technique
A2. Discus or Hammer Tech
B1. Standing Heavy Throws (20lb)
Volume determined by Coach Shelby
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
C1a. Hurdle Jumps
Pair
C1b. Stretch if Necessary
D1. Narrower Grip Bench
Pair
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
D1a. Plyo Push Ups
1--15--1
1--1--1
BW
60/70/80/90
SxR
RI
x1/x1/
x1/2x2
4min Set
8 Min
Series
3x6 Jumps 4min Set
x1/x1/
x1/2x2
REPEAT
Pair
D1b. Stretch if Necessary
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower
Body Band Stretch
Bobby and John
X--X--X
Load
X--X--X
1--15--1
Week 29
3x6 Push
Ups
4min Set
8 Min
Series
4min Set
The stim-method For track
Day 2
Accessory Circuit
B1. RDL (USE STRAPS)
Series
B2. ANY TRICEP
Series
B3. Incline Bench DB Row
107
E-I-C
Willie Danzer
%
1--1--1
155+
2x8-12
1--1--1
100+
Total
1--1--1
1--1--1
BW
1--1--1
1--1--1
%
C1. Box Squat
1--1--1
60/70/80/90
X--X--X
1--15--1
1--1--1
2x15e
BW
2x8-12
Load
SxR
RI
x1/x1/
x1/2x2
4min Set
BW
60/70/80/90
8 Min
Series
3x6 Jumps 4min Set
x1/x1/
x1/2x2
REPEAT
X--X--X
N/A
2x15
E-I-C
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
C1a. Hurdle Jumps
Pair
C1b. Stretch if Necessary
D1. Narrower Grip Bench
2x8-12
2x8-12
Week 29
Day 1-Heavy Shot Day
A1. Heavy Shot Put Technique
A2. Discus or Hammer Tech
B1. Standing Heavy Throws (20lb)
Volume determined by Coach Shelby
RI
2x8-12
Bobby
Pair
SxR
1--1--1
Series
B4. ANY BICEP
Series
B5. McGill Sit-Ups
Series
B6. Any Shrug
Series
B8. TRX Fatman Pull Up to External
Rotation
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower
Body Band Stretch
Pair
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
D1a. Plyo Push Ups
Load
3x6 Push
Ups
4min Set
8 Min
Series
4min Set
The stim-method For track
108
Willie Danzer
D1b. Stretch if Necessary
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower
Body Band Stretch
1--15--1
John
Week 29
E-I-C
%
C1. Box Squat
1--1--1
60/70/80/85
Day 1-Heavy Shot Day
A1. Heavy Shot Put Technique
A2. Discus or Hammer Tech
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
C1a. Free Squat
Pair
C1b. Stretch if Necessary
D1. Narrower Grip Bench
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
D1a. Bench Press
Pair
D1b. Stretch if Necessary
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower
Body Band Stretch
John and Bobby
Day 2
Accessory Circuit
B1. MR Reverse Hypers
Series
B2. ANY TRICEP
Series
B3. Incline Bench DB Row
Series
B4. ANY BICEP
Series
Load
SxR
RI
x1/x1/
x1/2x3
4min Set
X--X--X
30
3x6
1--15--1
1--1--1
60/70/80/85
x1/x1/
x1/2x3
X--X--X
8 Min
Series
4min Set
4min Set
3x6
8 Min
Series
4min Set
Load
SxR
RI
155+
2x8-12
30
1--15--1
Week 29
E-I-C
1--1--1
%
1--1--1
1--1--1
1--1--1
2x8-12
100+
Total
2x8-12
2x8-12
N/A
The stim-method For track
109
Willie Danzer
B5. McGill Sit-Ups
Series
B6. Any Shrug
Series
B8. TRX Fatman Pull Up to External
Rotation
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower
Body Band Stretch
1--1--1
John
Week 29
E-I-C
%
C1. Box Squat
1--1--1
60/70/80/85
Day 3-Heavy Shot Day
A1. Heavy Shot Put Technique
A2. Discus or Hammer Tech
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
C1a. Free Squat
Pair
C1b. Stretch if Necessary
D1. Narrower Grip Bench
Pair
REPEAT
SERIES 1-3 TIMES
D1a. Bench Press
Pair
D1b. Stretch if Necessary
Athlete’s Notes: Post workout, Lower
Body Band Stretch
BW
1--1--1
2x15e
2x15
1--1--1
BW
2x8-12
Load
SxR
RI
x1/x1/
x1/2x3
4min Set
X--X--X
30
3x6
1--15--1
1--1--1
60/70/80/85
x1/x1/
x1/2x3
X--X--X
1--15--1
30
3x6
8 Min
Series
4min Set
4min Set
8 Min
Series
4min Set
The Knowledge Behind
Programs That Work
James Smith
C
onsistent with how I’ve operated on the Q&A
of elitefts.net since 2005, my contribution to
this noble project will be rooted in “teaching
you to fish”, though I will, in addition, offer you
a “fish” as well, in so far as the “elevator version”
allows.
No doubt, this beginning segment is an unpopular
approach given my observations of the corporate
on-line sports training community over the last 14
years who seem to prefer fish over learning how
to catch them. Never the less, my uncompromising
nature makes for the ease in which I offer donations
such as this one. In the spirit of the late Bruce Lee
“take what is useful and discard what is not”.
The casual and competitive lifters share a common
goal- to become stronger. In the case of the competitive
lifter the goal might be stated: “to be come strongerperiod”. In this way, “strength training” is both the
means and the ends and occupies the near totality of
area in the pie chart.
For all other populations (personal trainers,
athletes, and coaches), despite what you might think,
“strength training” represents only a mere fraction
of important training components that you must
introduce to yourself, clients, or athletes. In this way,
and despite the title of “strength coach” the role of
“strength training” is nothing more than a means,
just one of many in fact, that are central towards
Most important for you to understand is that, as the the development of various physical preparatory
saying goes, “perception is reality”. In this way, we objectives for athletes and non-athletes alike.
must first ask the question…what is your objective?
Your objective is proportional to your perception “of In this case, particularly regarding the training of
the training problem” and the associated realization athletes, the pie chart will also include qualities such
of your efforts.
as skill, speed, stamina, and suppleness. Further
sub-divisions of these qualities include, but are not
The bulk of the readers of this project will no limited to, reactive-elastic ability, power, a-lactic /
doubt be “strength” enthusiasts. Of that population lactic /aerobic power or capacity, rhythm, relaxation,
exists, primarily, casual lifters, competitive lifters, timing, movement/joint amplitude, and more…
personal trainers, athletes, and strength coaches.
A pie chart exist, for each one of you, in which From this we know that “programs that work” is
the proportionality and contribution of “strength a relative term and the real question, as previously
training” is different; based upon your objectives.
stated, is- what is the objective. Keep in mind,
The knowledge Behind programs
111
however, that in order to identify the objective one
must first ask the proper questions.
Outside of the casual and competitive lifter
populations, my observations over the years have
revealed the fact that most personal trainers and
coaches typically, via no help from there misguided
certifying organizations and university curricula,
fail to ask the proper questions.
James Smith
physical effort, let’s say once every calendar week,
that vastly exceeds the demands of their day-to-day
tasks then the body will have to generate a defense
reaction proportional to that stress. We call it a
defense reaction because the human body’s ability
to adapt is inherently linked to our survival. The
body adapts, utilizing the minimal required energy,
to adjust to the physical effort such that the effort
itself renders the least amount of life threatening
In the words of the late Hungarian Nobel Laureate stress to our bodies.
Albert Szent Gyorgi “True discovery consists of
seeing what everyone else has seen and thinking No different than the concept of dose: response, as
what no one else has thought”
the frequency of the stimulus increases (provided
the magnitude is sufficiently in excess of the office
The eventuality of asking the proper questions workers day to day stress) the associate defense
will result in the optimal proportionality and reactions see to it that the office worker’s structural
contribution of elements within the pie chart; and resources and operational capabilities increase
the proportionality will change over time.
in a proportional fashion. Thus, in time, provided
genetics and nutritional habits are sufficient, the
Important to recognize is that the physiological ordinary office worker begins to transform into
foundations of “strength” development, regardless something more.
of its contribution to the training objective, are the
same. The foundations are linked to the human Marcus Aurelius said “of each particular thing ask,
organisms adaptive capabilities.
what is it in and of itself, what is its nature”. In this
way, we must ask ourselves why do programs that
The process of adaptation may be paraphrased and work, work? The answer lies in the means by which
simplified down to the concept of a defense reaction. we manipulate the nature, or taxonomy, of the
In this way, adaptation is a defense reaction to stress training load.
(both positive and negative stress).
The taxonomy of the training load may be reduced
A sedentary office worker’s level of day to day down to means, methods of execution, frequency,
physical stress exists as nothing more than the intensity, and volume.
physical effort associated with getting out of bed, in
and out of the car, bus or train, walking, maybe up •
Means = exercises (to include all movements
some stairs, getting in and out of a chair, and so on. regardless if they are performed inside a weight room,
If no physical efforts exist outside of those mundane on a track, field, ice, court, or in or on the water
tasks then the physical condition of the sedentary •
Methods of Execution = how the means are
office worker’s body will exist as an aggregate performed
combination of their miniscule physical actions, •
Frequency = the time interval that passes
inherited genetic traits, and nutritional habits. This between episodes of training stimuli
is why most people who fit this profile, particularly •
Intensity = the magnitude of work imposed by
those with poor nutritional habits, carry very little the training stimuli per each episode of stress
lean muscle tissue and higher amounts of fat.
•
Volume= the sum total of work performed per
unit time and there are many contexts in which volume
Now, if we take this same individual and impose a may be calculated (per set, per training session, per
The knowledge Behind programs
112
series of sessions…)
Most important are that these aspects of the training
load are optimized for the individual and task at
hand.
James Smith
business person whose day job entails a great deal
of sitting either behind a desk or behind the wheel
in transit to various work locations. He is a devout
enthusiast of physical preparation and his goals are,
and have been, to develop both lean muscularity
and strength void of the use of anabolic steroids and
other anabolic/androgenic pharmaceuticals.
Many suggest that one seek the minimum effective
dose. In this way, the training load is managed in
such as way as to introduce the minimal effective Prior to enlisting my service he had been trained
frequency, intensity, and volume of work performed via a more conventional approach for a number of
in order to accomplish the desired outcome.
years by a well-known on-line trainer in addition
to following the programs in a well-known training
Others, for whatever reason, seem to find solace manual. In this way, he had been performing more of
in vastly exceeding this minimum effective dose in a generic series of programs and, by association, his
favor of finding how much they, or their clients/ results were not remarkable.
athletes, can tolerate. Clearly, this also qualifies for
negligent behavior.
After our first five months together he achieved
extraordinary results. Through his diligent work
From this, you must recognize that a program that ethic and commitment to very specific nutritional
works cannot responsibly be targeted at no one manipulations (reflections of his own researches)
in particular as the means, methods of execution, his physical condition improved dramatically on the
frequency, intensity, and volume must be generated order of a 4 kilogram decrease in body fat and an
for the specific needs of individuals.
8kilogram increase in lean muscle mass assessed
by a medical doctor; accompanied by strength
Those familiar with my work know that I have increases across the board.
paid continued respects to the late sprint coach
Charlie Francis. One of the myriad of lessons shared What I have decided to share here are two sequential
by Charlie was the fact that programs that were 4 week training blocks which lead to him setting
constructed for individuals that yielded certain a 6kg PR in the bench press of 130kg in the week
results are to serve as history lessons; in that, they of 9-14. Earlier in 2014 I transitioned him to a
happened in the past. In this way, no matter how flexible 3x/calendar week training schedule to
“intelligent” or “flawed” a program may be judged by accommodate his demanding work schedule (long
another, one cannot deny the fact that the program hours and a great deal of travelling in the car). You’ll
happened (it was executed by at least one person); see the training illustrated in Upper 1 and 2 and
and in retrospect the program and circumstances Lower 1 and 2. In this way, his training week consists
surrounding its execution serves as a learning of two sessions for the upper body and two sessions
opportunity for someone in the future.
for the lower body; however, he performs no more
than three sessions every seven days. So his training
Following I present to you a general strength week typically lasts 8-9 days on the calendar. This
program (suggested only for the casual training schedule has worked exceptionally well for him.
enthusiast) that worked for a client of mine. I rarely
agree to work with a non-competitive athlete; He performs sequences of 3 week loading blocks
however, this person is a close friend of mine so I followed by 1 week deloads. The nature of the
made an exception. Not so dissimilar from the office loading weeks has varied from strength-aerobic,
worker scenario I explained earlier, this client is a accumulation, to higher intensifications of load
The knowledge Behind programs
113
James Smith
increases. New movements are introduced during deload weeks and any movement highlighted in red
indicates a change from the previous week.
It is prudent to note that he also performs restorative cyclical aerobic work (20-30 minutes) as well as
mobility work and stretching on the days in between his primary training days.
Week of July 20- Continue Deload, Begin Reload
*The training is illustrated starting from the beginning of a reload. Two deload sessions preceded this one in the
same calendar week
Primary Upper Reload 1
General Warm Up- up to you
1.
Pre-Training, Repeat this series x 2: (rest between movements is up to you)
2.
Mcgill Bird Dog RLRL
3.
Isometric pushup hold with a med ball under each hand
4.
Stir the Pot
5.
Decline Rhythmic Pushups
6.
Neck and Traps Superset
•
Leg Curl Neck Extension- 4x10
•
Bench Neck Flexion- 4x10
•
Single Arm Cable Shrug- 4x10ea
Main Training
1.
Bench Press- warm up to 80kgx5, 95kgx5, 105kgx max reps, 5min btwn sets
2.
Pushups Up/Down Easy- 3x5
3.
Close Grip Chest Supported Row- 5 x 10, increase weight each set, slow and controlled, 3-5min between sets
4.
Delts- dumbbell giant set, any 3 dumbbell exercises, no rest between movements, x 2 supersets, 2min between giant sets
5.
Biceps/Triceps Superset- your choice for exercises, 2 supersets, no rest between exercises, 2minutes between supersets
6.
Close Grip Pushups in Smith Machine- 3 x max reps, start on the bottom rung and move up 1 rung each set, 90sec btwn
sets
114
The knowledge Behind programs
James Smith
Week of July 27
Primary Lower Reload 1
General Warm up- up to you
Secondary Upper Reload 1
General Warm Up- up to you
1. Pre-Training: repeat series x 2: (rest
1. Pre-Training, Repeat this series x 2: 1. Pre-Training: repeat series x 2: (rest
(rest between movements is up to you)
between movements is up to you)
• McGill Bird dog box pattern
• Mcgill Bird Dog LLRR
• Rolling Planks
• Stir the Pot
• McGill Bird dog box pattern with legs
only (hands stay fixed on the ground)
• Iso Front Squat with 20kg barbell
• Isometric pushup hold between two
benches or boxes for a deep stretch
(back flat)
• Rolling Planks
• Dumbbell Shoulder Ext Rotation
lying face down on incline bench
• Single Leg Seated Leg Curl
between movements is up to you)
• McGill Curl ups
• Double Leg Seated Leg Curl
• Rhythmic Rebound Hops on Aerobics
step
Neck
• Leg Curl Neck Extension 3x12
• Bench Neck Flexion 3x12
Main Training
1. Pullups- 50 total reps any way you want
(do not extend elbows all the way, perform
semi-explosively)
• Decline Rhythmic Pushups
Neck
• Leg Curl Neck Extension 2x20
• Bench Neck Flexion 2x20
Main Training
1. Pushups Up/Down Easy x 3x4
2. Dumbbell Bench Press- up to
Secondary Lower Reload 1
General Warm up- up to you
• Bulgarian Split Squat
• McGill Curl ups
• Rhythmic Rolling Hops
Neck
• Leg Curl Neck Extension 4x10
• Bench Neck Flexion 4x10
Main Training
1. Pullups- 10x5 anyway you want
(do not fully extend elbows, semiexplosively)
2. High Box Squat- 100kg x 9sets x 4reps, 40kg ea x 2 x max reps, 5min btwn sets 2. Glute Ham Raise- 48 total reps
1min btwn sets
3. Any Row- 5 x 10, increase wt each any way you want, slow and controlled
movement tempo, 2min btwn sets
3. Barbell Single Leg Glute Bridge- 40kg set, 2min rest between sets, controlled
x 2 x max reps each leg, slow and controlled movement tempo in all phases
3. Low Pulley Split Squat front foot
movement tempo (the slower the better),
elevated on aerobics step- 2 x 20,each
4. Delts- pick any 3 movements and
optional rest between sets
4. Low Pulley Split Squat front foot
elevated on aerobics step- 4 x 10,each leg,
increase weight, 2min between legs and ,
2min between sets
perform 2 giant sets, slow movement
tempo, no rest between movements,
2min between giant sets
5. Biceps Superset- Pick any two
5. Glute Ham Raise- 60 total reps any
biceps exercises and perform 2
supersets, 1-2minutes rest between
supersets
6. Reverse Grip Lat Pulldown- 3 sets,
6. Any Pushup variation x 1 sets of
way you want, slow tempo
slow movement tempo
maximum reps
leg, increase weight, 2min between legs
4. Close Grip Lat Pull Down- 3 sets,
smooth movement tempo
115
The knowledge Behind programs
James Smith
Week of 8-03
Primary Upper Reload 2
General Warm Up- up to you
Primary Lower Reload 2
General Warm up- up to you
1. Pre-Training, Repeat this series x 2: (rest 1. Pre-Training: repeat series x 2: (rest
Secondary Upper Reload 2
General Warm Up- up to you
1. Pre-Training, Repeat this series x 2:
between movements is up to you)
between movements is up to you)
2. Mcgill Bird Dog RLRL
• McGill Bird dog box pattern
• Mcgill Bird Dog LLRR
3. Isometric pushup hold with a med ball
• Rolling Planks
• Stir the Pot
under each hand
• Iso Front Squat with 20kg barbell
4. Stir the Pot
• McGill Curl ups
5. Decline Rhythmic Pushups
• Double Leg Seated Leg Curl
• Isometric pushup hold between two
benches or boxes for a deep stretch (back
flat)
6. Neck and Traps Superset
• Leg Curl Neck Extension- 3x12
• Bench Neck Flexion- 3x12
• Single Arm Cable Shrug- 3x12ea
• Rhythmic Rebound Hops on Aerobics
step
Neck
• Leg Curl Neck Extension 2x20
• Bench Neck Flexion 2x20
Main Training
Main Training
7. Bench Press- warm up to 85kgx5,
1. Pullups- 5 sets of max reps any way
100kgx3, 112kgx max reps, 5min btwn sets
8. Pushups Up/Down Easy- 3x6
9. Close Grip Chest Supported Row- 4
you want (do not extend elbows all the
way, perform semi-explosively), 3min
rest btwn sets
x 12, increase weight each set, slow and
controlled, 3-5min between sets
2. High Box Squat- 100kg x 8sets x
10. Delts- dumbbell giant set, any 3
3. Barbell Single Leg Glute Bridge-
4reps, 1min btwn sets
dumbbell exercises, no rest between
movements, x 2 supersets, 2min between
giant sets
45kg x 2 x max reps each leg, slow and
controlled movement tempo (the slower
the better), optional rest between sets
11. Biceps/Triceps Superset- your choice
4. Low Pulley Split Squat front foot
for exercises, 2 supersets, no rest between
exercises, 2minutes between supersets
12. Med Grip Pushups in Smith
Machine- 3 x max reps, start on the bottom
rung and move up 1 rung each set, 90sec
btwn sets
elevated on aerobics step- 3 x 12,each
leg, increase weight, 2min between legs
and , 2min between sets
(rest between movements is up to you)
• Dumbbell Shoulder Ext Rotation lying
face down on incline bench
• Decline Rhythmic Pushups
Neck
• Leg Curl Neck Extension 4x10
• Bench Neck Flexion 4x10
Main Training
1. Pushups Up/Down Easy x 3x5
2. Dumbbell Bench Press- up to 45kg ea
x 2 x max reps, 5min btwn sets
3. Any Row- 4 x 12, increase wt each
set, 2min rest between sets, controlled
movement tempo in all phases
4. Delts- pick any 3 movements and
perform 2 giant sets, slow movement
tempo, no rest between movements, 2min
between giant sets
5. Biceps Superset- Pick any two
biceps exercises and perform 2 supersets,
1-2minutes rest between supersets
5. Glute Ham Raise- 70 total reps any 6. Any Pushup variation x 1 sets of
way you want, slow tempo
6. Reverse Grip Lat Pulldown- 3 sets,
slow movement tempo
maximum reps
116
The knowledge Behind programs
James Smith
Week of 8-10
* Primary Upper Reload 3- I’m giving you the option to work up to a 1RM; however, it is imperative that you pay attention to how
your strength feels as you are working up on the sets with 85kg and 100kg. If you are not feeling exceptional I do not want you to
test the 1RM. Instead, I want you to perform 4-5 heavy singles with either 112kg or a greater weight that you are certain you can
manage for 4-5 x 1.
Secondary Lower Reload 2
Primary Upper Reload 3
Primary Lower Reload 3
General Warm up- up to you
General Warm Up- up to you
General Warm up- up to you
1. Pre-Training: repeat series x 2: (rest
1. Pre-Training, Repeat this series x 2:
1. Pre-Training: repeat series x 2: (rest
• McGill Bird dog box pattern with legs
only (hands stay fixed on the ground)
2. Mcgill Bird Dog RLRL
• McGill Bird dog box pattern
• Rolling Planks
3. Isometric pushup hold with a med ball
• Rolling Planks
under each hand
• Iso Front Squat with 20kg barbell
4. Stir the Pot
• McGill Curl ups
5. Decline Rhythmic Pushups
• Double Leg Seated Leg Curl
between movements is up to you)
• Bulgarian Split Squat
• McGill Curl ups
• Single Leg Seated Leg Curl
• Rhythmic Rolling Hops
Neck
• Leg Curl Neck Extension 3x12
• Bench Neck Flexion 3x12
Main Training
(rest between movements is up to you)
6. Neck and Traps Superset
• Leg Curl Neck Extension- 2x20
• Bench Neck Flexion- 2x20
• Single Arm Cable Shrug- 2x20ea
Main Training
1. Pullups- 10x6 anyway you want (do not 1. Bench Press- warm up to 85kgx5,
fully extend elbows, semi-explosively)
2. Glute Ham Raise- 56 total reps
any way you want, slow and controlled
movement tempo, 2min btwn sets
3. Low Pulley Split Squat front foot
elevated on aerobics step- 2 x 16,each leg,
increase weight, 2min between legs
4. Close Grip Lat Pull Down- 3 sets,
smooth movement tempo
100kgx3, 112kgx1, *up to 1RM, 5min
btwn sets
between movements is up to you)
• Rhythmic Rebound Hops on
Aerobics step
Neck
• Leg Curl Neck Extension 4x10
• Bench Neck Flexion 4x10
Main Training
1. Pullups- 3 sets of max reps any
2. Pushups Up/Down Easy- 3x7
way you want (do not extend elbows
all the way, perform semi-explosively),
3min rest btwn sets
3. Close Grip Chest Supported Row-
2. High Box Squat- 100kg x 7sets x
15,12,10,8, increase weight each set, slow
and controlled, 3-5min between sets
4reps, 1min btwn sets
4. Delts- dumbbell giant set, any 3
dumbbell exercises, no rest between
movements, x 2 supersets, 2min between
giant sets
50kg x 2 x max reps each leg, slow
and controlled movement tempo
(the slower the better), optional rest
between sets
5. Biceps/Triceps Superset- your choice
4. Low Pulley Split Squat front
for exercises, 2 supersets, no rest between
exercises, 2minutes between supersets
6. Wide Grip Pushups in Smith
3. Barbell Single Leg Glute Bridge-
foot elevated on aerobics step12,10,8,each leg, increase weight, 2min
between legs and , 2min between sets
Machine- 3 x max reps, start on the bottom 5. Glute Ham Raise- 80 total reps
any way you want, slow tempo
rung and move up 1 rung each set, 90sec
btwn sets
6. Reverse Grip Lat Pulldown- 3
sets, slow movement tempo
117
The knowledge Behind programs
James Smith
Week of 8-17- Begin Deload
Secondary Upper Reload 3
General Warm Up- up to you
Secondary Lower Reload 3
General Warm up- up to you
Primary Upper Deload
General Warm Up- up to you
1. Pre-Training, Repeat this series x 2: (rest 1. Pre-Training: repeat series x 2: (rest
between movements is up to you)
between movements is up to you)
1. Pre-Training, Repeat this series x 2:
• Mcgill Bird Dog LLRR
• McGill Bird dog box pattern with legs
only (hands stay fixed on the ground)
2. Mcgill Bird Dog RLRL
• Isometric pushup hold between two
benches or boxes for a deep stretch (back
flat)
• Rolling Planks
on the floor
• Dumbbell Shoulder Ext Rotation lying
face down on incline bench
• Single Leg Seated Leg Curl
• Stir the Pot
• Decline Rhythmic Pushups
Neck
• Leg Curl Neck Extension 3x12
• Bench Neck Flexion 3x12
Main Training
1. Pushups Up/Down Easy x 3x6
• Bulgarian Split Squat
• McGill Curl ups
• Rhythmic Rolling Hops
Neck
• Leg Curl Neck Extension 2x20
3. Any Row- 15,12,10,8, increase wt
3. Isometric pushup hold with hands
4. Stir the Pot
5. Decline Rhythmic Pushups
6. Neck and Traps Superset
• Any Neck Extension- 4x10
• Any Neck Flexion- 4x10
• Bench Neck Flexion 2x20
• Any Shrug- 4x10ea
Main Training
Main Training
1. Pullups- 10x7 anyway you want (do
1. Bench Press- warm up to 85kg x 5
not fully extend elbows, semi-explosively)
x 3, 3min btwn sets
any way you want, slow and controlled
movement tempo, 2min btwn sets
3. Neutral Grip Chest Supported
2. Dumbbell Bench Press- up to 50kg ea x 2. Glute Ham Raise- 64 total reps
2 x max reps, 5min btwn sets
(rest between movements is up to you)
2. Clapping Pushups- 3x5
Row- 15,12,10,8, increase weight
each set, slow and controlled, 3-5min
3. Low Pulley Split Squat front foot
elevated on aerobics step- 2 x 12,each leg, between sets
increase weight, 2min between legs
4. Delts- pick any 3 movements and
4. Delts- dumbbell giant set, any 3
perform 2 giant sets, slow movement tempo, 4. Close Grip Lat Pull Down- 3 sets,
dumbbell exercises, no rest between
no rest between movements, 2min between
movements, x 2 supersets, 2min
smooth movement tempo
giant sets
between giant sets
each set, 2min rest between sets, controlled
movement tempo in all phases
5. Biceps Superset- Pick any two
biceps exercises and perform 2 supersets,
1-2minutes rest between supersets
6. Any Pushup variation x 1 sets of
maximum reps
5. Biceps/Triceps Superset- your
choice for exercises, 2 supersets, no rest
between exercises, 2minutes between
supersets
6. Close Grip Pushups with feet
elevated on bench/hands on floor- 3 x
max reps, , 90sec btwn sets
118
The knowledge Behind programs
James Smith
Week of 8-24 Continue Deload
Primary Lower Deload
General Warm up- up to you
Secondary Upper Deload
General Warm Up- up to you
1. Pre-Training: repeat series x 2: (rest
1. Pre-Training, Repeat this series x 2: 1. Pre-Training: repeat series x 2: (rest
(rest between movements is up to you)
between movements is up to you)
• McGill Bird dog box pattern
• Mcgill Bird Dog LLRR
• Rolling Planks
• Stir the Pot
• McGill Bird dog box pattern with legs only
(hands stay fixed on the ground)
• Iso Back Squat with 20kg barbell
• Isometric pushup hold with feet
elevated on bench (back flat)
• Rolling Planks
• Alternate Reverse Lunge
• Single Leg Seated Leg Curl
• Cable Face Pull with rope attachment
• McGill Curl ups
• Rhythmic Rebound Hops on Aerobics
step
• Decline Rhythmic Pushups
• Single Leg Lying Leg Curl
Neck
• Rhythmic Rolling Hops
Neck
• Any Neck Extension 2x20
Neck
• Any Neck Extension 3x12
• Any Neck Flexion 2x20
• Any Neck Extension 4x10
• Any Neck Flexion 3x12
Main Training
• Any Neck Flexion 4x10
Main Training
1. Clapping Pushups x 3x5
Main Training
1. Pullups- 10 x 3, 30-45sec btwn sets,
2. Dumbbell Floor Press- up to 30kg
1. Pullups- 6 x 3, 30-45sec anyway you
between movements is up to you)
• McGill Curl ups
any way you want (do not extend elbows
all the way, perform semi-explosively)
2. High Box Squat- 70kg x 10sets x
ea x 2 x max reps, 5min btwn sets
3. Any Row- 1, increase wt each
3reps, 1min btwn sets
set, 2min rest between sets, controlled
movement tempo in all phases
3. Barbell Double Leg Glute Bridge-
4. Delts- pick any 3 movements and
100kg x 2 sets of sub-max reps, slow and
controlled movement tempo (the slower
the better), optional rest between sets
4. Dumbbell Split Squat rear foot
elevated on bench- 2 x 15,each leg,
same weight, 2min between legs and ,
2min between sets
5. Glute Ham Raise- 50 total reps any
way you want, slow tempo
6. Wide Grip Lat Pulldown- 3 sets,
slow movement tempo
Secondary Lower Deload
General Warm up- up to you
want (do not fully extend elbows, semiexplosively)
2. Glute Ham Raise- 40 total reps any way
you want, slow and controlled movement
tempo, 2min btwn sets
perform 2 giant sets, slow movement
tempo, no rest between movements,
2min between giant sets
3. Dumbbell Split Squat rear foot elevated
5. Biceps Superset- Pick any two
4. Close Neutral Grip Lat Pull Down- 3
biceps exercises and perform 2
supersets, 1-2minutes rest between
supersets
6. Any Pushup variation x 1 sets of
maximum reps
on bench- 2 x 12,each leg, same weight, 2min
between legs
sets, smooth movement tempo
119
The knowledge Behind programs
James Smith
Week of 8-31- Reload
Primary Upper 1 of 3
General Warm Up- up to you
Primary Lower 1 of 3
General Warm up- up to you
Secondary Upper 1 of 3
General Warm Up- up to you
1. Pre-Training, Repeat this series x 2:
1. Pre-Training: repeat series x 2: (rest
1. Pre-Training, Repeat this series x 2:
2. Mcgill Bird Dog RLRL
• McGill Bird dog box pattern
• Mcgill Bird Dog LLRR
(rest between movements is up to you)
between movements is up to you)
3. Isometric pushup hold with hands on • Rolling Planks
(rest between movements is up to you)
• Stir the Pot
the floor
• Iso Back Squat with 20kg barbell
4. Stir the Pot
• McGill Curl ups
5. Decline Rhythmic Pushups
• Single Leg Seated Leg Curl
• Cable Face Pull with rope attachment
• Rhythmic Rebound Hops on Aerobics
step
• Decline Rhythmic Pushups
Neck
Neck
• Any Neck Extension 4x10
• Any Neck Extension 2x20
• Any Neck Flexion 4x10
6. Neck and Traps Superset
• Any Neck Extension- 3x12
• Any Neck Flexion- 3x12
• Any Shrug- 3x12ea
• Isometric pushup hold with feet elevated
on bench (back flat)
• Any Neck Flexion 2x20
Main Training
Main Training
Main Training
1. Bench Press- warm up to a 5RM,
1. Clapping Pushups x 3x5
1. Pullups- 9 x 4, 30-45sec btwn sets, any 2. Dumbbell Floor Press- up to 35kg ea
3min btwn sets, then drop down to 80%
of that weight for 3 sets of max reps,
5min btwn sets
2. Clapping Pushups- 3x5
3. Neutral Grip Chest Supported
way you want (do not extend elbows all the x 2 x max reps, 5min btwn sets
way, perform semi-explosively)
3. Any Row- 5x10, increase wt each
2. High Box Squat- 100kg x 6sets x
set, 2min rest between sets, controlled
5reps, 1min btwn sets
movement tempo in all phases
3. Barbell Double Leg Glute BridgeRow- 12,10,8,8 increase weight each set, 100kg x 2 sets of max reps, slow and
slow and controlled, 3-5min between sets controlled movement tempo (the slower the
better), optional rest between sets
4. Delts- dumbbell giant set, any 3
dumbbell exercises, no rest between
4. Dumbbell Split Squat rear foot
movements, x 3 supersets, 2min between elevated on bench- 3 x 12,each leg, same
giant sets
weight, 2min between legs and , 2min
5. Biceps/Triceps Superset- your
choice for exercises, 3 supersets, no rest
between exercises, 2minutes between
supersets
6. Med Grip Pushups with feet
elevated on bench/hands on floor- 3 x
max reps, , 90sec btwn sets
between sets
5. Glute Ham Raise- 60 total reps any
way you want, slow tempo
6. Reverse Grip Lat Pulldown- 3 sets,
slow movement tempo
4. Delts- pick any 3 movements and
perform 3 giant sets, slow movement
tempo, no rest between movements, 2min
between giant sets
5. Biceps Superset- Pick any two
biceps exercises and perform 3 supersets,
1-2minutes rest between supersets
6. Any Pushup variation x 1 sets of
maximum reps
120
The knowledge Behind programs
James Smith
Week of 9-7
Secondary Lower 1 of 3
General Warm up- up to you
Primary Upper 2 of 3
General Warm Up- up to you
1. Pre-Training: repeat series x 2:
1. Pre-Training, Repeat this series x 2:
(rest between movements is up to you) (rest between movements is up to you)
• McGill Bird dog box pattern with
legs only (hands stay fixed on the
ground)
• Rolling Planks
• Alternate Reverse Lunge
2. Mcgill Bird Dog RLRL
3. Isometric pushup hold with hands on
the floor
4. Stir the Pot
Primary Lower 2 of 3
General Warm up- up to you
1. Pre-Training: repeat series x 2:
(rest between movements is up to
you)
• McGill Bird dog box pattern
• Rolling Planks
• Iso Back Squat with 20kg barbell
• McGill Curl ups
• McGill Curl ups
5. Decline Rhythmic Pushups
• Single Leg Lying Leg Curl
6. Neck and Traps Superset
• Rhythmic Rolling Hops
• Any Neck Extension- 2x20
• Rhythmic Rebound Hops on
Aerobics step
Neck
• Any Neck Flexion- 2x20
Neck
• Any Neck Extension 3x12
• Any Shrug- 2x20
• Any Neck Extension 4x10
• Any Neck Flexion 3x12
Main Training
• Any Neck Flexion 4x10
Main Training
Main Training
1. Pullups- 6 x 4, 30-45sec anyway
1. Bench Press- warm up to a 3RM,
3min btwn sets, then drop down to 70%
of that weight for 3 sets of max reps,
5min btwn sets
2. Glute Ham Raise- 40 total reps
2. Clapping Pushups- 3x6
foot elevated on aerobics step- 3
x 12,each leg, same weight, 2min
between legs
4. Delts- dumbbell giant set, any 3
dumbbell exercises, no rest between
movements, x 3 supersets, 2min between
giant sets
Bridge- 110kg x 2 sets of max reps,
slow and controlled movement
tempo (the slower the better),
optional rest between sets
5. Biceps/Triceps Superset- your
4. Dumbbell Split Squat rear foot
choice for exercises, 3 supersets, no rest
between exercises, 2minutes between
supersets
elevated on bench- 3 x 10,each leg,
same weight, 2min between legs and
, 2min between sets
6. Wide Grip Pushups with feet
elevated on bench/hands on floor- 3 x
max reps, , 90sec btwn sets
5. Glute Ham Raise- 70 total reps
you want (do not fully extend elbows,
semi-explosively)
• Single Leg Seated Leg Curl
1. Pullups- 8 x 4, 30-45sec btwn
sets, any way you want (do not
extend elbows all the way, perform
semi-explosively)
any way you want, slow and controlled 3. Neutral Grip Chest Supported
2. High Box Squat- 100kg x 5sets
movement tempo, 2min btwn sets
x 6reps, 1min btwn sets
Row- 4x10 increase weight each set,
slow and controlled, 3-5min between sets 3. Barbell Double Leg Glute
3. Dumbbell Split Squat front
4. Wide Neutral Grip Lat Pull
Down- 3 sets, smooth movement
tempo
any way you want, slow tempo
6. Reverse Grip Lat Pulldown- 3
sets, slow movement tempo
121
The knowledge Behind programs
James Smith
Week of 9-14
*For primary upper 3 of 3 you once again have the option to work up to a 1RM (only if you feel good). If you don’t then, work
up to heavy, but not maximal single, then drop down to 60% of that for 3 sets of max reps with 5min in between
Secondary Upper 2 of 3
General Warm Up- up to you
Secondary Lower 2 of 3
General Warm up- up to you
1. Pre-Training, Repeat this series x
1. Pre-Training: repeat series x 2: (rest 1. Pre-Training, Repeat this series x 2:
between movements is up to you)
(rest between movements is up to you)
• Mcgill Bird Dog LLRR
• McGill Bird dog box pattern with legs
only (hands stay fixed on the ground)
2. Mcgill Bird Dog RLRL
• Stir the Pot
• Rolling Planks
• Isometric pushup hold with feet
elevated on bench (back flat)
• Alternate Reverse Lunge
the floor
• Cable Face Pull with rope
attachment
• Single Leg Lying Leg Curl
2: (rest between movements is up to
you)
• Decline Rhythmic Pushups
Neck
• Any Neck Extension 3x12
• Any Neck Flexion 3x12
Main Training
1. Clapping Pushups x 3x6
2. Dumbbell Floor Press- up to
40kg ea x 2 x max reps, 5min btwn
sets
• McGill Curl ups
• Rhythmic Rolling Hops
Neck
• Any Neck Extension 2x20
• Any Neck Flexion 2x20
Main Training
1. Pullups- 6 x 5, 60sec btwn anyway
you want (do not fully extend elbows,
semi-explosively)
2. Glute Ham Raise- 50 total reps
any way you want, slow and controlled
3. Any Row- 4x10, increase wt each movement tempo, 2min btwn sets
set, 2min rest between sets, controlled 3. Dumbbell Split Squat front foot
movement tempo in all phases
elevated on aerobics step- 3 x 10,each
Primary Upper 3 of 3
General Warm Up- up to you
3. Isometric pushup hold with hands on
4. Stir the Pot
5. Decline Rhythmic Pushups
6. Neck and Traps Superset
• Any Neck Extension- 4x10
• Any Neck Flexion- 4x10
• Any Shrug- 4x10
Main Training
1. Bench Press- warm up to a 1RM, 3min
btwn sets, then drop down to 60% of that
weight for 3 sets of max reps, 5min btwn
sets
2. Clapping Pushups- 3x7
3. Neutral Grip Chest Supported Row3x10 increase weight each set, slow and
controlled, 3-5min between sets
4. Delts- pick any 3 movements and leg, same weight, 2min between legs
perform 3 giant sets, slow movement 4. Wide Neutral Grip Lat Pull
4. Delts- dumbbell giant set, any 3
5. Biceps Superset- Pick any two
5. Biceps/Triceps Superset- your choice
tempo, no rest between movements,
2min between giant sets
biceps exercises and perform 3
supersets, 1-2minutes rest between
supersets
6. Any Pushup variation x 1 sets of
maximum reps
dumbbell exercises, no rest between
Down- 3 sets, smooth movement tempo movements, x 3 supersets, 2min between
giant sets
for exercises, 3 supersets, no rest between
exercises, 2minutes between supersets
6. Close Grip Pushups with feet
elevated on bench/hands on floor- 3 x
max reps, , 90sec btwn sets
122
The knowledge Behind programs
James Smith
Week of 9-21
Primary Lower 3 of 3
General Warm up- up to you
Secondary Upper 3 of 3
General Warm Up- up to you
Secondary Lower 3 of 3
General Warm up- up to you
1.Pre-Training: repeat series x 2: (rest
1. Pre-Training, Repeat this series x 2:
1. Pre-Training: repeat series x 2: (rest
•McGill Bird dog box pattern
• Mcgill Bird Dog LLRR
•Rolling Planks
• Stir the Pot
• McGill Bird dog box pattern with legs
only (hands stay fixed on the ground)
•Single Leg Seated Leg Curl
• Cable Face Pull with rope attachment
• McGill Curl ups
•Rhythmic Rebound Hops on Aerobics
step
• Decline Rhythmic Pushups
• Single Leg Lying Leg Curl
Neck
• Rhythmic Rolling Hops
Neck
• Any Neck Extension 2x20
Neck
•Any Neck Extension 3x12
• Any Neck Flexion 2x20
• Any Neck Extension 4x10
•Any Neck Flexion 3x12
Main Training
• Any Neck Flexion 4x10
Main Training
1. Clapping Pushups x 3x7
Main Training
1. Pullups- 7 x 4, 45-60sec btwn
2. Dumbbell Floor Press- up to 45kg ea
1. Pullups- 5 x 6, 60-80sec btwn anyway
between movements is up to you)
•Iso Back Squat with 20kg barbell
•McGill Curl ups
sets, any way you want (do not extend
elbows all the way, perform semiexplosively)
2. High Box Squat- 100kg x 4sets x
7reps, 1min btwn sets
(rest between movements is up to you)
• Isometric pushup hold with feet elevated • Rolling Planks
on bench (back flat)
• Alternate Reverse Lunge
x 2 x max reps, 5min btwn sets
3. Any Row- 3x10, increase wt each
set, 2min rest between sets, controlled
movement tempo in all phases
4. Delts- pick any 3 movements and
3. Barbell Double Leg Glute Bridge- perform 3 giant sets, slow movement
120kg x 2 sets of max reps, slow and
tempo, no rest between movements, 2min
controlled movement tempo (the slower between giant sets
the better), optional rest between sets
5. Biceps Superset- Pick any two
4. Dumbbell Split Squat rear foot
biceps exercises and perform 3 supersets,
elevated on bench- 3 x 8,each leg,
1-2minutes rest between supersets
same weight, 2min between legs and ,
6. Any Pushup variation x 1 sets of
2min between sets
maximum reps
5. Glute Ham Raise- 80 total reps any
way you want, slow tempo
6. Reverse Grip Lat Pulldown- 3
between movements is up to you)
you want (do not fully extend elbows,
semi-explosively)
2. Glute Ham Raise- 60 total reps
any way you want, slow and controlled
movement tempo, 2min btwn sets
3. Dumbbell Split Squat front foot
elevated on aerobics step- 3 x 8,each leg,
same weight, 2min between legs
4. Wide Neutral Grip Lat Pull Down- 3
sets, smooth movement tempo
sets, slow movement tempo
James Smith:
Professional duties have included stations in 3 countries. Coaching or consulting roles have spanned the Olympic, International,
Professional, University, High/Secondary School and private sector levels. Work positions have included: track and field coach/
consultant, physical preparation coach/consultant, Program Director, and Senior National Physical Preparation Coach with
Performance Director responsibility for the Portuguese Rugby Federation. Presentations on global sport concepts have been given in
5 different countries. Consulting duties have spanned work with coaches/athletes from the NFL, CFL, Collegiate American Football,
United Kingdom Athletics, Jamaican Track and Field, US Collegiate Track and Field, US National Luge, Super 15 Rugby, Premiership
Rugby, Rabo Direct Pro 12 Rugby, English Premier League Football, Croatian Water Polo, USA Volleyball, Mixed Martial Arts, and a
variety of other Olympic sports disciplines. Military special operations, Paramilitary, and Law Enforcement clients have included:
operators from USAF Para Rescue, US Navy SEAL Teams, US Navy Divers, Swedish Särskilda Skyddsgruppen, US Army Special
Forces, Federal Air Marshals, Para Military Contractors, and Corrections Officers.
8 Week Shoulder
Blaster Program
T
his is an 8 week shoulder program that I
used to bring up my delts for my physique
shows. I still did a heavy chest day. Having a
concentrated shoulder day proved to be extremely
beneficial for bringing up my delts.
This program can be utilized intermediate
or advanced lifters. It can be used as a standalone shoulder program for an aesthetic based
bodybuilding regimen. If using it for mass gains, I
suggest the following split:
Legs
Chest & light shoulders
Arms
Back/lats
Shoulders & light chest (this workout)
It can also be adding to a powerlifting program as a
separate supplemental shoulder day (in addition to
max effort and dynamic effort days). If adding it to
a powerlifting program, I suggest the following:
Max effort bench with lat work, triceps and light
shoulders
Dynamic bench (3 days later) with back work and
triceps
Shoulder day (this workout, the day after dynamic
bench) with shoulders and curls optional.
The idea behind it is to get some concentrated
shoulder work in rather than doing it at the end
Julia Ladewski
of a bench day with only 1 or 2 small exercises.
With this, the volume and intensity is higher, so
take that into consideration with your other bench
days as well. Recovery is still important, but it does
give a good blend for those looking to maintain or
increase strength and bring up a lagging body part.
WEEK 1
•
•
•
•
•
BB Overhead Press
work to heavy 5
DOWNSETS, 2x10
DB Hex Press
4x12
Pec Minor Dips- 4xfailure
superset with
Band Over & Backs- 4x10
Grenade/Band Rear flyes
3x30
For these, attach bands to a post and attach
two 3” Grenades to the band with large
carabiners.
6 Way shoulder
3x10
8 Week Shoulder blaster program
124
julia Ladewski
WEEK 2
•
•
•
•
•
Timed DB Overhead Press
1 press every 6 seconds for 2 minutes x 3 sets
Face Pulls
4x20
Side Chain Laterals
3x10, 1x20
Scarecrows
3x10
Feet elevated Pushups
8 pushups every 30 seconds
Work to failure or 100, whichever comes first
WEEK 3
•
•
•
•
•
BB Overhead Press
work up to heavy 5
Down set of 5 with a 3 sec up, 3 sec down
6 way shoulder
3x10
Rear delt destroyer set
60 reps partial
30 reps partial
15 reps full range
Dumbell hex press
4x12
Ladder pushups
3 different positions on the rack.
Pushups to failure on each position.
WEEK 4
•
•
•
Swiss bar Overhead press
Used the 3 neutral grips. Started with narrow
one first and work your way out.
1st set- 5 reps at each grip
2nd set- 4 reps at each
3rd set- 3 reps at each
2nd set- 2 reps at each
Leaning side raise
4x40 seconds
Seated dumbbell cleans
4x20 reps
•
•
SUPERSET WITH
Band pull aparts 4x10
Band chest press
3x10 w/ hold
Chain fly/press combo
3x8 each
WEEK 5
•
•
•
•
•
•
6 way Shoulders
3x10
Bradford press
5x5
(Downset of over/back+full overhead press = 1
rep)
2x8
Alt. DB OH Press
x40, 36, 38
J Walking w/ micro mini around wrists
2 sets (1 down the rack, 1 up)
Chain Flyes
3x12
superset with
TRX Pushups
3x12
WEEK 6
•
•
•
•
•
Overhead press
6 second rep (3 ct up, 3 ct down) - 3x10
Chain Side Laterals - 4x12
Serrano OH Press
4x8
Face Pulls for a song
Band Flyes
3x15
Reverse Band Bench
100 total reps
WEEK 7
•
•
Serrano Overhead Press
3x8 each
BB Military (standing)
4x6
8 Week Shoulder blaster program
•
•
•
•
•
125
Bradford - 3 sec back, 3 sec forward
3x12 (6 over and backs)
TRI SET WITH
Band side raises
4x20
TRI SET WITH
Rear delt (hang and swing)
4x15
Grenade chain flyes
4x12
Ladder pushups- 4 levels
failure at each level
WEEK 8
•
•
•
•
•
Rear/Side/Front Raise
3x20 reps each, non-stop
DB Arnold Press
4x12
Rear Delt Rows
4x10 (last set drop set of 10, 10, 10)
DB Flyes
4x8+6 w/ manual resistance
Banded Chest Press
4x1 minute timed
Julia Ladewski, CSCS, is a coach to athletes, women, men,
powerlifters, crossfitters, fitness enthusiasts, recreational lifters
and those seeking body transformation. She takes pride in helping
people from all walks of life to see and reach their full potential.
Julia was a Division I University strength & conditioning coach
from 2002-09 at the University at Buffalo, where she worked
with every sport on campus. From 2009-2014, she was Director
of Sports Performance at Parisi Speed School in Schererville, IN.
As an elitefts.com sponsored athlete and Q&A staff member, Julia
is an elite-level powerlifter in three different weight classes. She
is also a physique competitor, mother to two children, and wife
to husband Matt. Julia also owns Bella Forza Strength Apparel
(www.BellaForza.me). She continues to write and speak about
youth sports performance, female strength sports, and nutrition.
She is one of the best hands-on technical coaches in the country.
Her writing can be found on elitefts.com and JuliaLadewski.
com. She is also a member of the Institutional Review Board for
MusclePharm.
julia Ladewski
Perfecting Your
Bench Work
4
Scott Yard
lessons that have had an impact on the platform He taught me to take 135 as seriously as 1000. He
and a back to basics approach to assistance showed me that even though I’m strong that doesn’t
bench work.
make me good and strength is only half the battle.
You need to practice your technique and get better.
I am going to preface this article by stating that I am I learned that you should try and get better in the
not the most qualified person in this eBook. The gym with each rep.
truth is I wish I knew more and could offer more.
With that being said I am very fortunate though to Powerlifting is a marathon not a sprint. Chase PRs,
have 15 years of competitive platform experience not milestones. A 5lb pr is better than no pr.
under my belt and during those 15 years I have had
the luxury of knowing many smart people and have This is something I learned early on when I was in
had many great conversations, tips, and pointers to gear and making my way towards my first 800lb
give me the information I have lacked.
bench. To date I have done 840 in a full meet and at
one point was the best bencher in the world in a full
The purpose of this article is to share some of the meet. Before that happened I was a 735 bencher and
great things I have learned over the years. I aim to was being told I was on the way to 800. I listened to
Live, learn, and pass on. Being a part of ELITEFTS the hype and started taking shots at 800. I missed
had been a blessing for me these past 8 years and I them all lol. I started to think and my wife asked
hope this article can help one of you reading this. If me why I kept doing so badly at meets. I told her I
I can help just one person do better my mission was just missed 800 and I was close. She said why not
accomplished.
just do 740 first. I thought she was nuts. 740? But
I want 800. I realized then that I was chasing mile
Get better, not just stronger.
stones and not prs like I should be. The next meet I
did I opened at 675 and went 740 for a pr. I then did
I used to train with a guy name Matt Wilson. Matt was 770. The next meet I did 775. I did this and finally
an 1105 squatter and very technical. I would come hit my 800. It took longer but in the end it was the
up to train with him and he was always reminding right way to do it. I stopped wasting training cycles
me of how much I needed to work on things. At on long shots and walked away from meets being
my own gym all I ever heard was “smoke show” or better then I was from the last meet.
that was easy. At Matt’s gym all I heard was “that
was high” or why are you rushing your warm ups”. Worry about yourself, not the next guy on deck.
Perfecting your bench work
127
When you are competing you are really just
competing against yourself. Some may disagree but
it isn’t a sport based on skill or miracles. You can
either lift the weight or you can’t. The ability to hit
the weight is based on genetics, your training cycle,
and the years of iron under your belt. No one goes
to a meet and hits a 100lb deadlift pr for the win.
Powerlifting doesn’t have anything equivalent to the
1/2 court shot at the buzzer. The point of this is that
it is better to get a pr on a third pull and hit a huge pr
total then to go for something stupid on the deadlift
you will never hit for the win. Again some will think
this is crazy but I will take a big pr total any day over
I almost got first but now I settled for 5th. Take
second and win next year by actually being stronger
than everyone else.
Cutting weight isn’t always a good idea.
Stop cutting weight and start getting stronger. I
see so many new lifters doing the first meet and
cutting to 181 or 220. STOP IT. This is absurd. The
only thing you should be doing at your first meet is
focusing on getting all 9 attempts. Unless you are
trying to be a top 20 lifter or going for a record it’s
not worth it. This even goes for when you are going
for a record or too. Cutting large amounts of weight
is hell on your body. I did the Arnold bench bash in
2007. I came in third overall with an 828 bench. I
went from 305 to 275 in two days. I was lucky to
hit 828 but should have gone in at 305 and benched
865-870. The 308 record was 859 at the time and
I was so hell bent on going 275 that I never even
looked at the 308 records. I focused on a weight
class instead of a pr and it cost me. Looking back no
one cares what I weighed for the bench bash. I was
still 3rd. If I focused on the task at hand of lifting the
heaviest weight possible and performing to my best
I might be bragging about a bigger bench then 840.
Always choose performance over a division.
In summary
Get better not just stronger.
Scott yard
Best yourself, and focus on PRs. Not landmarks
Best yourself and focus on your meet, not someone
else’s
Put performance first over any division
A back to basics approach for raw bench assistance
work.
With those things in mind I will leave you with an
outline of how I have handled my last two bench
meet cycles. I will outline my assistance work and
things that have helped me. The main bench work
has consisted of lots of singles, rest pause work
and cat sets. Check out josh Bryant’s book sold at
elitefts.com titled bench press the science for more
details on those. In 2009 I benched 505 raw in a full
meet and was doing well going into my next meet
for a pr. Long story short I tore my bicep tendon and
sprained my ac joint and was stuck in the high 400s
for 4 years until March of this year. I decided to go old
school and add in bodybuilding type movements and
focus on getting bigger and stronger. I also realized
I need over head work. The problem was over head
work hurt my shoulder. My solution for overhead
work was the elitefts Swiss press bar and the elitefts
shoulder saver pad. I found with these two I could
do over head work. I alternate between incline and
over head presses. I use a close grip for shoulder
safety and like to use high reps and heavy reps. Peck
work is a must for raw benches. I neglected my pecs
for years buying into the hype that pecks don’t help
your bench. I added in peck work and my bench
went up. Heavy flies in the incline and flat variety
are key. Push downs and band work for the triceps
won’t cut it. I told myself my elbows were sore and I
could get away with fluffy crap for my triceps. I got
back to barbell and heavy db work for my triceps and
again I hit PRs. Basics work and we all must return
to them. Below is how I worked these movements in
for my past two meet cycles. I went from struggling
with high 400s last year to hitting 510 in March and
525 in July.
Perfecting your bench work
128
Scott yard
The chart bellows shows how I use these movements in a 12 week cycle. Like I said I always bench heavy
first followed by cat and dead work. These movements follow the main work and are done in left to right
order.
Week
Delt / tricep
movement
Strict over head press
Max set of 6
Chest movement
Tricep movement
Incline fly
8-10 reps
Strict over head press
Max set of 12
Close grip incline
Max set of 4
Low incline fly
8-10 reps
Flat fly
8-10 reps
Close grip tricep ext
off pins with chain
max set of 5
Lying palms in db ext
Max set of 10
Lying barbell exts
3 sets of 8 with same
weight
4
5
Deload
Close grip incline
Max set of 2
Flat fly
6
Strict over head press
Max set of 10
Close grip incline for
max single
Incline fly
8-10 reps
Low incline fly
8-10 reps
8
Deload
9
Strict over head press
Max Set of 8
Flat fly
8-10 reps
Incline fly
8-10 reps
10
11
Close grip incline for
set of 8 at 80%
Deload
12
Meet day
1
2
3
7
Low incline fly
8-10 reps
Flat fly
8-10 reps
Close grip tricep ext
off pins with chain
max set of 5
Lying palms in db ext
Max set of 10
Lying barbell exts
3 sets of 8 with same
weight
Close grip tricep ext
off pins with chain
max set of 5
Lying palms in db ext
Max set of 10
Lying barbell exts
3 sets of 8 with same
weight
The over head press work is done with the elitefts Swiss press bar close grip for higher reps to keep the
shoulders working but healthy and safe. The close grip incline is done with an elitefts shoulder saver pad
to protect my shoulders but hammer the triceps pecks, and delts with heavy weights. The flies and exts are
done heavy and changed weekly for variety. The key is to be strict but heavy and always shoot for weight or
rep pr. Complacency equals stagnation, and stagnation equals death. Always try to be better and you will.
Perfecting your bench work
129
Scott yard
Bio:
Scott Yard is a 2004 graduate of Western Maryland College. He is a 15 year veteran to the sport of power lifting who has lifted
on many stages. As an equipped lifter in 2006 Scott broke the all-time world record total for the 275-pound class. This was done
at the age of 23. His 2605-pound total consists of a 1050 squat, 840 bench, and a 715 deadlift. Scott’s 840 bench at one time was
the heaviest recorded bench to date in a full meet across all weight classes. In early 2007 Scott placed third overall in the 242 plus
division at the WPO ARNOLD bench bash. Later that year Scott placed third in the 242 plus division at the inaugural IPA PRO-AM.
Scott currently competes raw. In November of 2010 he fulfilled a long term goal of totaling 2000 lbs raw with wraps in the 275
weight class. Scotts best competition raw with wraps lifts include 765 in the squat, 505 in the bench, and 755 in the deadlift. Scott
also competes raw in the USAPL and won 2011 USAPL Raw nationals in the 242 class. In March of 2012 Scott competed at the Arnold
Raw Challenge at the 231 weight class and came in second place. In 2014 Scott continues to compete raw and has squatted 700
raw without wraps, benched 525, and totaled 1925 with a belt only. Scott has held American and world records in the APF, APA, IPA,
USAPL, and RPS powerlifting organizations. Scott trains out of Club Natural Gym in Hanover, Pennsylvania, and hopes to compete
for many years to come. By day Scott is a husband and father of two girls and is the director of vocational services for a nonprofit
agency that supports Adults with developmental disabilities.
Strength Training Program
for Ultra-Marathoners
T
his year brought an unexpected challenge
from two former clients of mine. One was
participating in a 100 kilometre race while
the other was going to run 50 kilometres of the race
with her. The goal of my client was to complete the
race in under sixteen hours to ensure she received
the beer stein that was awarded to all participants
who finished in under that time.
Both of these clients had significant injury histories
relating to their hips, glutes and calves. The brief
they provided to me was simple:
•
•
•
Get them stronger for the race;
Address their existing injuries as much as
possible; and
Avoid any new injuries.
Bill Allars
The Functional Movement Screen showed that
each of my clients has limited shoulder mobility,
problems with hip flexion and extension, a lack of
rotary stability and limited ankle mobilisation for
one client. All of these conditions were supported by
their physiotherapist who highlighted the remedial
work they were to do while noting that there were
no specific contraindications for either of them.
Given that both of my clients were avid runners, the
problems identified with hip flexion and extension
in the Functional Movement Screen surprised me
but most likely reflected a lack of gluteal function for
each of them and the ongoing hip problems that one
of them has been afflicted by.
In putting together a program for these two runners,
my focus was on the following:
All of this was to be completed in the sixteen weeks • Improving their hip mobility;
that remained prior to the race.
• Developing their ability to move in multiple
Prior to developing the program with my clients,
planes rather than the single plane that running
there were two key things that I undertook. These
required;
were:
• Address their gluteal dysfunction; and
• Strengthen the core and driver muscles to
• Completing a Functional Movement Screen on
support their running.
each of them; and
•
• Contacting their physiotherapist to review While the Functional Movement Screen identified a
their injury histories, their progress and any lack of shoulder mobility for both clients, this was
recommendations or contraindications that they not a key consideration in their program it would
identified.
not directly impact on their running goals. It is,
Strength Training Program
131
Bill Allars
• Quadruped Thoracic Rotations
• Hip Flexor Mobilisations
• Single Leg Deadlifts
• Bowler Squats
• Strength Work
• SSB Squats (5x5)
• Trap Bar Deadlifts (5x10)
• KB Single Leg Deadlifts (5x10)
• Bodyweight Lateral Lunges (5x10)
• McGill Curls (3x20)
• Super Mans (3x20)
• Stretching
• Hamstrings
Phase 1 – Rehabilitation and Prehabilitation – • Calves
• Quadriceps
Weeks 1 through 4
• Gluteals
• Lower Back
This phase was focused primarily on continuing
• Adductors
to address existing injury issues in conjunction
with the physiotherapist while also starting on the
Each week we rotated the sets and repetition schemes
process of improving their hip function.
for the SSB Squats and the Trap Bar Deadlifts. The
A standard session during this phase was:
selection of SSB Squats was deliberate as I like the
added instability that using this bar provides, forcing
• Warm Up
both clients to increase their stability and effectively
• Foam Roller (10 rolls on each site)
engage their core when completing the exercise.
• Calves
The lacrosse ball was included to allow us to identify
• Backs of Knees
and focus on addressing knots in muscles more
• Hamstrings
effectively through more focused contact than we
• Glutes
could achieve with the foam roller. The pained looks
• Quadratus Lumborum
on the faces on my clients was always a sure sign
• Lower Back
that a trigger point requiring attention had been
• Quads
identified. While they grappled with this during
• Adductors
the early phases, as they progressed with it, the
• Hip Flexors
improvement was visible.
• IT Bands
Phase 2 – Focused Strength Work – Weeks 5
• Lacrosse Ball
through 14
• Calves
• Gluteals
• Mobility Work (10 repetitions of each exercise) This phase was focused primarily on building on the
• 10 Hip Crossover
foundation we had established during the first phase
• 10 Scorpions
while maintaining or focus on rehabilitation and
prehabilitation.
• 10 Supine Scorpions
A standard workout during this phase was:
• Front Leg Raises
• Side Leg Raises
• Rear Leg Raises
• Warm Up
• Foam Roller (10 rolls on each site)
• Fire Hydrants
however, something that I will now be working with
both of them on addressing.
The program we completed was divided into the
following phases
Rehabilitation and prehabilitation;
Strength development;
Taper.
The program was amended as we progressed
to take account of the running training that was
prescribed by their running coach. This generally
wasn’t a problem but there weeks where we backed
off on load and intensity as they were particularly
high volume running weeks.
Strength Training Program
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
132
Calves
Backs of Knees
Hamstrings
Glutes
Quadratus Lumborum
Lower Back
Quads
Adductors
Hip Flexors
IT Bands
Mobility Work (10 repetitions of each exercise)
10 Hip Crossover
10 Scorpions
10 Supine Scorpions
Front Leg Raises
Side Leg Raises
Rear Leg Raises
Fire Hydrants
Quadruped Thoracic Rotations
Hip Flexor Mobilisations
Single Leg Deadlifts
Bowler Squats
Cossacks into Lunges
Strength Work
SSB Squats (5x5 working up to 3 repetition
maximums)
Trap Bar Deadlifts (5x10)
Single Leg Bridges or Barbell Hip Thrusts (3x10)
Front, Lateral and Reverse Lunges (3x10)
McGill Curls (3x20)
Super Mans (3x20)
Planks or Side Planks (3x1 Minute)
Stretching
Hamstrings
Calves
Quadriceps
Gluteals
Lower Back
Adductors
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Each week we rotated the sets and repetition
schemes for the SSB Squats and the Trap Bar
Deadlifts. During this phase, we would occasionally
need to change the volume and loads to reflect their
running training. During one week we switched
Bill Allars
to an upper body session as they were due to run
forty kilometres two days after our session and then
thirty kilometres the following day. Needless to say,
frying their legs during our session was not going to
be of much benefit to them during this time.
The strength exercises during this time was in the
region of 20% on their squat and deadlift numbers.
The increase in load for the barbell hip thrusts was
in the order of 50%. While this was excellent news
in terms of raw numbers, perhaps of greater impact
was their anecdotal feedback that they both felt
much stronger during their longer training runs and
felt much more powerful when running up hill and
across uneven terrain.
During this phase, exercise bands were added to
the mobility work wherever possible, particularly
during the front, side and rear leg raises. Regular
massages were also included in their overall training
program for recovery purposes.
Phase 2 – Taper – Weeks 15 & 16
This phase was focused primarily on keeping the
muscles free of knots and loose. The hard work had
already been done, the key here was on maintaining
the gains that had been made.
A standard workout during this phase was:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Warm Up
Foam Roller (10 rolls on each site)
Calves
Backs of Knees
Hamstrings
Glutes
Quadratus Lumborum
Lower Back
Quads
Adductors
Hip Flexors
IT Bands
Mobility Work (10 repetitions of each exercise)
10 Hip Crossover
Strength Training Program
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
133
10 Scorpions
10 Supine Scorpions
Front Leg Raises
Side Leg Raises
Rear Leg Raises
Fire Hydrants
Quadruped Thoracic Rotations
Hip Flexor Mobilisations
Single Leg Deadlifts
Bowler Squats
Cossacks into Lunges
Strength Work
Light KB Goblet Squats (3x15)
Bodyweight Single Leg Bridges
Bodyweight Front, Lateral and Reverse Lunges (3x10)
McGill Curls (3x20)
Super Mans (3x20)
Planks or Side Planks (3x1 Minute)
Stretching
Hamstrings
Calves
Quadriceps
Gluteals
Lower Back
Adductors
General Comments
Bill Allars
During all of the training phases, the client completed the mobility activities as part of their pre-run warm
ups to ensure their hips and glutes were activated before they started. They also completed bodyweight
circuits that included squats, lunges in all directions and single leg bridges and core week at least one other
day during the week (preferably two but with their running loads this was not always possible given that
they both also work full time).
Outcomes
The beer stein was gratefully accepted with my client finishing the 100kms in 15 hours, thirty minutes. A
thirty-minute margin for error, just what I like to see.
The most gratifying element of the whole experience for me was that both of my clients remained injury
free during the whole preparation period and both noted that they felt strong not only at the start of the
race but also at the end of it.
The next step for these two is to confirm the next item on their bucket lists (I believe it has to do with a race
up the stairs in an 80+ floor building) and start the process of developing a training program for this while
also getting them in “bikini” shape for the upcoming southern hemisphere summer.
Strength Training Program
134
Bill Allars
About the Author:
I am a personal trainer based in Frankston, Victoria. I have more than 30 years of training and nutrition experience that I can bring
to bear to help you achieve your health and fitness goals. I have trained for sports, to build strength, to build muscle and to improve
general health and fitness levels. I work with my clients to help them achieve the health and well-being that they deserve.
billallars@frankstonpaleo.com.au
Advanced Powerlifting
Training
Bryan Mann
Week 1
Monday
Sets
Reps
Intensity
Tuesday
Sets
Reps
Intensity
Thursday
Sets
Reps
Intensity
Saturday
Sets
Reps
Intensity
Low Box Squat
Leg Press
Pistol Squat
Hise Shrugs
Glute Ham Raise
Speed Press
JM Press
Tate Press
Lat Pull Downs
Bradford Press
Band Pull Aparts
Box Squat
Dimel Deadlifts
Walking Lunge
Pull Down Abs
Reverse Hypers
Floor Press
Piston Pushdowns
Chest Supported Row
Max Effort
4
4
3
6
8
6
6
6
3
3
8
3
3
6
6
Max Effort
3
6
1
8
10each leg
20
8
3
10
15
10
10
12
2
20
8each leg
10
10
1
1 minute
10
Max Effort
Heavy
Bodyweight
Moderate
Bodyweight
50%
Moderate
Moderate
Heavy
Moderate
Mini band
50%
Light
Moderate
Moderate
Moderate
Max Effort
Bands
Heavy
Advanced powerlifting Training
DB Row
DB Arnold Press
Hammer Curls
6
3
3
136
Bryan mann
10
10e
12
Moderate
Heavy
Moderate
Week 2
Monday
Sets
Reps
Intensity
Tuesday
Sets
Reps
Intensity
3
12
Mini band
Sets
Reps
Intensity
6
10
Moderate
Sets
Reps
Intensity
Band Resisted Deadlift
Hack Squat
Pistol Squat
DB Shrugs
Glute Ham Raise
Speed Press
Close Grip 4 board
Triceps Flare Outs
Seated Cable Row
Rev Grip Overhead
Press
Band Pull Aparts Palms
Up
Thursday
Box Squat
RDL
Reverse Walking Lunge
Pull Down Abs Stagger
Stance
Reverse Hypers Feet
Wide
Saturday
3 Board Press
Band Pushdown
Barbell Row
DB Row Elbows Out
Plate Raise
Hammer Curls
Max Effort
4
4
3
6
8
6
6
6
3
8
3
3
6
Max Effort
3
6
6
3
3
1
8
10each leg
20
8
3
3
15
10
10
2
10
8each leg
10
1
1 minute
10
10
10e
12
Max Effort
Heavy
Bodyweight
Moderate
Hands Behind Head
55%
Heavy
Moderate
Heavy
Moderate
55%
Moderate
Moderate
Moderate
Max Effort
Bands
Heavy
Moderate
Heavy
Moderate
Advanced powerlifting Training
137
Bryan mann
Week 3
Monday
Sets
Reps
Intensity
Tuesday
Sets
Reps
Intensity
Thursday
Sets
Reps
Intensity
6
10
Moderate
Sets
Reps
Intensity
Chain Squats
Front Squat
Pistol Squat-Elevated
Behind Back Shrugs
Glute Ham Raise
Speed Press
Barbell Extension
Rolling Extensions
V Bar Lat Pulldown
Seated DB Snatch
Band Pull Aparts to
angles
Box Squat
Pull Throughs
DB Step Ups
Pull Down Abs Stagger
Stance
Reverse Hypers
Saturday
Reverse Band Press
Piston Pushdowns
Reverse Grip BB Row
DB Row Elbows Out
Lateral Raise
Hammer Curls
Max Effort
4
4
3
6
8
6
6
6
3
3
8
3
3
6
Max Effort
3
6
6
3
3
1
8
10each leg
20
8
3
8
15
10
10
12
2
20
8each leg
10
1
1 minute
6
10
10e
12
Max Effort
Heavy
Bodyweight
Moderate
Band Resisted
60%
Heavy
Moderate
Heavy
Moderate
Mini band
60%
Moderate
Moderate
Moderate
Max Effort
Bands
Heavy
Moderate
Heavy
Moderate
Advanced powerlifting Training
138
Bryan mann
Week 4
Monday
Sets
Reps
Intensity
Tuesday
Sets
Reps
Intensity
Lat Pulldown
Seated DB Snatch
Face Pulls
6
3
3
10
10
12
Heavy
Moderate
Light
Thursday
Sets
Reps
Intensity
Saturday
Sets
Reps
Intensity
Reverse Band Squat
Overhead Squat
Pistol Squat-Elevated
Snatch Grip Shrugs
Glute Ham Raise
Speed Press
French Press
Box Squat
Pull Throughs
Reverse DB Step Ups
Pull Down Abs
Reverse Hypers Feet
Out
Shirted Bench Press
Piston Pushdowns
Reverse Grip BB Row
If you’ve still got gas in
the tank, you didn’t go
hard enough on bench
today
Max Effort
4
4
3
6
8
6
8
3
3
6
6
Max Effort
3
6
1
8
10each leg
20
8
3
10
2
20
8each leg
10
10
1
1 minute
6
Max Effort
Light
Bodyweight
Moderate
Plate Behind Head
50%
Moderate
50%
Moderate
Moderate
Moderate
Moderate
Max Effort
Bands
Heavy
Advanced powerlifting Training
139
Bryan mann
This workout is for a more advanced trainee. The exercises change weekly excluding the things that are
more foundational. Even then, things like GHR and Reverse Hyper will change in small variations of the
main lift. I like getting into the bench shirt about every 4th week or so, and usually follow this progression
of max effort lifts or some form of them. For the lower body- when I could still compete in squat, I found
that my reverse band squat with the strong band was pretty much what my geared squat would be. I never
really had to throw on gear to keep my squat in check, but would normally do so about every 6th to 8th week
just because. For me, the bench press was more crucial to get into the gear more often. It wasn’t so much
the strength, but the pressure in my head that I would have to get used to. While the reverse band squat
pretty much replicated everything on the squat for me save for the funky waddle up (who am I kidding, I
waddle everywhere), the pressure throughout my body was the same. For the bench press, if I didn’t get
enough work in the shirt it wasn’t the weight I couldn’t handle on meet day, it was the pressure in my head.
Mann received his degree in Health Promotion from Missouri State University in 2003, a Graduate Certificate
in Sports Management from Missouri State University in 2004, a Masters Degree in Health Education and
Promotion in 2006 and PhD in 2011. Mann is recognized as a Certified Strength and Conditioning Specialist
(CSCS) through the National Strength and Conditioning Association (NSCA) as well as Strength and
Conditioning Coach Certified (SCCC) from the Collegiate Strength and Conditioning Coaches Association.
Mann resides in the Columbia area with his wife Corinne Schoppet Mann.
Strongman Training
for Old Dudes
Mark Watts
T
his is a very basic program for strongman for the off-season with not a lot of volume. This program
utilizes Zatsiorsky three methods and provides about 10 days before an exercise is repeated. The four
basic lifts will be repeated three times every 4-week cycle. This is an outstanding program for anyone
need more recovery in between training sessions.
Week 1
Week 2
Week 3
Week 4
Day 1: Dynamic Effort
Bench Press
Deadlift
Military Press
Squat
Day 2: Max Effort
Squat
Bench Press
Deadlift
Military Press
Day 3: Repetive Effort
Military Press
Squat
Bench Press
Deadlift
Typical Set & Rep Scheme
Dynamic Effort: 5 doubles, 5 triples, or 10 singles
Maximum Effort: Work up to heavy double or triple
Repetitive Effort: 1x10-15
Exercise Pool & Rotation
Exercise
Squat
Bench Press
Deadlift
Military Press
Dynamic Effort
Box Squat w/ Bands or Chains
BP w/ Bands or Chains
DL w/ Bands or Chains
BTN Push Press
Maximum Effort
Front Squat
Fat Bar Bench Press
Trap Bar Deadlift
Fat Bar Military Press
Repetitive Effort
SS Yoke Bar Squat
DB Bench Press for Time
Conv. Deadlift
Log Clean & Press
141
Strongman Training for old dudes
Mark Watts
Typical Training Session
Dynamic Warm-Up
Main Lift
Supplemental Movement (sometime supersetted w/ main lift)
Accessory Movement (sometimes supersetted w/ supplemental lift)
Accessory Movements
Supplemental
Accessory
Exercise
Dynamic Effort
Seated Box Jumps
Glute-Ham Raise
Glute-Ham Raise
Single Leg RDL
Glute-Ham Bridge
Banded Leg Curl
Bench Press
Band Pull-Downs
Med Ball Throws
Neutral Grip Pull-Up
Band Face Pulls
Cable Pull-Down
Band Scarecrows
Deadlift
Single Leg Box Jumps
Reverse Hypers
Pallof Press
Single Leg Squat
Blast Strap Fall-Outs
Walking Lunge
Stability Ball Roll-outs
Military Press
Blast Strap Row
Plyo-Push-Ups
Meadows Row
Chain or Banded Push-ups
1 Arm DB Row
Feet elevated Push-Up
Squat
WEEK 1
Day 1
Maximum Effort
Repetitive Effort
Bench Press w/ Doubled Minis
Single Arm Band Pull-Downs Rotational Med ball Push Throws against Wall
5 triples w/ 30 sec. RI
3 sets of 5 w/ an X33 tempo
3 sets of 5 throws each direction
Buffalo Bar Hands Free Front Squat
Weighted Glute-Ham Raise
Single Leg DB RDL Work up to 3RM
Cluster Set of 3 w/ 60 sec. RI
DO set: -10%x5
3 sets of 5
3 sets of 8
Log Clean & Press
1 Arm DB Row
Feet Elevated Push-up
80% of 1RM for Max Reps in 75 sec.
70% of 1RM for Max Reps in 60 sec.
3 sets of 10
100 reps
Day 2
Day 3
WEEK 2
Strongman Training for old dudes
Day 1
Deadlift w/ Bands & Chains
Single Leg Box Jumps
Pallof Press
Day 2
Fat Bar Bench Press
Neutral Grip Pull-Up
Light Band Face Pulls
Day 3
142
Mark Watts
60% of 1RM for 10 singles
5 sets of 2 jumps each leg
3 sets of 10 reps
Work up to 3RM
Cluster Set of 3 w/ 60 sec. RI
DO set: -10%x5
Work up to 5RM
Same weight for 2 triples or 3 doubles
2 sets of 15
SS Yoke Bar Squat
Stability Ball Bridge & Curl
Seated Band curls
Work up to 5RM
Same weight for 2 triples or 3 doubles
3 sets of 10 reps
2 sets of 25 reps
Behind the Neck Push Press
Blast Strap Row
Plyo-Push-ups
Work up to 2RM
Drop 10% and perform 3 doubles
50 reps
10 sets of 3
WEEK 3
Day 1
Day 2
Trap Bar Deadlift
Prisoner Side Step-Up
Blast Strap Fall-outs
Day 3
Work up to 3RM
Cluster Set of 3 w/ 60 sec. RI
3 sets of 8
2 sets of 15
Stability Ball DB Bench Press
25% bodyweight for max reps in 60 sec.
Same weight for 45 sec
Same weight for 30 sec
Cable Pull-Down
4 sets of 12 reps
Mini Band Scarecrows
3 sets of 10 reps
WEEK 4
Day 1
Box Squat w/ Bands & Chains
Seated Box Jumps
Glute Ham-Raise
40% for 5 doubles
5 sets of 3
3 sets of 5
Strongman Training for old dudes
Day 2
Fat Bar Military Press
Meadows Row
Push-ups w/ Bands or Chains
Day 3
Conventional Deadlift Stability Ball Roll Outs
Walking Lunge
143
Mark Watts
Work up to 3RM
Cluster Set of 3 w/ 60 sec. RI
DO set: -10%x5
4 sets of 6 reps
Add Chain for every 3 reps OR…
Add band tension for every 10 reps
70-80% of 1RM for max reps in 60 sec
3 sets of 10
4 x 25yards
Mark Watts is the Director of Education at elitefts.com™ and the NSCA Ohio State Director. He is also an adjunct professor in the College
of Professional & Applied Studies at Urbana University. Watts has a master’s degree in exercise science and health promotion from
California University of Pennsylvania and a master’s degree in elementary education from Clarion University of Pennsylvania. Mark
has been working with college athletes in over 20 different sports at the Division I, II, and III levels for over 15 years as a strength and
conditioning coach. Prior to elitefts™, he coached athletes at Denison University, the United States Military Academy at West Point,
Allegheny College, and Clarion University. He has also completed strength and conditioning internships at the University of Tulsa
and Ohio State University. Mark is certified by the National Strength & Conditioning Association, USA Weightlifting, the National
Academy of Sports Medicine, and the Collegiate Strength & Conditioning Coaches Association. He started competing in powerlifting
in 1997 and is an amateur Strongman competitor in the master’s division. Mark is originally from Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania, and is
a USMC veteran.
Block Periodization
Program
Shane Church
T
his program came to me as I was writing programs for no one. I really liked it and thought I came up
with the next big thing. Boy was I wrong. Not only was this not “the next big thing” I’m pretty Moses
was doing Block Periodization when he was crossing the desert.
So, after having my dreams of being the Canadian Jim Wendler were dashed, I decided to research Block
and put it on paper the way I would want to do it.
This is what I came up with:
Block 1: Accumulation
Squat
3 sets of 6 @ 60% of goal
4 sets of 6 @ 60% of goal
5 sets of 6 @ 60% of goal
6 sets of 6 @ 60% of goal
The accessory work in this block will focus on building work capacity. For that I like to use low intensity,
high volume work done in a circuit.
An example of an upper body day would be;
• Overhead Swiss bar Extensions
• Swiss bar curls
• Swiss bar military press with a slow tempo
• Face pulls
• Push ups.
Rocking each exercise for 10-12 reps and doing this for as many sets as you are doing on your main lift.
Black Periodization Program
145
Shane Church
Block 2: Transmutation
Squat
Bench
Deadlift
CG Incline Bench
4 sets of 4 @ 70% of
goal
4 sets of 3 @ 75% of
goal
4 sets of 3 @ 80% of
goal
4 sets of 2 @ 85% of
goal
4 sets of 4 @ 70% of
goal
4 sets of 3 @ 75% of
goal
4 sets of 3 @ 80% of
goal
4 sets of 2 @ 85% of
goal
4 sets of 4 @ 70% of
goal
4 sets of 3 @ 75% of
goal
4 sets of 3 @ 80% of
goal
4 sets of 2 @ 85% of
goal
4 sets of 4 @ 70% of
goal
4 sets of 3 @ 75% of
goal
4 sets of 3 @ 80% of
goal
4 sets of 2 @ 85% of
goal
Your accessories here will look nothing like the actual movement. An Upper body day would have stuff
like vertical rows, DB flys and rope push downs in it. Focusing on the muscle and getting a sweet sweet
pump on.
Block 3: Realization
Squat
Bench
Deadlift
CG Incline Bench
6 sets of 1 @ 85% of
goal
4 sets of 1 @ 90% of
goal
3 sets of 1 @ 92.5% of
goal
2 sets of 1 @ 95% of
goal
6 sets of 1 @ 85% of
goal
4 sets of 1 @ 90% of
goal
3 sets of 1 @ 92.5% of
goal
2 sets of 1 @ 95% of
goal
6 sets of 1 @ 85% of
goal
4 sets of 1 @ 90% of
goal
3 sets of 1 @ 92.5% of
goal
2 sets of 1 @ 95% of
goal
6 sets of 1 @ 85% of
goal
4 sets of 1 @ 90% of
goal
3 sets of 1 @ 92.5% of
goal
2 sets of 1 @ 95% of
goal
\
The 12th week will also be your opener.
This is where the rubber meets the tracks. Higher intensity accessories like rack pulls and pin press are
done added to make sure the tonnage of your training days isn’t dropping to much with the less volume.
The most crucial part of this, and pretty much any program, is to be REALISTIC with your goals. A safe bet
that I tell people is to attempt no more than 10% of your previous best meet lift. And that number drops
the longer you have been lifting and stronger you are. I would never tell a 1000 lbs squatter to base it off of
getting an 1100 lbs squat in his next meet. That is unrealistic. Powerlifting is a sport of longevity. The longer
you compete the better it gets, the more friends you will make and the stronger you will become. Mentally
and physically.
Give this a try and for at least 12 blocks and let me know if you think I’m crazy or not!
Shane Church started competing in Strongman in Canada in 2007. With nothing to do in the winter, he started competing in
Powerlifting and never looked back. Shane currently trains in Ottawa, Ontario, Canada and has personal best lifts of 960 lbs squat,
615 lbs bench, and 705 deadlift, and a Canadian record total of 2245 lbs, all in the 242 lbs weight class.
Frederick “Fred”, 5
Columbus, OH
I WISH TO GO TO
THE FINAL SHUTTLE LAUNCH.
Astronaut Fred, this is Houston. Do you copy?
For 5-year-old Fred, rocket ships and astronauts
serve as a positive distraction from his tough
medical tests and procedures.
Fred suffers from diamond blackfan anemia, a
bone marrow disorder. Fred doesn’t let his condition
stop him because nothing could stop his heroes,
Neil Armstrong and Buzz Aldrin, either!
When volunteers asked Fred what his one true wish
would be, it was easy for this young boy to answer.
He wished to visit Kennedy Space Center –
specifically to see the final space shuttle launch.
“We had a fantastic time. Fred met all sorts of
astronauts and pilots and NASA employees. It’s
hard to describe how perfect this turned out,”
Fred’s parents, Joanne and Mark, shared in a note
to the Foundation.
The astronauts’ courage reminded Fred of his own
hope, strength and joy, and now he is ready to face
hope,
strength
and joy, and now he is ready to
his next
frontier!
Summer Football Training
Phase II and III
Ron McKeefery
Ron McKeefery
Eastern Michigan Football
Sports Performance
Summer
Phase II
Monday
Power Clean-BB
Front Squat
Russian Leans
Step Ups-BB-UL
Leg Curl-PB-UL
TKE
Swings-KB-BL
Hip Thrusts-BB-BL
Abduction-MR
Calf Raise
Neck Lat Flex-MR
Neck Flex-MR
Plate Holds
Core Tuesday
6 x (5,3,1)
3 x 6-8
3 x 6-8
2 x 8-10
2 x 8-10
1 x 10-12
1 x 10-12
1 x 10-12
1 x 10-12
1 x 10-12
2 x 12
1 x 12
1 x :60sec
200 reps
Bench Press
Row-BB-BL
Military Press-BB
Pullover-DB-BL
Dips
Pec Fly
Hyperextension
TPDs-CB-BL-SG
Bicep Curls-UB-StD
Rear Delt-DB-BL
Neck Lat Flex-MR
Neck Ext-MR Wrist Rolls Core Weight
6 x (5,3,1)
3 x 6-8.
3 x 6-8
2 x 8-10
2 x 8-10
1 x 10-12
1 x 10-12
1 x 10-12
1 x 10-12
1 x 10-12
2 x 12
1 x 12
Cycle
200 reps
Summer Football training
148
Ron McKeefery
Thursday
Friday
Snatch-BB-BL
6 x (5,3)
Bench Press-BB-#B 3 x 6-8
Pull Up-PG
3 x 6-8
Military Press-DB-BL2 x 8-10
Row-DB-UL
2 x 8-10
Pec Fly-CB
1 x 10-12
Good Mornings-BN 1 x 10-12
Tate Press-DB-BL
1 x 10-12
Bicep Curls-BB-PG 1 x 10-12
Shrugs-BB
1 x 10-12
Neck Lat Flex-MR 2 x 12
Neck Flex-MR
1 x 12
Finger Walks-SH
x1
Core 200 reps
Squat-BB
6 x (5,3,1)
Deadlift-BB-BL-PG 3 x 6-8
?
3 x 6-8
RDL-DB-BL
2 x 8-10
Lunge-BB-UL
2 x 8-10
Sled Drag-Reverse 1 x Set Distance
Pull Thru-BN-UL-SA 1 x 10-12
Hip Lift-UL
1 x 10-12
Adduction-MR
1 x 10-12
Dorsiflexion-MR
1 x 10-12
Neck Lat Flex-MR 2 x 12
Neck Ext-MR 1 x 12
Plate Flips 1 x 12
Core 200 reps
Day 2
Ron McKeefery
Eastern Michigan Football
Sports Performance
Summer
Phase III
Day 1
Clean and Jerk
Box Squats
Military-DB-UL-AT
TGU-DB-UL
Lunges-DB-UL-Rev
Leg Curl-MR-UL
Lat. Lunge-DB-UL
F/S/R-DB-BL
Core Plate Holds Neck Lat Flex-MR
Neck Flexion-MR
Weight
6-8 x 3-2
2 x 6-8
2 x 8-10
2 x 8-10
2 x 10-12
2 x 20yds
1 x 10-12
200 reps
1 x 60sec
2 x 12
1 x 12
Bench Press-BB-BL
High Pulls-BB-BL
RFE-DB-UL
Row-BB-BL
Hurdle Hops
Push Up-MB-AT
Rev Hyperextension
Dips
Core Wrist Rolls Neck Lat Flex-MR
Neck Ext-MR
6 x (5,3,1)
6-8 x 2-3
2 x 6-8
2 x 8-10
2 x 6ea
2 x 10-12
2 x 10-12
2 x 10-12
200 reps
x2
2 x 12
1 x 12
Day 3
Deadlift-TB-BL
Bench-BB-CH
Box Jumps-UL
RDL-BB-BL
Pull Ups-NG
TKE-BN-UL
Lower Leg
Bicep Curls-SB
Core Plate Flips Neck Lat Flex-MR
Neck Flex-MR-AT
6 x (5,3,1)
6-8 x 3-2
2 x 6ea.
2 x 8-10
2 x 8-10
2 x 10-12
2 x 10-12
2 x 10-12
200 reps
1 x 10-12
2 x 12
1 x 12
Build your Sumo
and Conventional Deadlifts
D
isclaimer: You should be proficient in both lifts
before you try this program. You don’t have to
be an expert in both lifts, but poor technique
in over an extended period of time is asking for longterm problems.
I think most lifters ask themselves at one point
or another, “Am I built to better pull sumo or
conventional?” Sumo is more technical and can be
considered more difficult to learn, but a deadlift is a
deadlift is a deadlift. Both pick the bar up from the
floor and lock it out at the top.
I was a decent conventional deadlifter when I first
started powerlifting. I pulled an ugly 700 at 200lbs
that wouldn’t have passed at a sanctioned meet. A
month later, in my “offseason,” I decided to give sumo
a try. I missed 600lbs and 550 was uglier than my
best conventional pull. This left me scratching my
head. At this time, I was fortunate enough to train at
Westside on the weekends, so naturally Louie threw
me in briefs and said just pull sumo for a while. I
did all my speed deadlifts with a sumo stance, still
ugly, but I was getting better. I went to a deadlift
meet only a few months later and pulled a smooth
700 conventionally. It doesn’t take much “figurin” to
understand that the sumo work was bringing up my
conventional pull.
So I took it a step further. I committed to pulling sumo
in training regularly (and heavier). I learned that I
could train my sumo from the floor relatively heavy
Casey William
just about every week, where my conventional pulls
from the floor would leave me burned out within a
matter of weeks. I had to take a step back to take
two steps forward, but it’s paying off. So I’ll show
you a condensed version of what I did (because my
journey into learning both was a two year process),
although it will likely need altering to fit your
individual weaknesses.
*I’m doing this as a conventional puller in competition. If you’re
a sumo dead lifter, you may want to consider switching the days
I have listed for each respectively. Or run the program once the
way it is written, and then switch it the next time through. Hell
that would leave you with 12 weeks to start a meet prep if you
did that. (52weeks – 20 – 20= 12 weeks, ain’t life grand?)
Notes:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Percentages are based on true competition max.
Rack pulls are done with the bar at the top of the
kneecap.
Block pulls are done with the plates sitting on 4”
blocks (or mats or stacked plates).
GHR’s can be replaced with ”poor man’s GHR’s” if
you don’t have one available (YouTube it if you’re
unsure of what I’m talking about).
Also any type of glute/hamstring exercise can be
substituted for Rev. Hypers if one is not available.
The main movement and first assistance are
the most important. The additional assistance
Build your sumo
150
exercises are to bring up weaknesses.
Block 1
Week 1
Sumo pulls 5x5 60%
Conventional rack pulls 4x6 80%
Stiff leg deficit deads 3x10
GHR 3x10
Week 2
Sumo pulls 4x4 65%
Conventional block pulls 4x6 70%
Snatch grip block pulls 3x10
GHR 3x10
Week 3
Conventional speed pulls (against bands or chains)
50-60% bar weight 8x1 30sec rest
Sumo block pulls 4x6 75%
GHR x 50 reps
Week 4
Conventional deadlifts 5x1 working up to 85%
Good mornings 3x8
RDLs 3x8
Shrugs x 50 reps
Block 2
Week 5
Sumo pulls 5x5 65%
Conventional rack pulls 4x6 85%
Stiff leg deficit deads 3x10
GHR 3x10
Casey williams
Sumo block pulls 4x6 80%
Rev. Hyper x 50reps
Week 8
Conventional deadlifts 5x1 working up to 90%
Good mornings 3x8
RDLs 3x8
Shrugs x 50 reps
Block 3
Week 9
Sumo pulls 5x5 70%
Conventional rack pulls 3x6 90%
Stiff leg deficit deads 3x10
Rev. Hyper 3x10
Week 10
Sumo pulls 4x4 75%
Conventional block pulls 3x6 80%
Snatch grip block pulls 3x10
Rev. Hyper 3x10
Week 11
Conventional speed pulls (against bands or chains)
50-60% bar weight 8x1 30sec rest
Sumo block pulls 4x3 85%
Rev. Hyper x 50reps
Week 12
Conventional deadlifts 5x1 working up to 90%
Good Mornings 3x8
RDLs 3x8
Shrugs x 50 reps
Week 6
Block 4
Week 13
Week 7
Week 14
Sumo pulls 4x4 70%
Conventional block pulls 3x6 75%
Snatch grip block pulls 3x10
GHR 3x10
Sumo pulls 5x5 70%
Conventional rack pulls 3x3 95%
Stiff leg deficit deads 3x10
GHR 3x10
Conventional speed pulls (against bands or chains) Sumo pulls 4x4 80%
Conventional block pulls 3x3 90%
50-60% bar weight 8x1 30sec rest
Build your sumo
151
Snatch grip block pulls 3x10
GHR 3x10
Week 15
Conventional speed pulls (against bands or chains)
50-60% bar weight 8x1 30sec rest
Sumo block pulls 3x3 90%
Rev. Hyper x 50reps
Week 16
Conventional deadlifts 5x1 working up to 95%
Good Mornings 3x8
RDLs 3x8
Shrugs x 50 reps
Block 5
Week 17
Sumo pulls 5x5 75%
Conventional rack pulls 5x2 100%
Stiff leg deficit deads 3x10
Rev. Hyper 3x10
Week 18
Sumo pulls 4x4 85%
Conventional block pulls 5x1-2 95%
Snatch grip block pulls 3x10
Rev. Hyper 3x10
Week 19- treat this as a deload week
Conventional speed pulls (against bands or chains)
50-60% bar weight 8x1 30sec rest
Sumo block pulls 5x1 80%
GHR 3x10
Week 20- Test
Conventional deadlifts 5x1 working up to a new max
Good Mornings 3x8
RDLs 3x8
Shrugs x 50 reps
Casey williams
Casey Williams works as a sales account manager in the oil
and gas industry in Pittsburgh, PA. He was exposed to some
powerlifting in high school as an offseason for football, but
it wasn’t until he finished his football career and degree at
Bucknell University that he committed to the sport. Since then he
hasn’t looked back. In 2012 at the IPA Nationals he broke the alltime world record drug tested raw squat and total in the 220′s
with a 700 squat and 1770 total. His best raw lifts to date are a
755 squat, 529 bench, and 727 deadlift with a 2011 total at 235
pounds.
Twelve-week Monkey
Bar Progression
Sheena Leedham
“I am going to fail with this next squat attempt. My chest will
cave, my knees will buckle.”
Lack of confidence, a bad past experience, repeated
failure, and social pressures give fear permission to
invade the playground, the classroom, the gym, and
Seconds before attempting the last set of squats, our home.
these thoughts flooded my lifting partner’s brain.
She whispered these exact words into my ear as As many ailments are soothed through early
I was tugging on the tapered tongue of her belt, detection, the key to sabotage a childhood fear is
helping her to secure the prong at it’s tightest fit.
through early intervention. Once identified, it’s
necessary to take specific steps to meet his or her
Despite my words of encouragement and plea to needs at the appropriate levels and slowly build
ban self-doubt, she needed the assistance of the side their body and mind through small successes.
spotters to lift the bar into the rack.
When is the last time you let your thoughts
undermine your ability to accomplish a task? It
seems at any age, fear can creep up on us and put
our best-intentioned efforts to a screeching halt.
Similarly, just the other day a client of mine refused
to use his left hand (his weaker of the two) to
complete single-arm rows. His exact words were,
“My left hand is weaker. I know I won’t get the same
amount of reps. What’s the point?”
Twenty years between the two, both had let fear
take over.
One prominent fear I’ve seen plague the playground
is fear of the monkey bars. Think about it…this
playground staple is set up for a child to use his
or her grip and back strength to move across
approximately 12 feet of steel bars, one hand at a
time.
Now imagine the child with special needs. He has
experienced failure over and over again, is frightened
of heights, and has a weak grip. Is it bizarre to think
this same child would want nothing to do with the
monkey bars, let alone other physical tasks that
require excessive effort?
In response to the decline of play and movement,
Working primarily with children with special needs, below is a 12-week exercise progression for the
I’ve seen fear dominate cognitive and physical ability. child with special needs whom specifically fears
Twelve-Week Monkey Bar
153
Sheena Leedham
the monkey bars. Teaching points you’ll find of both arms, their rotation, and have the child
helpful throughout are:
continuously open and close their hands and fingers.
•
•
•
•
•
Every week attention is given to the muscles and
motor patterns responsible for completing the
desired task
Similar exercises and activities mimic/replicate
the desired task
During the session, model each exercise before
the child is expected to complete a given task
Physical assistance and verbal cues are heavy
from the start and lessen as body awareness,
skill proficiency, and confidence increases
The environment changes eventually (if
applicable)
Play is the leading component
Verbal/Physical Cues: Use both hands, dig, right
hand has to find this one, left hand has to find this
one, find the quarter.
Set x Rep: 1 x 10 quarters are collected
Week 2: Shrek Seated Sled Pulls
How-To: Add two single-arm spud straps to a sled
using carabineers. Add weight to sled (something
they’ll be able to row for sets of 12-15. Add a stuffed
•
Shrek, or stuffed animal they like, to the stack of
Note: Each week’s progression may be extended as long as weight, securing the arm/head/leg/body of the
needed. For example, Week 2 may take a revisit for three weeks stuffed animal with Velcro. Facing the sled, each
before moving on to Week 3. Also, these exercises/steps are hand securing a spud strap, model how to extend
intended to play a part in a 30- to 60-minute training session.
arms, row arms simultaneously until sides of hands
make contact with lower abdomen (moving the
sled towards you), and stepping back to complete
A fear of self will sprout at some point—perhaps
another row.
facing the monkey bars or barbell. It’s sure to
happen at some point in time and just as one fear
dies another one will rise. The goal (and the goal of Benefit: Again we’re focusing on using each hand/
this 12-week progression) is to minimize Fear’s visit arm independently. Grip comes to play, as does the
and take the necessary steps to outsmart him, again use of the back and core.
and again. Enjoy!
Verbal/Physical Cues: Stand tall, belly full, squeeze
straps, pull steady, stretch lats, pull Shrek toward
you.
12-Week Monkey Bar Exercise Progression Set x Rep: 2 x 12-15 reps
Week 1: Sand Bin Money Find
Week 3: Seated Pull-down Machine
How-To: Fill a large plastic bin 3/4 full with sand. How-To: Using a straight bar attachment, grip the
Mix 10 quarters within the sand. The goal, using
both hands, is to find the 10 quarters. Emphasize
using both hands to dig through the sand. As they
are found, place quarters in a pile next to bin.
bar using a wide stance (hands outside of shoulder
width). Sit on seat and secure knees underneath
pad. Pull the bar down to top of head. Reverse bar,
shy of the starting position, for a big lat stretch.
Benefit: This fine motor work will engage the use Benefit: This exercise puts the child in a similar
monkey bar position, yet with the comfort of sitting
Twelve-Week Monkey Bar
154
in a fixed position. Grip comes to play, as does the
use of the back and core.
Verbal/Physical Cues:Set x Rep: 3 x 10
Week 4: Assisted Pull-up Machine
Sheena Leedham
to play, as does the use of the back and core.
Verbal/Physical Cues: Pull with your lats, elbows
down, pull, squeeze rope, belly full, smooth pulls,
one arm at a time.
How-To: With one knee on the pad and the other Set x Rep: 3 x Shrek to ceiling and back to ground
foot on the stand, use a medium grip (arms shoulder -Orwidth) to grip the pull-up bar. Once a firm grip is 3 x Sled pulls to feet
secured, place both knees on pad. Pull-up until chin
makes contact with bar. Adjust the weight so that he Week 6: Angry Bird Static Hangs
or she can get at least 10-12 reps.
How-To: Using a modified pull-up bar (the height
Benefit: This exercise puts the child in a similar of the bar can be reached as the child stands up on
monkey bar position. Comparable to the last exercise, their tip toes and extends their arms) the child will
the lower body is primarily in a fixed position, yet is grip the bar and hang (feet grazing the ground).
moving in sync with each pull up. Grip comes to play, Standing 3 feet away, you or another player will
as does the use of the back and core.
have a bin full of plush stuffed animals. Aim Angry
Birds (or another small plush stuffed animal) at the
Verbal/Physical Cues: Squeeze the bar, belly full, child’s stomach (mark an X using chalk on their shirt
and stress “do not hit the face”). The goal is to make
lightly touch chin to bar, pull, hang, stretch lats.
contact with the child by aiming for the X. Each
Angry Bird that makes contact earns the thrower a
Set x Rep: 2 x 10-12 reps
point.
Week 5: Shrek Rope Pull-down
Benefit: The bar is low enough that as the child
hangs and loses grip, he or she is a hair off the
How-To: In this video, you’ll see a rope pulley setup ground. This allows the child to get the feel of losing
with Shrek attached. This is an upright pull down.
With one arm at a time, pull the rope down until it
makes contact with chest. As the rope continues to
pull down, Shrek (and added weight) is raised to the
ceiling. Once Shrek reaches the ceiling, reverse the
pull down until Shrek is on the floor.
grip from the bar and landing on his or her feet. Grip
comes to play in a very direct way since the child
is statically holding, waiting as the other player gets
through all his stuffed animals.
No longer is the focus hanging and losing your grip,
but instead, if your friend is hitting the X. This is
really a fun game.
If this setup is not attainable, instead add a rope to
the sled (using a carabineer attachment or knot)
and pull the rope (one arm at a time) until the sled
Verbal/Physical Cues: Tight grip, aim for the X,
reaches your feet.
belly full, land on both feet.
Benefit: The pulley system changes the angle of
Set x Rep: 2 x 10 stuffed animals (players taking
the row previously done. Rather than one arm/lat
turns each round and regaining grip if grip is lost)
potentially compensating when pulling together,
each side of the body is forced to work. Grip comes
Twelve-Week Monkey Bar
155
Week 7: Playground Climbs to Slide
How-To: Moving from the gym to the playground,
today’s focus is to climb on the playground and slide.
At most playgrounds, there are multiple ways to
climb the structure to get to one slide (at multiple
heights). Find 5 different ways to climb up to the
slide (chained steps, ladder stairs, parallel bars,
climb up the slide, etc.)
Sheena Leedham
ground, the fear of heights is lessened or completely
out of mind. In future weeks, piggyback support
will take place when approaching the monkey bars.
Therefore, the Stop and Go game will provide a
positive experience to transition forward.
Verbal/Physical Cues: Hold on to me, squeeze
arms, squeeze legs, Stop, Go, Red, Green
Set x Rep: 2 x 1 (cone to cone)
Benefit: The focus at the playground is climbing Week 9: Stuffed Animal Monkey Bar 3-Second
and sliding. The constant climbing and variety Grab Carry
in equipment continues to build those muscles
responsible for monkey bar swings. Also, it’ll be How-To: Allow the child to choose a stuffed animal
beneficial for the child to associate the playground (or something related) to bring to the playground.
with something other than the monkey bars.
Explain that today the stuffed animal will be
completing the monkey bars with help. Holding
Verbal/Physical Cues: Climb, use your arms, the stuffed animal in hand, model how the stuffed
squeeze the bar, leg drive, slide down.
animal swings from one bar to the other with
assistance. Once both hands are on one bar, hold for
3 seconds, then repeat. Give attention to how you’re
Set x Rep: 5 x 1
close and helping and verbalize the stuffed animal’s
body position: tight, using lats, keeping grip strong,
Week 8: Piggy Back Ride Stop and Go
holding for 3 seconds, etc.
How-To: Mark a stretched distance with cones or
chalked lines. Have the child step up onto a sturdy
chair, a tire, or bench. Position yourself in front of the
child, facing away. Close to the child, cue him or her
to place both of their hands around your shoulders.
One leg at a time, cue him or her to wrap their legs
around your waist.
This game is similar to Red Light Green Light.
Starting at one end, have the child say “stop” and
“go.” When the child says “stop”, stop. When the child
says “go”, walk forward to reach the destination. For
variety, you can add players and race against them.
Instead of verbal cues, a player can be at the “finish”
line with red and green colored ribbons or paper.
Red signals stop and green signals go.
Benefit: This exercise provides a visual for the child.
He or she can hear and see your role in allowing
the entire process to be attainable and safe. This
exercise will also model expectations for the future.
Verbal/Physical Cues: Look at his/her form, I’m
close, I’m helping, lats are tight, belly full, one arm at
a time, 3-second hold, 1-2-3.
Set x Rep: 1 x length of monkey bars
Week 10: Monkey Bar Grab Carry
How-To: Assume piggyback position. Underneath
the monkey bars, the child will reach for each bar,
Benefit: Piggyback rides are often a go-to for one hand at a time. The goal is for the child to have
children because they place the child in a comfortable one hand around the shoulder and the other to
position in full contact with another. Although off the secure the bar in hand. Continue this until all bars
Twelve-Week Monkey Bar
156
have been secured.
Benefit: Up to this point, the child has had good
experiences in the piggyback position and is familiar
with watching the stuffed animal do this the week
prior. This exercise allows the child to complete
something familiar and he or she will get used to
how the bar feels in his or her hands.
Verbal/Physical Cues: I’m close, I’m helping, lats
are tight, belly full, one arm at a time.
Set x Rep: 1 x length of monkey bars
Week 11: Monkey Bar Setup with Static Hold
How-To: Model to the child how to climb up the
playground structure to get to the monkey bars.
Model how to stand on the edge of the platform and
reach for the bar. Grasp the bar with both hands.
Have the child try. As the child tries, stand before
him or her on the ground. Explain how you’ll secure
their legs once their holding tightly onto the bar.
Hold position for three seconds and bring the child
down to the ground to standing position.
Benefit: This setup provides expectations of how to
approach the monkey bars. Also, the support system
is slightly lessened because they are no longer in
piggyback position (chest and back are no longer
assisted).
Sheena Leedham
Have the child try. As the child tries, stand before
him or her on the ground. Explain how you’ll secure
their legs once their holding tightly onto the bar.
Securing their legs, the child will hold the hang
position for three seconds and then swing one arm
forward to reach and grab the next bar. Secure the
bar in hand. Do the same with the other hand. With
both hands securing the same bar, hold position for
three seconds. Explain how you will let go of their
feet after the 3-second hold and they are to then
land on the ground with both feet.
Benefit: The setup and your role will be familiar. He
or she will also be used to reaching for the bar with
one hand while having support. The 3-second hold
gives the child a pace to work with.
Similar to the Angry Bird game, in this exercise
they’ll resume the static hold position. As this drop
will be slightly farther than the modified bar, they’ll
be familiar with the cue of landing on both feet.
Because falling and getting hurt is one major area
of uncertainty for the child, we’ll be practicing
this aspect over and over. The message that’ll be
conveyed is that “you’ll eventually lose grip. Here’s
how to land on the ground and then try again.”
Verbal/Physical Cues: Stand tall, tight grip, belly
full, land on both feet, one arm at a time, 3-second
hold, 1-2-3, hold for three seconds, I’m here, I have
your legs, hang, let go of bar, land on both feet.
Verbal/Physical Cues: Stand tall, belly full, squeeze Set x Rep: 3 x 1 swing and drop
bar, hold for three seconds, 1-2-3, I’m here, I have
your legs.
Set x Rep: 5 x 1
Week 12: Monkey Bar Swing and Drop
How-To: Model to the child how to climb up the
playground structure to get to the monkey bars.
Model how to stand on the edge of the platform and
reach for the bar. Grasp the bar with both hands.
To further this progression, go from one complete
swing to a drop, to two complete swings to a drop.
Continue this progression until all bars are reached.
Moving forward, consider how you can continue
to lessen the amount of cues and support. Fear can
either be a limiting factor or, by overcoming it, a
method of building a lifetime’s worth of confidence.
Twelve-Week Monkey Bar
157
Sheena Leedham
Sheena is the Content Coordinator of elitefts™. She coordinates the article section on www.elitefts.com and the content that is posted
on the Strong(her)™ FB page. A graduate of Edinboro University of Pennsylvania, she holds a BS in Recreation Administration and
a Master’s of Education. Sheena competes as a figure athlete and trains as a powerlifter. She commits in sharing her voice and
shedding light on a wide array of topics with the intent for all elitefts™ readers to continue to stir their passions, never slacking in
the extraordinary resolve to be strong(er).
How to Come Back from a
Patellar Tendon Rupture
Thomas E. Deebel
M
Next step is nutrition. My nutrition was not optimal
immediately post surgery due to loss of appetite
and hospital food. At this point just try to get calories
of some type in. this will only be short term, so
don’t stress. When I was out of the hospital three
days after surgery I was finally off morphine which
helped the appetite issue. Percocett and warfarin
didn’t seem to affect it as much as morphine for
some reason. S I could now eat with some normality.
I concentrated mainly on good sources of protein.
Immediately after the accident I realized I ruptured When you’re on blood thinners you can’t eat dark
green vegetables such as kale, spinach, and brocoli
my tendon, so I made my way out of the office,
called my wife, and called an ambulance. I had a so I just ate what was allowed.
successful surgery just hours later and was now on
the long road to 500 lb squats and 600 lb deadlifts. As for supplements, I took liposomal vitamin C and
But first there’s a whole lot of stuff I’ve done, will do. vitamin d drops. 3-5 gs a day of the c for two
The first is mental attitude. If you suffer a serious weeks, then 1 g per day after and 20,000 Ius of D
per day which ws 10 drops. I added these to protein
injury, suck it up and deal. Accept your situation
and decide right there you will do what it takes to shakes mainly because the C was pretty harsh
get better. A positive mental attitude is what is going tasting. Yogurt would also help you mask the flavor
to get you out of that hospital bed and back in the of the c if you’re a yogurt fan.
gym.
Your going to need the help of many people from your Rehab is has been pretty simple. I consulted a few
doctor, to your therapists, to your family,spouse, and friends, Louie Simmons and Brian Bott and they
friends. Her’s a tip : don’t be a jerk. They are on your gave me great suggestions for exercises once I get
side, gratitude and appreciation for their efforts will my knee to 90 degrees. Mainly sled dragging front
go a long way into making your road to recovery and back, wheelbarrow walking , and box squats of
easier. No one likes pain and setbacks, but life is full various heights. This is down the road yet as I write
this article, but I plan to follow this in the future.
of them so be good to your people.
any of you have heard that I suffered a
pretty severe injury on 8/30/14. while
doing front squat supports with 482 lbs I
attempted to set down the weights on completion
of my first set but forgot to lock in the j hooks. I
went into a dead drop and ruptured my left patellar
tendon when I hit my safety chains. These chains
literally prevented a more serious injury or death in
this case.
How To come back from a
159
Four days post surgery I started PT which amounted
to some light bw leg exercises such as straight leg
assisted leg raising, foot flexing, extending, and how
to ambulate with my walker. This process went on
for app two weeks initially.
9 days post surgery I was fitted with a Bledsoe
brace which allows varying degrees of leg bending. I
started with 30 degrees and have added 10 degrees
every 5-6 days to the current 60 degeees I have
dialed in.
App. 25 days post surgery I received soft tissue
instruments which allowed me to finally work on
myself until I can get to physical therapy. This work
is similar to Graston and other techniques and fall
under what is called instrument assisted soft tissue
manipulation . I highly recommend this soft tissue
work for those who have need.
Two sessions had me at 75 degrees of bending which
is where I am at today. I’m hoping to be at ninety
degrees by this Friday at my next Doctor’s appt.
Once I hit ninety degrees of bending I can resume
normal leg and deadlift type of exercises, though
with drastically reduced weights.
When you are recvoerng from a surgery such as this
there is a key time frame of 4-6 weeks. This is
what it normally takes for your surgery to become
stable and when you can start challenging the area
with direct rehabilitative work. DO NOT RUSH THE
ORIGINAL TIME FRAME!
To much to quickly can cause damage and now
you’ve taken a case with a definitive recovery time
to maybe you never get back to old levels. But once
you’ve hit the 4-6 weeks and the doctor gives you
the go ahead, start moving forward.
I’m planning on a time frame of app 4-5 months of
specific increases to get back to my bests. I will
start very light concentrating on form and building
up my injured leg being careful not to exacerbate
any muscular imbalances. I’ve lost size around the
left quad insertion so it’s important o bring this up
slowly and evenly.
Thomas E. Deebel
I’m going to start with the SSB bar which weighs 82
lbs first and 135 on the deadlift done with tight
form. Any assitance exercises will be dialed down to
app 60 percent of my old numbers just to allow a
nice gradual progression as I regain my old strength.
Each month I’ll add in app 90 lbs which will give me
targets of 172, 262, 352, 442 on squats and 225,
315, 405, 495 on deads. Four months should have
me ready to meet train.
This is app 4-6 weeks from today’s date, which is
30 days post accident and surgery. This gives me a
possible meet June 2015.
I hope you can take some of these suggestions and
apply them to coming back from your injury. Be
patient, have faith, and do the work , and you will
get back on that platform safely ready to set some
new Prs. Good luck.
Thomas graduated from Penn State University in 1985 with
a B.S. in biology with a physiology concentration. In 1988,
he graduated from Palmer College of Chiropractic with a D.C.
degree. In 1998, Thomas achieved his first ART certification in
upper extremity work. Since then he’s achieved certification in all
course work through level three (biomechanics).Thomas worked
on the Ironman Triathlon treatment staff 6 times in 1998-2001,
Twelve-week Peaking
Template for Collegiate Throwers
Nate Harvey
T
his program is a template for the peaking
phase our throwers have utilized over the
past 8 years while producing numerous
conference champions, regional and national
qualifiers, All-Americans and one Olympic Trials
Finalist. This program IS NOT the reason for these
accomplishments, but rather a small piece of the
puzzle. The larger more important pieces are
our outstanding throws coach, the culture he has
created and the student athletes who train their
tails off to achieve these accolades. I will also admit,
much of this is stolen from West Side Barbell. Their
methods match up nicely with the sport of throwing.
I inherited this group of athletes from Paul Childress
when he left the university setting to go into private
sector. As you can see my job has not been hard in
this aspect, we’ve just continued to tweak things as
the years have gone by. We have made these tweeks
based on athlete’s feedback. You have to know
who your indicator kids are and use them to your
advantage.
Weightroom work is GPP (general physical
preparedness) training. We are trying to raise
maximal strength, explosive strength and lean
bodymass. We continually raise all of these all year
long using the conjugate method (maximal effort
method, dynamic method and repetition method).
We want to shoot cannon balls from tugboats NOT
canoes! That being said, we do prioritize the trait we
need most for competition as we approach our meet
(GPPSPP). We can do this by exercise sequencing,
loading parameters and volume. This may or may
not (depending on your school of thought) seem like
a lot of volume, but the athletes have slowly built up
to this workload over the school year.
Training days are:
Sunday: Max Effort Lower
Monday: Max Effort Upper
Wednesday: Dynamic Lower
Thursday: Dynamic Upper
This obviously is not the ideal rotation if we were
training lifters, but for our situation and competition
Our philosophy with this group has been simple keep schedule it is. The heavy/CNS intensive work is
them healthy and get them as strong as possible; done early in the week so the athletes are ready to
their sport coach will make them better throwers. compete on the weekend.
If the strength is there everything else will fall into
place. As any other issues arise we address them. Below is a TEMPLATE of a 12 week peaking plan.
We also make adjustments for the various events eg. You can adjust to fit your athletes, facilities and
Javelin throwers may do some different movements resources.
than Shot Putters.
PROGRAM GENERALITIES:
Twelve Week peaking tremplate
161
Nate harvey
-
3 week training blocks
Deload every 4th week if they feel like it. MANDATORY deload the week before final 3 week block
Increase volume on speed squat and speed pulls by increasing percentage each week, EXCEPT for the final 3 weeks of prep. Then we decrease volume as our meet approaches
Increase volume on accessory work weekly during each 3 week block
Speed bench volume stays constant during each 3 week block
ME LOWER- alternate between pulling and squatting movements each week. Also vary stances and bars
ME UPPER- alternate between full and partial movements. Vary the accommodating resistance too
Always vary accessory movements from week to week and never repeat an exercise with in the training week
All squats are done to a parallel box
Box Jump Variations include- seated box jump, wgtd box jump, seated wgtd box jump, seated footslam box jump…
Speed days are higher volume with less taxing movements, Max effort days are lower volume with more taxing movements
Soft tissue work/ rolling is done on major muscle groups to be trained as part of the warm up every day
If good mornings are done they are done immediately following the Max Effort Squat movement. Usually between 3x5-8. We typically do them with the same bar and accommodating resistance that the squat was performed with. These are usually moderately hard, we are not trying to kill anyone with these, just train the movement.
WEEK 12- 12 weeks out from meet
ME LOWER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Light Reverse Hyper
2x15
Box jump variation
3-4x5
Conventional Deadlift
Variatoin- 1RM
Rev. Hyper- 4x20
GHR – 3x8
Abs w/w -4x25
1 Arm DB Row- 3x8
ME UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
DB Bench – 10%
bench max for 60
total reps
Floor Press- 2rm
DB Bench – 3x8
DB Tricep- 3x10
Pull up variation- 3x8
Shrug variation- 3x15
Obliques- 4x25
Rear Delt or Scap
variation- 3x12
Biceps- 3x10
SPEED LOWER
SPEED UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Rev. Hyper- 2x20
Box jump variation3-4x5
Speed Squat vs chain8x2 @50%
Speed Pull- vs chain –
5x2@50%
Single leg Variation3x6-8
Rev Hyper- 4x20
Banded leg curl- 120
total
Abs with wgt- 4x25
Groiners- 80 total
Machine Row to stomach—4x12
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
Speed Bench vs chain
– 9x3@ 40%
Board Press variant3x5-8
Pulldown variation to
chest – 3x12-15
Shrug variation- 3x12
Triceps pushdown
variation – 3x12
Obliques -4x25
Rear delt or Scap variation- 3x12
Biceps- 3x12
Twelve Week peaking tremplate
162
Nate harvey
WEEK 11- 11 weeks out from meet
ME LOWER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Light Reverse Hyper
2x15
Box jump variation
3-4x5
Wide Stance Squat
Variation- 1RM
Rev. Hyper- 4x20
GHR – 4x8
Abs w/w -4x25
1 Arm DB Row- 4x8
ME UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
DB Bench – 10%
bench max for 60 total
reps
Rev Band Bench- 2rm
Inc. DB Bench – 3x8
Barbell Tricep- 4x10
Pull up variation- 4x8
Shrug variation- 3x15
Obliques- 4x25
Rear Delt or Scap variation- 3x12
Biceps- 3x10
SPEED LOWER
SPEED UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Rev. Hyper- 2x20
Box jump variation3-4x5
Speed Squat vs chain8x2 @55%
Speed Pull- vs chain –
5x2@55%
Single leg Variation3x6-8
Rev Hyper- 4x20
Banded leg curl- 140
total
Abs with wgt- 4x25
Groiners- 100 total
Machine Row to stomach—3x12
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
Speed Bench vs chain
– 9x3@ 40%
Board Press variation3x5-8
Pulldown variation to
chest – 4x12-15
Shrug variation- 3x12
Triceps pushdown
variation – 4x12
Obliques -4x25
Rear delt or Scap variation- 3x12
Biceps- 3x12
WEEK 10- 10 weeks out from meet
ME LOWER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Light Reverse Hyper
2x15
Box jump variation
3-4x5
Sumo Deadlift variation- 1RM
Rev. Hyper- 4x20
GHR – 4x8
Abs w/w -4x25
1 Arm DB Row- 5x8
ME UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
DB Bench – 10%
bench max for 60 total
reps
Bench vs bands- 2rm
DB Floor Press – 3x6
DB Tricep- 6x10
Pull up variation- 5x8
Shrug variation- 4x15
Obliques- 4x25
Rear Delt or Scap variation- 4x12
Biceps- 3x10
SPEED LOWER
SPEED UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Rev. Hyper- 2x20
Box jump variation3-4x5
Speed Squat vs chain8x2 @60%
Speed Pull- vs chain –
5x2@60%
Single leg Variation3x6-8
Rev Hyper- 4x20
Banded leg curl- 160
total
Abs with wgt- 4x25
Groiners- 120 total
Machine Row to stomach—4x12
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
Speed Bench vs chain
– 9x3@ 40%
Board Press variation3x5-8
Pulldown variation to
chest – 6x12-15
Shrug variation- 3x12
Triceps pushdown
variation – 6x12
Obliques -4x25
Rear delt or Scap variation- 3x12
Biceps- 3x12
Twelve Week peaking tremplate
163
Nate harvey
WEEK 9- DELOAD – Extra soft tissue and mobility work. Non-taxing accessories only
WEEK 8- 8 weeks out from meet
ME LOWER
ME UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Light Reverse Hyper
2x15
Box jump variation
3-4x5
Close Stance Squat
variation- 3RM
Rev. Hyper- 4x20
GHR – 4x8
Abs w/w -4x25
1 Arm DB Row- 5x8
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
DB Bench – 10%
bench max for 60 total
reps
2 Board Press- 2rm
DB Bench – 3x6
DB Tricep- 3x8
Pull up variation- 3x8
Shrug variation- 3x15
Obliques- 4x25
Rear Delt or Scap variation- 4x12
Biceps- 3x10
SPEED LOWER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
WEEK 7- 7 weeks out from meet
ME LOWER
ME UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Light Reverse Hyper
2x15
Box jump variation
3-4x5
Conventional deadlift
variation- 2RM
Rev. Hyper- 4x20
GHR – 4x8
Abs w/w -4x25
1 Arm DB Row- 5x8
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
DB Bench – 10%
bench max for 60 total
reps
Cambered bar to 1
board- 2rm
DB Floor Press – 3x6
DB Tricep- 4x8
Pull up variation- 4x8
Shrug variation- 3x15
Obliques- 4x25
Rear Delt or Scap variation- 4x12
Biceps- 3x10
WEEK 6- 6 weeks out from meet
Rev. Hyper- 2x20
Box jump variation3-4x5
Speed Squat vs bandsband tension=25% of
squat max at top 8x2
@40%
Speed Pull- vs bands –
5x2@40%
Single leg Variation3x6-8
Rev Hyper- 4x20
Ankle wgt leg curl120 total
Abs with wgt- 4x25
Groiners- 80 total
Machine Row to stomach—3x12
SPEED LOWER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Rev. Hyper- 2x20
Box jump variation3-4x5
Speed Squat vs bandsband tension=25% of
squat max at top 8x2
@45%
Speed Pull- vs bands –
5x2@45%
Single leg Variation3x6-8
Rev Hyper- 4x20
Ankle wgt leg curl140 total
Abs with wgt- 4x25
Groiners- 100 total
Machine Row to stomach—3x12
SPEED UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
Speed Bench vs
band(minis or ultra
minis) – 9x3@ 40%
PAIRED WITH Med
ball chest pass x3
Board Press variation3x5-8
Pulldown variation to
chest – 3x12-15
Shrug variation- 3x12
Triceps pushdown
variation – 3x12
Obliques -4x25
Rear delt or Scap variation- 3x12
Biceps- 3x12
SPEED UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
Speed Bench vs
band(minis or ultra
minis) – 9x3@ 40%
PAIRED WITH Med
ball chest pass x3
Board Press variation3x5-8
Pulldown variation to
chest – 4x12-15
Shrug variation- 3x12
Triceps pushdown
variation – 4x12
Obliques -4x25
Rear delt or Scap variation- 3x12
Biceps- 3x12
Twelve Week peaking tremplate
ME LOWER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Light Reverse Hyper
2x15
Box jump variation
3-4x5
Wide Stance Squat
Variation- 2RM
Rev. Hyper- 4x20
GHR – 5x8
Abs w/w -4x25
1 Arm DB Row- 5x8
ME UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
164
Shoulder warm up
DB Bench – 10%
bench max for 60 total
reps
Rev band vs chain
Bench- 2rm
Inc. DB Bench – 3x6
Barbell Tricep- 6x8
Pull up variation- 5x8
Shrug variation- 3x15
Obliques- 4x25
Rear Delt or Scap variation- 4x12
Biceps- 3x10
Nate harvey
SPEED LOWER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Rev. Hyper- 2x20
Box jump variation3-4x5
Speed Squat vs bandsband tension=25% of
squat max at top 8x2
@50%
Speed Pull- vs bands –
5x2@50%
Single leg Variation3x6-8
Rev Hyper- 4x20
Ankle wgt leg curl160 total
Abs with wgt- 4x25
Groiners- 120 total
Machine Row to stomach—6x12
SPEED UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
Speed Bench vs
band(minis or ultra
minis) – 9x3@ 40%
PAIRED WITH Med
ball chest pass x3
Board Press variation3x5-8
Pulldown variation to
chest – 6x12-15
Shrug variation- 3x12
Triceps pushdown
variation – 6x12
Obliques -4x25
Rear delt or Scap variation- 3x12
Biceps- 3x12
WEEK 5 – MANDATORY DELOAD - Extra soft tissue and mobility work. Extra naps and extra
food. Non-taxing accessories only.
THINGS THAT CHANGE DURING THE LAST 4 WEEKS OF PREPARATION
-
‘Max Effort’ work is only taken to a perceived 80% of their max. In other words work up to what feels like an 8 on a scale of 1-10.
Dynamic work volume starts high on the first week of this block then decreases weekly as you approach the meet. This allows for supercompensation.
The repetition work (repetition method) volume also decreases weekly.
The jumps typically are performed only with bodyweight during this phase. The object of this phase is speed, so you don’t want to slow your jumps down. Maximal strength supposedly lasts up to 30 days, but speed is only maintained for approximately 1 week if it is not stimulated. Also, speed/explosive strength is our priority during this phase so the program should reflect that.
WEEK 4- 4 weeks out from meet- this is THE hardest week of training they will have- VERY
Twelve Week peaking tremplate
165
Nate harvey
taxing
ME LOWER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Light Reverse Hyper
2x15
Box jump variation
3-4x5
Sumo dead variationonly up to a perceived
80% maximal efort
Rev. Hyper- 4x20
GHR – 5x8
Abs w/w -4x25
1 Arm DB Row- 5x8
ME UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
DB Bench – 10%
bench max for 60 total
reps
Floor press vs chain- 2
reps- only up to a perceived 80% maximal
efort
DB Bench – 3x6
Barbell Tricep- 6x8
Pull up variation- 5x8
Shrug variation- 3x15
Obliques- 4x25
Rear Delt or Scap variation- 4x12
Biceps- 3x10
SPEED LOWER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Rev. Hyper- 2x20
Box jump variation3-4x5
Speed Squat vs bandsband tension=one band
up from weeks 8-6 (if
they used average on
weeks8-6 they use strong
bands for this phase)
8x2 @40%
Speed Pull- vs bands –
5x2@40%
Single leg Variation3x6-8
Rev Hyper- 4x20
Banded leg curl- 160
total
Abs with wgt- 4x25
Groiners- 120 total
Machine Row to stomach—6x12
SPEED UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
Speed Bench vs
band(minis or ultra
minis). Also choke a
mini band in addition
to quaded band. This
kicks in at the top. More
band=more speed –
6x3@ 40% PAIRED
WITH Med ball chest
pass x3
Board Press variation3x5-8
Pulldown variation to
chest – 6x12-15
Shrug variation- 3x12
Triceps pushdown variation – 6x12
Obliques -4x25
Rear delt or Scap variation- 3x12
Biceps- 3x12
WEEK 3- 3 weeks out from meet- volume and intensity start tapering down in prep for the meet
ME LOWER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Light Reverse Hyper
2x15
Box jump variation
3-4x5
Close stance squat
variation- only up to a
perceived 80% maximal efort
Rev. Hyper- 4x20
GHR – 4x8
Abs w/w -4x25
1 Arm DB Row- 4x8
ME UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
DB Bench – 10%
bench max for 40 total
reps
10.
Incline Bench- 3 repsonly up to a perceived
80% maximal efort
DB Bench – 3x6
Barbell Tricep- 4x8
Pull up variation- 4x8
Shrug variation- 3x15
Obliques- 4x25
Rear Delt or Scap variation- 3x12
Biceps- 3x10
SPEED LOWER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Rev. Hyper- 2x20
Box jump variation3-4x5
Speed Squat vs bandsband tension=one band
up from weeks 8-6 (if
they used average on
weeks8-6 they use strong
bands for this phase)
8x2 @35%
Speed Pull- vs bands –
5x2@35%
Single leg Variation3x6-8
Rev Hyper- 4x20
Banded leg curl- 140
total
Abs with wgt- 4x25
Groiners- 100 total
Machine Row to stomach—5x12
SPEED UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
Speed Bench vs band
(minis or ultra minis).
Also choke a mini band
in addition to quaded
band. This kicks in at the
top. More band=more
speed – 6x3@ 35%
PAIRED WITH Med
ball chest pass x3
Board Press variation3x5-8
Pulldown variation to
chest – 4x12-15
Shrug variation- 3x12
Triceps pushdown variation – 4x12
Obliques -4x25
Rear delt or Scap variation- 3x12
Biceps- 3x12
WEEK 2- 2 weeks out from meet- volume and intensity continue to taper down in prep for the
meet
Twelve Week peaking tremplate
ME LOWER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Light Reverse Hyper
2x15
Box jump variation
3-4x5
Belt Squat- 3x5- moderate
Rev. Hyper- 4x20
GHR – 4x8
Abs w/w -4x25
1 Arm DB Row- 3x8
ME UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
166
Shoulder warm up
DB Bench – 10%
bench max for 40
total reps
11.
Bench out of foam
– 1rep- only up to a
perceived 80% maximal efort
DB Bench – 3x6
Barbell Tricep- 3x8
Pull up variation- 3x8
Shrug variation- 3x15
Obliques- 4x25
Rear Delt or Scap
variation- 3x12
Biceps- 3x10
Nate harvey
SPEED LOWER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Rev. Hyper- 2x20
Box jump variation3-4x5
Speed Squat vs bandsband tension=one
band up from weeks
8-6 (if they used average on weeks8-6 they
use strong bands for
this phase) 6x2 @30%
Speed Pull- vs bands –
3x2@35%
Single leg Variation3x6-8
Rev Hyper- 4x20
Banded leg curl- 120
total
Abs with wgt- 4x25
Groiners- 80 total
Machine Row to stomach—3x12
SPEED UPPER
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Shoulder warm up
Speed Bench vs band
(minis or ultra minis). Also choke a mini
band in addition to
quaded band. This
kicks in at the top.
More band=more
speed – 6x3@ 35%
PAIRED WITH Med
ball chest pass x3
Board Press variation3x5-8- LIGHT
Pulldown variation to
chest – 3x12-15
Shrug variation- 3x12
Triceps pushdown
variation – 3x12
Obliques -4x25
Rear delt or Scap variation- 3x12
Biceps- 3x12
WEEK 1- MEET WEEK- GO COMPETE!!!!
•
•
•
•
•
•
Harvey is entering his third year in the Sports Performance Program at the University at Buffalo. During this time he
has either assisted in or directed the training of each one of UB’s athletic teams at one time or another.
Harvey holds a Master’s Degree in Applied Physiology from the State University of New York at Buffalo. During his
time in graduate school at UB he also served as a volunteer assistant in the sports performance department.
Prior to his time at the University at Buffalo he spent time as a high school football coach, sports performance coach
in the private sector and a Fitness Director for Xerox Recreation Association in Rochester, NY.
Harvey’s undergraduate work was completed at SUNY Brockport in Exercise Physiology and Physical Education.
At Brockport he was a four year letter winner in football and eventual Usafootball.com All-American selection. He
completed his undergraduate work with an internship in the Buffalo Bills strength and conditioning department.
He has been training himself for twenty years and uses this ‘under the bar’ experience to help his athletes reach their
maximal potential. Recently, he earned his Elite Powerlifting status in August of 2009 in only his third competition
entered.
Harvey resides in Buffalo with his wife Hillary and two children Natalie and Rocco.
Levi, 13
Salem, OH
I WISH TO HAVE A CLUB HOUSE
Living the carefree life of a teenager is not easy for
13-year old Levi. For the past year, he has been
fighting a malignant brain tumor. His routine hospital
stays and treatments often prevent him from going
out and being with his friends. Through it all though,
Levi keep his head held high and continues to smile.
When Levi learned he qualified for a wish, he was
overjoyed with excitement! After careful
consideration, Levi wished to have his very own club
house! He wanted a place to kick back and relax
after a long day of school. Levi wanted a place just
to be a kid and hang out with his friends where they
could build LEGO projects or play video games.
In late October of 2012 Levi stepped off the bus from
school to find a very big surprise in his back yard; his
very own furnished club house! When he walked
inside, he was greeted by a pile of toys including
LEGO sets, a futon, and numerous Super Mario
Brothers posters and décor! His new hang out even
has a loft for him to relax in.
“I think it’s awesome!” said Levi. He’s looking forward
to creating memories with his friends and family that
Thank you for making wishes like
Levi’s come true.
will last a lifetime.
Upgraded Movement:
A Pre-Season Plan for the
Football Athlete
Brett Bartholomew
T
he following is a 3-week intermediate preseason movement progression for football
athletes age 18+. It provides a breakdown of
the following training components that are included
in each of the 3-days shown in the program.
•
Pillar-Preparation: Getting the system
ready to perform by addressing assymetries,
soft-tissue, and honing in on key issues regarding mobility or stability as needed by
whichever screen you utilize.
•
Movement Prep: “Preparing to play”
via addressing key stabilizers, increasing
core temperature, and addressing dynamic
flexibility, coordinative movement skills and
firing up the nervous system.
•
Plyometrics: Addressing and enhancing transfer of training through enhancing
the use of the stretch shortening cycle (SSC).
Plyometrics optimize power output via training and enhancing qualities that contribute
to force absorption and expression.
•
Movement Skills: Allow us to optimize
characteristics and transfer of acceleration,
speed, decal & COD under both controlled
and reactive conditions. Training these components broken down into the following categories:
o Skill acquisition: This is where we work
on the technical aspects of movement
where we develop/teach positions,
patterns and power. Activities such as
wall-drills which don’t directly transfer but do aid in the delivery of context when discussing angles of projection. Or bungee, leash or sled resisted drills which aid help the athletes
understand how to move with intent,
power and coordination.
o Skill application: This is where we work
on the tactical aspects of movement
where we now focus on transfer to
more advanced or chaotic drills that
build off of fundamental movements
learned during acquisition. Cone
drills, reactive agility drills, acceleration starts out of different positions
etc. are fit here and teach the athlete
how to react appropriately and re-position the body to move adequately
and effectively.
These sessions should take no longer than 2530 minutes and volumes for plyometrics are kept
relatively low to account for the increased amount
of time spent practicing/scrimmaging etc. If this
Upgraded Movement :A Preseason
169
Brett Bartholomew
was an off-season example, volume would be higher since “on the field” work is not a competing stressor
as it is during pre-season and in-season. If you wish to add volume week to week (which is not necessary
since movement skill mastery is the end goal), be mindful of doing so incrementally (10%) rule and NEVER
Remember to always be sure that you are cleared
increase both intensity and volume at the same time.
to participate in an athletic development program and be realistic about your limitations. Simple is NOT
synonymous with easy. It is always easier to fall into the trap of “more…more...more” but the best programs
are rooted in simplicity and you must understand that balance and more important REST is a weapon. For
movement descriptions or visuals, check out http://www.coreperformance.com/knowledge/movements/
Enjoy the process and get to work!
Brett Bartholomew is a performance specialist at Athletes’ Performance in Phoenix, where he works with elite college, high school
and youth athletes. Prior to joining AP, he was a volunteer football strength coach at the University of Nebraska-Lincoln and a
graduate assistant strength and conditioning coach at Southern Illinois University-Carbondale. While at SIU, he also served as an
assistant strength coach for football and basketball and as head strength coach for baseball, men’s and women’s tennis, men’s golf,
swimming & diving, the cheerleading squad and the dance team.
In-Season Squat Progression
for a Traveling Football Team
I
n-season training for the lower body has always
been a slippery slope - How much do you push the
intensity? How much volume? How many times a
week? What exercises? The list could go on forever.
To me, as I get more experienced and weathered in
this field I’ve tried to make my questions and my
goals more black and white so I can make our plan,
for our team, with our facilities, that we can coach.
Here are the questions I now ask myself --What are the team’s goals (head coach) for the
1.
In-season Program?
2.
What can we use from an equipment & time stand point to get what we need?
3.
How many sets of eyes will I have to monitor
the plan and make sure it is what we wanted –
not a rag tag version of it.
Here, at the University of Delaware I am lucky to
have a Head Football Coach who wants his player’s
to be a better version of the recruits he brought
in, not a different player than they were in high
school, and an administration that understands our
department needs to have equipment based on the
needs of our team and program. The answers to the
above questions are as follows
1.
Team Goal – Durability & Availability – we need to be training and practicing so we can get better during the season.
2.
Equipment & Time - Orthopedically the
equipment we will have our athletes use during the
Ted Perlak
stress of Football season, and still get a training
response – is the SS Yoke Bar (safety squat). Time
wise – we get 3 lifts a week, and we start our week
with the lower body lift. We train Tues (lower body,
Wed OR Thurs (upper body), and Sunday (single joint/
recovery). From a Strength & Conditioning standpoint
our Sunday lift ENDS the previous week, and Tuesday
BEGINS the next week – this allows for us to not be
massively effected by players being beat up from the
game the day before.
Number of Coaches - I need a minimum of 3
3.
coaches on the floor – we will have 3 travel groups with
no more than 25 guys, we use 8 of our racks, this will
allow us to monitor the room. Ideally we will have a
couple of interns, but they to me are a bonus.
The next part of the plan is what are my goals as
the Director of the Program? My main goal is to get
everyone training together, to be organized, and set
an efficient atmosphere where we can get in, get out,
and get what we need without wasting time. Time
is precious, and in-season time is paramount. We
accomplish this by using a clock for each set, and
keep the group together for the entire time they are
in the room – below is the set-up of our lower body
day.
In-Season Squat progression
172
Category
Ted parlek
Warm-up
Time
Soft Tissue Foam / PVC Roll Routine
5min
Dyanmic Floor Routine
3min
Correctives Glute Routine
2min
Hip Routine
2min
Movement Prep Stick Routine
2min
Total Warm-up Time 14min
Category
Strength Training
Sets x Reps Time
Total Body Power Kettle Bell Swings
4x:15-:20
5min
Lower Body Push Safety Bar Squat
3,3,4x3
12min
+ Terminal Knee Extension
Lower Body Pull Bar RDL
6x10e
4x5
Core + Sit-up Variation (weighted)
Upper Back Circuit Face Pull Variation
6min
4x10-15
4x10-15
+ Shrug Variation
4x10-15
+ Scap Variation
4x10-15
6min
Total Strength Training Time 29min
TOTAL TIME - 43-45MIN
From an evaluation standpoint, my goal for any in-season program is to have the travel team be within
90% of their 1rm at the end of the program. Just from a CNS standpoint intensities can shift 5% on how
you feel from day to day – without factoring in the stressor of a collision sport. If we can have our team hit
90%+ at the end of a 15 week season, we are in good shape to continue the progression and get better in
the off-season.
Our main evaluator during the off-season is the Front Squat – so we use our Front Squat Max as our Safety
Squat Max. Is this perfect – No. Is it a 100% correlation – probably not. But it is pretty close when we tried
it as a staff, so we ran with it. The one disclaimer is we load the Safety Bar (70lbs) as if it is a 45lb bar, this
makes it easier for all involved, and factors in the fact that our athletes may be a bit stronger (5-10%) on
the Safety Bar compared to the Front Squat.
The other thing we want to do is stress the speed of the movement in-season, not just linearly load the
bar and get slower as the season goes on. Our way of doing that is after week four of the program, we
introduce accommodating resistance for the non-skill players (OL, DL, TE, LB), and the use of a tendo unit
for the skill players (WR, DB, RB, QB, K).
With our non-skill players or “Bigs” we add 40lbs of chain weeks 5-8, then restart the periodization and
use 80lbs of chain for weeks 9-12. Week 13 we go back to straight weight, no accommodating resistance.
With our Skill players, after week 4, as we get competent with the intent of the movement we re-start the
periodization 2.5% higher for each cycle and use a tendo reading of 0.6 to gauge the speed of the bar – we
stay with straight weight for the Skill players, and add no chains – just a competitive component with the
tendo reading. We use a minimum Tendo reading of .6 on average velocity. This way the athletes need to
have the intent of moving the bar fast.
After set 2 of the “work sets” (4x3) we auto regulate the load by coaches discretion, with skill players you
need to stay within the tendo reading with big you just need to have the intent of speed and keep your
form.
Here is the graph of the loading for our “Big” group.
In-Season Squat progression
173
Ted parlek
Saftey Squat - Loading Periodization
w/ Accomadating Resistance - (OL, DL, TE, LB)
Opponent
% for Work sets
sets & reps
Accom. Resistance
week 1
72.5
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
None
week 2
75
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
None
week 3
77.5
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
None
week 4
80
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
None
week 5
72.5
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
40lbs of Chain
week 6
75
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
40lbs of Chain
week 7
77.5
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
40lbs of Chain
week 8
80
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
40lbs of Chain
week 9
72.5
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
80lbs of Chain
week 10
75
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
80lbs of Chain
week 11
77.5
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
80lbs of Chain
week 12
80
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
80lbs of Chain
week 13
85
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
None
Here is the graph for loading and tendo readings of the Skill group.
Saftey Squat - Loading Periodization
w/ Tendo Reading - (QB, RB, WR, DB, K)
% for Work sets
sets & reps
Tendo Reading
week 1
72.5
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
---
week 2
75
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
---
week 3
77.5
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
---
week 4
80
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
---
week 5
75
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
0.6
week 6
77.5
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
0.6
week 7
80
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
0.6
week 8
82.5
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
0.6
week 9
77.5
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
0.6
week 10
80
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
0.6
week 11
82.5
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
0.6
week 12
85
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
0.6
week 13
85
3, 3, 4x3 (work)
0.6
*Minimum Speed
With regards to the intensities we use – we try to be within the parameters of Prilepin’s table, and on the
low end of the volume.
In-Season Squat progression
174
Ted parlek
As you can see – not counting our two warm up sets of 3, we perform 4x3 (12 reps) with week 1 – 72.5% up
to 80-85% by week 13. This is under the “optimal” reps for those intensities, but my interpretation of the
chart is the low end of the chart is minimum amount of reps to create a training response, this is exactly
what we want in-season – what is the minimum we can do to create a training effect and not hinder the
performance of our athletes a practice an in the game.
To recap this “program” or “progression”…
1.
Goal of in-season Squat Progression is to be within 90% of pre-season max at the end of the season.
2.
Stress the speed of the movement throughout the training cycle
a.
Adding Chains for the “Big” athletes
b.
Assessing bar speed with the use of a Tendo for “Skill” athletes
3.
Use the low end of Prilepin’s table to illicit a strength response without overly fatiguing the athletes.
4.
Be sure the program is based on the Goals, Facility, and Staffing availability of your department.
The final thing I want to stress with this program is coaching technique. The volume, intensity, chains,
tendos, staffing, etc; means ABSOLUTELY NOTHING if you aren’t grinding out your athletes on their
technique. Squat to proper DEPTH, there is NO EXCUSE OR REASON NOT TO, if you can’t perform the squat
– get them on a different movement. My goal is to enforce and brain wash to our athletes that working hard
= great technique, and a 500lb squat without proper depth will not be rewarded, it will be broken down to
a 400lb squat with proper form.
I hope this helps some of you guys out, please feel free to email me with any questions – tperlak@udel.edu.
Get after your athletes, be organized, and COACH GREAT TECHNIQUE!!!!!
Perlak has been involved with the United States Olympic Training Center, serving as a strength and conditioning
resident intern from January until May of 2004. In that role he assisted the staff in developing and implementing
programs for Olympic, Olympic hopefuls, Pan-American, and Paralympic individual athletes and national teams.
A 2001 graduate of Worcester (Mass.) State College, Perlak was a four-year starter and two-time captain
with the football team before earning a bachelor’s degree in health science with a concentration in exercise
science. Currently Perlak, who spent the last 12 years as a strength & conditioning coach at the NCAA
Division I level, has been named head strength and conditioning coach at the University of Delaware,
Director of Athletics and Recreation Services.
The Nerd Off-Season
Program
Dan Fosselman
I
recommend this to all white collar workers and students whose goal is primarily to get stronger and increase
work capacity while having studious/white collar obligations. This program is a 12 week program designed
to push you mentally, spiritually, and physically. The reason I have you walk every morning on top of lift is if
you are sitting for 8+ hours a day you need more than an hour of lifting a day to stay healthy. Heads up, there
is a squat emphasis on this program. This program is a 12 week commitment. I recommend this for at least an
intermediate lifter who has a reasonably high work capacity aka you’re not a fat ass. I did this program during
my fourth year of medical school and it was a great stress relief for me. It was a challenge to complete and
the regimen took away thinking. I hope you enjoy the program. You will need a front squat max and a squat
training max.
Program principles
1.
Walk/bike every morning for 1 hour on treadmill while reading – first thing of day
2.
Journal every night- 1 thing you’re thankful for, write down to do for next day, one thing you
learned
3.
Read 1 article pertinent to your desired profession or your hobby
4.
Listen to NPR on commute to school/work, listen to educational podcast on way home or call
friend or family member
5.
Take 15 minutes per day to remove stimulus and pray/meditate/ clear your mind – lunch time is
ideal
6.
Follow the Anabolic diet aka eat clean (veggies and meat) Sunday-Thursday and eat whatever
on weekends
7.
Warm up consists of Joe DeFranco’s Agile 8, do 2x per day, every day
8.
If you have a significant other give them at least 30min a day of your undivided attention. If you
have children give 1hr a day to your wife and kids. Turn off your phone and all that shit.
9.
6 hours of sleep minimum, 7 is better, 8 is optimal
10.
Supplements: vitamin pack, fish oil, probiotic, plant based protein (if you religiously use milk derived protein ie whey or casein, ), creatine, melatonin 10mg minimum
11.
Work hard and bust ass
The Nerd off season Program
176
Dan Fosselman
Block 1
Day 1 (Monday)
Week 2
Week 3
Week 4 (deload)
Week 1
1.
Front squat (55,60,65,70,75%x5)(60,65,70,75,80%x3)(65x5,70x4,75x3, 80x2, 85x1+)(60%x3x3)
2.
Speed dead (sumo, convo) 50%x3,3x4 55%x2,2x5 60%x1,1x5 50%x3,3, 55%x2,2, 60%x1,1
3.
A. Serrano Split squat
8x3s
6x4s
3x4s
bw x 5x2s
B. Reverse Hyper
20x3s
20x4s
20x4s
10x2s
10x3s
10x4s
10x4s
10x2s
C. Glute ham
4.
100m x 4s
100mx5s
100mx6s
100m x 2s
A. Single arm farmers
B. KB Turkish Get up
3,3xr4s
4,4x5
5,5x6
3,3x2
Day 2 (Wednesday)
Week 1
Week 2
Week 3
Week 4 (deload)
1.
SSB Squat
10RM
8RM
5RM
10s walk out with 100%TM
2.
Hang clean
8s x 2r
8s x2r
8rx2s
4rx3s
5 week
3 week
5/3/1+
deload
3.
A. 5/3/1 Bench
B. Band pull apart
20r after each set
4.
DB incline bench
12r x 3s
14r x 3s
16r x3s
8rep x 2 s
12r x 3s
15r x3s
18rx 3s
10r x 2s
DB incline row
20r x 3s
20r x 3s
20rx3s
20r x 2 s
Face pull
5.
Push up
25r x 3s
30r x 3s
35rx3s
20r x 2s
Pull up
8r x 3s
8rx3s
8rx3s
5rx2s
Dip
15r x 3s
20rx3s
25rx3s
10r x 2s
Around the world
3,3x3s
3,3x3s
3,3x3s
3,3x2s
6.
Sprint
20m x 5
20m x 8
30m x 5
don’t sprint
Week 1
Week 2
Week 3
Week 4(deload)
Day 3 (Friday)
1.
Back squat
(TMx1, 60%x5x10s) (TMx1, 65%x4x10)(TMx1x2s, 70%x3x10) (60%x5x3)
2.
High hex bar dead
8RM
5RM
3RM
5r x 2s light
3.
12r x3s
15rx3s
18r x3s
8r x 3s
A. Lunge
B. Single leg RDL
12r x3s
15rx3s
18r x3s
8rx2s
20swingx4s 25r x4s
30rx4s
20sx2s
4.
A. KB swing
B. Goblet squat
10r x 4s
10rx4s
10rx 4s
10rx2s
1minx4
1minx2
C. Plank
1min x 4
1minx4
Day 4 (Saturday)
Week 1
Week 2
Week 3
Week 4(deload)
1.
DB Row
15r x 4s
18rx4s
20rx4s
10rx2s
10r x4s
12rx4s
15rx4s
10rx2s
Standing DB OHP
2.
Bench Speed (3 grip)
0.5TMx3x9s 0.55TMx3x9s 0.6TMx3x9s
0.5x3x5s
15rx9s
15rx9s
15rx9s
15rx5s
Face pull
3.
DB flat bench
15rx3
18rx3s
20rx3s
10rx2s
Lat pull down
10rx3s
10rx3s
10rx3s
10rx2s
10rx3s
10rx3s
10rx3s
10rx2s
T bar row
4.
Serrano press
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
YTW
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
Blast strap row
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
5.
Jog 1 mile
Block 2
Day 1 (Monday)
Week 5
Week 6
Week 7
Week 8 (deload)
1.
Front squat (60,68,75,83%x4)(65,73%x3 80,88%x2)(70x4,78x3,85x2,93x1+)(65%x3x3)
The Nerd off season Program
177
Dan Fosselman
2.
3.
Speed dead(sumo, convo) (53%x3,3x4)(58%x2,2x5)(63%x1,1x5)( 53x3,3, 57x2,2, 63%x1,1)
6x3s
5x4s
3x4s
bw x 5x2s
A. Quarter Full BSS
20x3s
20x4s
20x4s
10x2s
B. 45 degree hyper
C. Glute ham
13x3s
13x4s
13x4s
10x2s
4.
A. Double arm farmers
100m x 4s
100mx5s
100mx6s
100m x 2s
B. KB Turkish Get up
3,3xr4s
4,4x5
5,5x6
3,3x2
Day 2 (Wednesday)
Week 5
Week 6
Week 7
Week 8 (deload)
1.
8RM
5RM
3RM
10s walk out with 115%TM
SSB Squat
2.
Hang clean
8s x 3r
8s x 3r
8rx3s
4rx3s
3.
A. 5/3/1 Bench
5 week
3 week
5/3/1+
deload
B. Band pull apart
25r after each set
4.
DB OHP
12r x 3s
14r x 3s
16r x3s
8rep x 2 s
12r x 3s
15r x3s
18rx 3s
10r x 2s
TBar Row
20r x 3s
20r x 3s
20rx3s
20r x 2 s
Face pull
5.
Push up
30r x 3s
35r x 3s
40rx3s
20r x 2s
Pull up
9r x 3s
9rx3s
9rx3s
5rx2s
Dip
20r x 3s
25rx3s
30rx3s
10rx2s
3,3x3s
3,3x3s
3,3x3s
3,3x2s
Around the world
6.
Sprint
100m x 3
100m x4 100m x 5
don’t sprint
Day 3 (Friday)
Week 5
Week 6
Week 7
Week 8(deload)
1.
(TMx1x2, 65%x5x8s) (TMx1x3, 73%x3x8)(TMx2x2s, 80%x3x8) (60%x5x3)
Back squat
2.
5RM
3RM
5r x 2s light
Low handle hex bar dead 8RM
3.
12rx3s
8r x3s
8r x 3s bw
A. Lunge front foot elevated- 10r x3s
B. Single leg RDL
15r x3s
18rx3s
20r x3s
8rx2s
4.
A. KB swing
25swingx4s 30r x4s
35rx4s
20sx2s
10r x 4s
10rx4s
10rx 4s
10rx2s
B. Goblet squat
1.5min x4
1.5 minx2
C. Plank
1.5min x 4
1.5minx4
Day 4 (Saturday)
Week 5
Week 6
Week 7
Week 8(deload)
18r x 4s
20rx4s
22rx4s
10rx2s
1.
DB Row
Standing DB OHP
10r x4s
12rx4s
15rx4s
10rx2s
2.
Bench Speed Comp Grip 10x4s
12x4s
15x3s
10x2s
25rx4s
25rx4s
25rx4s
15rx3s
Face pull
3.
DB flat bench
15rx4
18rx4s
20rx4s
10rx2s
10rx4s
10rx4s
10rx4s
10rx2s
Lat pull down
T bar row
10rx4s
10rx4s
10rx4s
10rx2s
4.
Serrano press
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
YTW
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
Blast strap row
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
5.
Jog 1.5 mile
Block 3
Day 1 (Monday)
Week 9
Week 10
Week 11
Week 12 (deload)
(65,75,85%x3) (70,80,90%x2) (75x3,85x2,95x1+) (60%x3x3)
1.
Front squat
2.
Speed dead (sumo, convo)( 55%x3,3x4) (60%x2,2x5) (65%x1,1x5)( 50%x3,3, 55%x2,2,
60%x1,1)
The Nerd off season Program
3.
178
Dan Fosselman
A. Bulgarian Split squat
20x3s
20x4s
25x4s
bw x 10x2s
20x3s
20x4s
20x4s
10x2s
B. Reverse Hyper
15x3s
15x4s
15x4s
10x2s
C. Glute ham
4.
A. Single arm farmers
100m x 4s
100mx5s
100mx6s
100m x 2s
B. KB Turkish Get up
3,3xr4s
4,4x5
5,5x6
3,3x2
Day 2 (Wednesday)
Week 9
Week 10
Week 11
Week 12 (deload)
1.
5RM
3RM
2RM
10s walk out with SSB Squat
125%TM
2.
Hang clean
6s x 4r
6s x4r
6rx4s
6rx4s
3.
A. 5/3/1 Bench
5 week
3 week
5/3/1+
deload
B. Band pull apart
30r after each set
4.
DB incline bench
12r x 3s
14r x 3s
16r x3s
8rep x 2 s
12r x 3s
15r x3s
18rx 3s
10r x 2s
DB incline row
20r x 3s
20r x 3s
20rx3s
20r x 2 s
Face pull
5.
Push up
35r x 3s
40r x 3s
45rx3s
20r x 2s
Pull up
10r x 3s
10rx3s
10rx3s
5rx2s
Dip
25r x 3s
30rx3s
35rx3s
15r x 2s
3,3x3s
3,3x3s
3,3x3s
3,3x2s
Around the world
6.
Sprint
40m x 5
40m x6
40m x7
don’t sprint
Day 3 (Friday)
Week 9
Week 10
Week 11
Week 12(deload)
1.
(TMx2, 70%x5x5s) (TMx2x2, 77%x4x5)(TMx3, 85%x3x5) (70%x5x3)
Back squat
2.
5RM
3RM
2RM
5r x 2s light
Deadlift- Comp stance
3.
10r x3s
8rx3s
5r x3s
8r x3s bw
A. Lunge
B. Single leg RDL
20r x3s
20rx3s
20r x3s
10rx2s
4.
A. KB swing
30swingx4s
35r x4s
35rx4s
20sx2s
10r x 4s
10rx4s
10rx 4s
10rx2s
B. Goblet squat
2minx4
2minx2
C. Plank
2min x 4
2minx4
Day 4 (Saturday)
Week 9
Week 10
Week 11
Week 12(deload)
1.
A. DB Row
20r x 4s
22rx4s
25rx4s
10rx2s
10r x4s
12rx4s
15rx4s
B. Standing DB OHP
10rx2s
2.
A. Bench Speed (3 grip) 0.53TMx3x9s 0.58TMx3x9s 0.63TMx3x9s
0.5x3x5s
B. Face pull
15rx9s
15rx9s
15rx9s
15rx5s
20rx3
23rx3s
25rx3s
3.
A. DB flat bench
10rx2s
B. Lat pull down
15rx3s
15rx3s
15rx3s
10rx2s
15rx3s
15rx3s
15rx3s
C. T bar row
10rx2s
4.
A. Serrano press
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
B. YTW
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
10rx2s
C. Blast strap row
10rx2s
5.
Jog 2 mile
Week 13 test yourself. Congratulations, you finished the program. Just like after a test go drink a lot of low
quality beer and hang out with your boo or friends.
God bless, vigilance
The Nerd off season Program
179
Dan Fosselman
Dan Fosselman is a fourth year osteopathic medical student at LECOM. He played lacrosse at Denison University
where he has an NSCA All-American. He graduated with a BS in Biochemistry and Neuroscience while interning as
a strength & conditioning student coach for four years with Mark Watts. Dan is also a competitive raw powerlifter
and practices Brazilian Jiu Jitsu. He joined the United States Army Reserves to officially become Lieutenant Dan.
Contrarian Approach to Off-Season
Highland Games Training
Mark Valenti and Erin R. Stewart
Mark R. Valenti USAW club coach, CrossFit Level 1,
CrossFit Strongman instructor,
Former professional highland games athlete
Erin R. Stewart CrossFit Level 1, RN
BLIND DOG GYM AND CROSSFIT
CROSSFIT HIGHLANDER
A contrarian approach to off-season Highland
Games training.
body will lead to further throws in the long run.
The notion that you cannot train for strength and
conditioning at the same time is a myth , as we have
proved numerous times in our facility.
As with any training program , your best bet is
to count back twelve weeks from the date of the
competition you would like to be at your best for.
However, the in-season program still has a heavy
emphasis on mobility and athletic movements.
BLOCK 1 (initial phase) In this phase ,you will be
primarily focused in the gym and will do little to
no actually throwing of implements. Feel free to
ne of the main problems with the training use this time to work footwork drills and increase
of Highland games athletes is a lack of technical proficiency.
concentration on conditioning,mobility and
movements that will help a thrower stay in touch if Week 1:
not completely develop the athletic prowess needed
Monday
to successfully compete, at the highest level ,on the
heavy events circuit.
1. Warm up
2. 300 meter jog
The following program is an “outside the box”
3. 20 dislocates w/ pvc pipe
form of training for the throwing events in the
4. upward facing dog into downward facing dog
Scottish Highland Games.
The emphasis in
(10 per position w. 3 sec. hold)
the following twelve weeks is an increase in
5. 20 triple extension waist bends
strength ,mobility,conditioning and overall power
6. 20 overhead squats w. pvc
development. Normally mobility and conditioning
are the forgotten aspects of training for the strength
A. 12 mn EMOM
events, but the development of a conditioned mobile
every minute on the minute complete the following
O
Contrarian Approach to Off-season
181
Mark valenti and Erin R. Stewart
circuit @ 70% of clean and jerk max : deadlift, hi your max stone to shoulder)
B. 1000 meter row for time
pull, clean,hang clean, jerk
B. back squat work up to a heavy triple (do not miss)
C. 12 mn AMRAP
5 box jumps
50 jump ropes
20 KB swings
Tuesday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Warm up
Banded shoulder traction
Pec stretch against stationary object
20 push ups
bar roll outs for triceps
work on front rack positon stretching
A. Skill: hand stands against the wall. Practice
kicking up on the wall and holding a handstand,
5mn of practice. If this is an easy skill for you work
on trying to do hand stand push ups or even walking
on your hands.
B. strict press work up to a heavy 5 rep set then
work back down to warm up weight.
C. 5 rounds for time
2 tire flips (as heavy as possible)
10 pull ups
10 ring dips
Thursday
1. Warm up
2. 400 meter row
3. 20 roll into stretch(start in a seated position ,
tuck your knees to your chest and roll back then
roll forward and stretch between your legs)
4. bird dogs 10 on each side
5. 20 trunk twists
6. 20 air squats
7. biceps stretch
A. Max stone load to shoulder (take 15 mn,. To find
Friday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Warm up
75 calories on the Airdyne bike
band traction
20 push ups
20 triple extensions
20 air squat
calf and shin stretching
A. 4 rounds for time
10 thrusters w. 135
20 russian twists
1 400 meter sprint
Week 2
Monday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Warm up
150 jump ropes or 75 Double Unders
shoulder rolling
pec stretch
bar rolling for triceps
front rack stretching
A. push press (Max Effort –work up to a max single)
B. 7 mn. Amrap
20 double unders
20 pull ups
C. 7 mn Amrap
10 wall balls
20 push ups
Tuesday
1.
2.
3.
4.
Warm up
20 trunk twist
20 side bends
20 triple extenstions
Contrarian Approach to Off-season
182
Mark valenti and Erin R. Stewart
5. 20 air squat
3. 20 dislocates
4. 20 thrusters w. pvc
5. bar hangs x 1 mn
Odd min.Yoke walk 2x body weight x 50’
Even min: 15 GHD sit ups w. wall ball
A. “ FAT FRAN”
21-15-9
thrusters @ 75% of bodyweight or higher
pull ups
B. mobility work on whatever positions or muscle
groups that need work…spend 15-20 mn working
your mobility
A. deadlift off defecit work up to a heavy 3
B. 14 mn EMOM
Thursday
1. Warm up
2. 300 meter jog
3. 20 dislocates
4. biceps stretch
5. pec stretch
A. skill: Muscle up,,,working drills until you are able
to get a full MU. Pick any drill and work at it for 10
mn
B. 5 rounds for time
Bench press @ body weight or higher x 5
Row 100 meters
Friday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Warm up
Cat / cow yoga positions x10 per position
Bird dogx 10 on each side
20 Triple extensions
20 Dislocates
20 Over head squats w. PVC
A. 10 mn. EMOM perform this complex
Hang hi pull, hang hi pull, snatch, OHS @ 70% of max
snatch
B. snatch ( Max Effort)
WEEK 3
Tuesday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Warm up
Sampson stretch
20 mountain climbers
20 triple exttensions
20 air squat
A. Front squat work up to a heavy double but don’t
miss
B. 12 mn Amrap
5 box jump
15 burpees
25 KB swings
Thursday
Warm up
Pec stretch
Biceps stretch
20 push ups
20 dislocates
A. bench press (max effort)
Monday
B. 12 mn. EMOM close grip bench for speed @ 60%
of “A”
1. Warm up
2. 75 cal ride on Airdyne
1. Warm up
Friday
Contrarian Approach to Off-season
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
300 meter jog
Biceps stretch
20 air squat
20 triple extensions
roll into stretch
183
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Mark valenti and Erin R. Stewart
Warm up
20 Dislocates
20 Press technique w. pvc
20 Air squat
20 Push ups
Tricep roll outs
A. deadlift off mats (raise the plates off the ground A. 15 mn. AMRAP
about 4”) work to a max double
5x clean and press w. strong man log loaded to 80%
of body weight or as heavy as possible
B. 3 rounds for time
15 burpees
10 pull ups
10 hand stand push ups
6 stone to shoulder ( 3 to each shoulder) as heavy Thursday
as possible
300 meter sprint
1. Wup
2. 500 meter row
BLOCK 2 (transition phase) use this stage to 3. upward/downward facing dog x 10 in each
slowly incorporate throwing. Use range throwing
position
to try and create an effortless technique capable of 4. walking lunge
base line distances. You will still be hitting the gym 5. bear crawls
4 times per week during this phase.
6. 20 air squats
WEEK 4
Monday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Warm up
5 mn. Of double under jump rope practice
inch worm x 50’
walking lunge w. twist x 50’
20 air squat
A. snatch (Max effort) 10 mn. To find max
B. clean and jerk (Max Effort) 10 mn to find max
A. front squats (max effort)
B. 12x 40 meter sprints work up slowly start at 50%
speed and work up to max speed… spend 30 sec. to a
minute recovering between sprints
Friday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Warm up
Bar rolling for triceps
Pec stretch
Biceps stretch
Ring rows x 20
Triple extensions x 20
C. Back squat up to a heavy double (don’t miss) 10
A. “ fat” Elizabeth
min to find max
21-15-9
power cleans @ body weight
D. tabatta x 8 rounds GHD situ ups
ring dips
Tuesday
184
Contrarian Approach to Off-season
Mark valenti and Erin R. Stewart
WEEK 5
Thursday
Monday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Warm up
Cat/cow yoga positions
Banded hip stretch
Trunk twist x20
Side bends x 20
Air squat x20
A. 20 mn. EMOM
Odd minutes: 5 seated box jumps
Even minutes: 2 hang snatches w 75%of max or
AHAP
A. Deadlift (max effort)
Friday
Tuesday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Warmup
Dislocates
Biceps stretch
Pec stretch
Band traction
20 Push ups
A. skill: upside down work
hspu,walking on hands ,etc)
Warm up
20 Dislocates
20 Overhead squats w. pvc pipe
20 Triple extensions x
Walking lunge w. twist
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
A.
(hand
stands,
Warm up
Pec stretch
20 Band tear aparts
20 Push ups
Over head stretch
15 mn AMRAP
5 bench press @ bodyweight or AHAP
5 atlas stone to shoulder @ 75% of bodyweight or
heavier
10 ghd sit ups
B. “press party” warm up with strict presses, then
take 3 sets at a heavy singles in the press, increasing WEEK 6
the weight each time. Then complete 3 sets of 3
in the push press ,increasing the weight each time. Monday
Finally complete 3x5 in the jerk, increasing the
weight each time.
1. Warm up
2. 20 Dislocates
1. stict press
3. 20 Triple extenstions
2. 3x1
4. 20 Air squat
3. C. push press
5. Bar roll outs
4. 3x3
6. Front rack stretches
5. D. jerk
6. 3x5
A. clean and jerk (max effort)
C. tabata pull ups ( any grip) x 8 rounds
B. 1000 meter row
Tuesday
Contrarian Approach to Off-season
185
Warm up
Band traction
Overhead stretch
Pec stretch
Biceps stretch
20 Push ups
Mark valenti and Erin R. Stewart
BLOCK 3 (PREP PHASE) In this phase you will
start to incorporate more explosive jumping and
Olympic lifting. The conditioning phase ,while still
present, will start to taper slighlty. During this phase
you will start throwing more often and building on
the techniques established in phase 2.
A. 1 ¼ bench press work up to a heavy set of 5
B. dumbbell bench as many reps as possible in 2mn.
Dumbells should be challenging but still light enough
WEEK 7
that a solid 12-15 reps are possible when fresh
C. chin ups (palms facing supinated grip) tabata x
Monday
8 rounds
Thursday
1. Warm up
2. Jog 300 meters
3. Trunk twist x 20
4. Lungs x20 per leg
5. Triple extenstions x 20
6. Air squat x 20
7.
A. EMOM
Odd min. ride airdyne for max calories
Even min. 2 back squats @ 1.5% of bodyweight
Go until you burn 200 calories
Friday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Warm up
20 Dislocates
Pec stretch
Bar roll outs
Front rack stretches
A. military press : work up to a heavy set of 5 and
then work back down to warm up weight.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Warm up
Upward/downward facing dog
20 Dislocates
20 OHS w. pvc pipe
20 Triple extenstion
A. 10 mn EMOM (every min., on the min perform
the following complex) snatch,hang snatch,hang
snatch, overhead squat @ 70% of snatch max)
B. snatch (max effort)
C. Front squat : ten minutes to work up to a heavy
double
Tuesday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Warm up
20 Strict press w. pvc
20 Dislocates
Bar roll outs
Front rack stretch
A. push press (work up to a heavy triple)
B. 10 mn. Amrap
10 thrusters @ 135
B. bent over rows 10x10 work up as heavy as
10 box jumps
possible without breaking form
Contrarian Approach to Off-season
186
Thursday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Warm up
5 mn of DU or jump rope practice
20 trunk twists
20 triple extenstions
20 air squat
A. 16 mn. EMOM
Odd min: 3x front squat @ 80%of max or AHAP
Even min: 2x tire flip @ AHAP
B. 7 mn AMRAP
10 wall balls
10 burpees
Friday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Warm up
Pec stretch
Biceps stretch
Overhead stretch
20 push ups
A. bench press (max effort)
B. tabata x 8 rounds : hspu
ring dips
pull ups
WEEK 8
(goal test your crossfit total: back squat,military
press,deadlift)
Monday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Warm up
300 meter jog
20 OHS w. PVC
walking lunge w. twist
inch worms
Mark valenti and Erin R. Stewart
A. back squat (Max effort)
B. light 1000 meter row for quality not time
Tuesday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Warm up
20 dislocates
biceps stretch
bar roll outs
rack position stretching
A. Military press (max effort)
B. 1 mile easy jog
Thursday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Warm up
Biceps stretch
20 triple extensions
20xOHS w. pvc
pec stretching
A. 10 rounds for time
6 atlas stone to shoulder loads
200 meter row
Friday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Warm up
300 jog
cat/cow yoga positions
inch worms
walking toe touches
air squats
A. deadlift (max effort)
WEEK 9
Monday
Contrarian Approach to Off-season
1.
2.
3.
4.
187
Warm up
20 dislocates
band traction
20 push ups
A. 10 mn EMOM
Push press x 3 @ 80% of best push press or AHAP
B. 10 mn EMOM
Jerks x2 @ 80% of best jerk or AHAP
Tuesday
1. Warm up
2. 500 meter row
3. upward facing /downward facing dog yoga
positions
4. 20 air squat
5. 20 triple extensions
A. OHS (from rack) work up to a heavy
double
B. 3 rounds for time
10 OHS @ 80% of A
1 300 meter run
Thursday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Warm up
Overhead stretch
10 pull ups
20 dislocates
20 push ups
A. bench press (work up to a heavy triple)
B. tabata dumbbell incline bench press x 8 rounds
C. tabata strict pull ups (use a band if needed) x 8
rounds
D. tabata bent over rows x8 rounds
Mark valenti and Erin R. Stewart
Friday
1.
2.
3.
4.
Warm up
Sampson stretch
20 roll into stretch
20 air squat
A. front squat (work up to a heavy double)
B. 10 mn AMRAP
5 box jumps
20 russian twists
50 jump ropes
BLOCK 4 FINAL PHASE : In this phase the
conditioning will again drop off slightly (met cons
should be kept under 8 mn.) increase your throwing
workouts and the weight room workouts will drop to
3 times a week. Your focus has to be on the throwing
aspect as you prep for the start of the season.
Week 10
Monday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Warm up
Cat/cow yoga positions
20 triple extensions
20 air squat
20 dislocates
A. snatch (max effort)
B. snatch grip deadlift (work up to a heavy triple)
C. OHS (work up to a heavy 5)
Wednesday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Warm up
Overhead stretch
Bar roll outs
Dislocates
20 push ups
Contrarian Approach to Off-season
A. bench press (max effort)
B. 12 mn EMOM
odd min. 5 pull ups strict
Even min 10 sit ups on the GHD
Friday
Warm up
300 meter jog
banded hip stretch
20 air squats
20 triple extensions
A. cleans ( work up to a heavy double)
B. back squats (work up to a heavy double)
Week 11
Monday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Warm up
20 dislocates
20xpush ups
band traction
overhead stretch
A. military press (work up to a heavy triple)
B. 7 mn. AMRAP
10 push ups
10 pull ups
Wednesday
1.
2.
3.
4.
Warm up
50 calories on the airdyne
20 OHS w. PVC
20 triple extensions
A. deadlift (work up to a heavy triple)
B. 10 mn EMOM
Odd min: 8 box jump
Even min: 10 kb swings
188
Mark valenti and Erin R. Stewart
Friday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Warm up
Pec stretch
Plate mobility
20 push ups
10 pull ups
A. 18 mn. EMOM
Push press complex (2 push presses and 1 jerk @70%
of best push press)
Week 12
Monday
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Warm up
300 meter jog
cat/cow yoga positions
20 triple extensions
20 air squats
20 dislocates
A. hang snatch (work up to a heavy double)
B. hang clean (work up to a heavy double)
C. front squat (work up to a heavy triple)
Wednesday
1.
2.
3.
4.
Warm up
Pec stretch
Overhead stretch
20 push ups
A. bench press (work up to a heavy 5)
B. 8 sets of pull ups (as many as possible per set…
switch your grip every 2 sets)
Friday
1. Warm up
2. 1000 meter row
3. 20 air squats
Contrarian Approach to Off-season
189
4. 20 triple extensions
5. 20 roll into stretch
A. defecit deadlift ( work up to a heavy 5)
B. sumo deadlift w. plates elevated on 4” mats (work
up to a heavy single)
C. 8 mn EMOM speed deadlift @ 50%
Mark Valenti is a former professional Heavy Events athlete
and competed on the circuit for 22 years. He qualified for the
National Championshiips at Bethlehem Pa and Portland Oregon
on 5 occasions. Was one third of the World Team Champions in
2008 and won competitions in both the USA and Canada. He
has also won strongman and CrossFit competitions in the recent
past.
Mark is the co-owner , along with his wife Erin, of Blind Dog
Gym and CrossFit in Lorain,Ohio. He currently trains athletes
of all kinds ,including CrossFit athletes, Highland games and
strongman competitors .
Mark is currently a certified CrossFit L!, CrossFit Strongman,
USAW Club Coach and USATF Level 1 Coach.
You can obtain more info at blinddoggym.com or contact Mark
at blinddoggym@gmail.com
Mark valenti and Erin R. Stewart
The Tactical Preparedness
Workout
Chris Smith
F
or the law enforcement officer, there are plenty
of things that rank higher on the priorities list
than hitting the gym. Long hours at work and an
often unpredictable schedule can force even the most
dedicated lifter to skip out on training. Add to this a
diet rich in junk food, sleep deprivation, stress on top
of more stress, and you’ve got a formula that doesn’t
always quite add up to a string of PR’s.
All hope is not lost, however. It’s entirely possible
for an active law enforcement officer (LEO) to run
an effective and efficient training program – but there
are some factors that should be given consideration
if you want to make the most of your time in and
out of the gym. Law enforcement offers a number of
unique demands, as both a lifestyle and a training goal.
Therefore, an efficacious training program should look
at these issues and take them into account at risk of
producing substandard results.
Injury Prevention
Any program, regardless of target population, should
aim to avoid injuries. For the LEO, however, even a
minor injury has the potential to create a myriad of
bigger problems. As with any tactical population
mistakes and injuries can have deadly results. So,
with this in mind, the training program for an officer
should not only strive to avoid injuries, but to prevent
future injuries both in and out of the gym. Prehab and
structural balance, therefore, are just as important as
hitting a PR.
Time Management
When it comes to managing a busy schedule one of
the first things to get cut for a busy law enforcement
officer will probably be the gym. Free time is precious
and often reserved for family, and unfortunately that
sometimes means sacrificing training. This means that
a good training program needs to get the lifter in and
out of the gym in minimal time while still delivering
results – because that time in the gym better be worth it!
Another aspect of time management is a flexible
schedule. It’s not uncommon for an officer to be suddenly
called into work or have to give up a scheduled day
off. That can mean that officers don’t always have the
ability to adhere to a strict training schedule. Mondays
can’t always be bench day! An optimal training program
for a LEO should allow some flexibility in a training
schedule, while still leaving room for recovery.
Needs of the Job
Law enforcement can really be thought of as a hybrid
sport. Like a mixed martial artist, an officer needs to
be good at a lot of things in order to be the best. In any
given day, an officer may need to wrestle with a noncompliant criminal, sprint up ten flights of stairs, run
191
The Tactical preparedness workout
Chris Smith
a quarter mile, help lift someone who outweighs them by 200lbs, jump a fence or any other number of tasks all
while wearing about 40lbs of gear. If you look at the job like a sport it requires a balance of strength, power, speed
and conditioning. The big difference here is
that neglecting one attribute won’t result in a last place finish; it could result in injury or worse.
In addition to the multifaceted needs of the tactical athlete, there are other unique training demands that should
be given consideration. Grip strength is an often forgotten training element and is something that can have a
tremendous impact when it comes to confrontational situations for an officer. A firm grip not only sends a message
but it can also mean the difference between retaining control of a suspect or not. Training of the neck is another
frequently neglected area of training. As with any full-contact athlete a strong neck is vital to preventing injury
and should be given the appropriate attention.
The Program
Taking into consideration all of the elements above, this program consists of a brief, effective warm-up, strength
training and conditioning. The warm-up is designed to facilitate mobility and prevent injuries while preparing
for an effective training session. The strength-training portion is designed for even the most minimally equipped
gym while emphasizing development of strength and power. Lifting is divided into three days: lower body, upper
body pressing, upper body pulling. The reason for this split is to allow for maximum flexibility in scheduling. If
necessary you can train three days in a row with minimal interference between training days, or you can space the
days out however works best for you.
The conditioning element is broken into two phases. The first phase emphasizes development of aerobic capacity
while the second builds upon that and focuses more on the anaerobic systems. While there has been a strong
backlash against aerobic training in the past few years, it remains an important training element. A solid aerobic
base will help your strength training workouts by reducing the amount of rest you need between sets and will give
you a foundation to build upon with your anaerobic training. To top it off, many police agencies still require some
form of aerobic capacity event as part of their fitness requirements.
Warm Up
T-Spine Extension on Roller
Squat to Stand x 5
Kneeling hip flexor stretch
Pushups x 20
Band Pull-Apart x 20 (Replace with Dumbbell rear delt raise x 20 if no bands)
Strength Training Month 1
Day 1 Lower
Body
A. Clean
High Pull
from Hang
Week 1
Rest
Week 2
Week 3
Week 4
Sets x Reps
90 sec
3x6
4x4
4x6
3x3
The Tactical preparedness workout
B. Squat
C1. Fat Bar
Romanian
Deadlift
C2.
Bulgarian
Split Squat
D1. Barbell
Russian
Twist
D2. Neck
Flexion
D3. Neck
Extension
Day 2 Upper
Body Pressing
Day 3 Upper
Body Pulling
A. Weighted
Pull-Ups*
B. Barbell
Row with
Thick Grips
C1. Face Pull
Chris Smith
90 sec
3x8
4x6
4x8
3x5
30 sec
3x8
4x6
4 x 10
2x8
60 sec
3 x 20
4 x 15
4 x 20
2 x 15
30 sec
3 x 10
3 x 10
3 x 10
2 x 10
30 sec
3 x 10
3 x 15
3 x 15
2 x 10
30 sec
3 x 10
3 x 15
3 x 15
2 x 10
Week 1
Rest
A. Incline
Bench Press
B. 1 Arm
Standing
Dumbell
Push Press
C. Flat
Dumbbell
Bench with
Thick Grips
D1. Close
Grip Bench
with Pause
D2. Hanging
Leg Raises
192
Week 2
Week 3
Week 4
Sets x Reps
90 sec
3x8
4x6
4x8
3x5
60 sec
3x8
4x6
4x8
3x5
60 sec
3 x 10
4x8
4 x 12-15
2x8
30 sec
3 x 10
4x8
4 x 10-12
2 x 10
60 sec
3 x 15
3 x 15
3 x 15
2 x 15
Week 1
Rest
Week 2
Week 3
Week 4
Sets x Reps
90 sec
3x8
4x6
4x8
3x5
60 sec
3x8
4x8
4 x 10
2 x 10
30 sec
3 x 15
4 x 15
4 x 20
2 x 15
193
The Tactical preparedness workout
C2. Rear
Delt Raise
C3. Barbell
Curl
C4. Ab
Wheel
Rollout
Chris Smith
30 sec
3 x 12-15
4 x 12-15
4 x 20
2 x 15
30 sec
3 x 12-15
4 x 12-15
4 x 15
2 x 15
60 sec
3 x 10
4 x 10
4 x 10
2 x 10
*If you can’t do pull-ups with added weight do 4 sets of as many reps as possible instead
Strength Training Month 2
Day 1 Lower
Body
A. Snatch
High Pull
from Hang
B. Squat
C. Snatch
Grip
Romanian
Deadlift
D. Reverse
Lunge w/
Dumbells
E1. Half
Kneeling
Pallof Press
E2. Neck
Flexion
E3. Neck
Extension
Day 2 Upper
Body Pressing
A. Push
Press
B. Paused
Bench Press
Week 5
Rest
Week 6
Week 7
Week 8
Sets x Reps
90 sec
3x5
4x3
5x4
3x3
90 sec
3x5
4x3
5x5
3x5
60 sec
3 x 6-8
4x5
4x8
2x8
60 sec
3 x 10
4 x 10
4 x 15
2 x 10
30 sec
3 x 10
3 x 10
3 x 10
2 x 10
30 sec
3 x 10
3 x 15
3 x 15
2 x 10
30 sec
3 x 10
3 x 15
3 x 15
2 x 10
Week 5
Rest
Week 6
Week 7
Week 8
Sets x Reps
90 sec
3x5
4x3
5x4
3x3
90 sec
3x5
4x3
5x4
3x3
194
The Tactical preparedness workout
C. Incline
Dumbbell
Bench with
Fat Grips
D1. Skull
Crusher
D2. Situps
60 sec
3x8
4x8
4 x 10
2 x 10
30 sec
3 x 10-12
4 x 10-12
4 x 12-15
2 x 10
60 sec
3 x 1 minute
max reps
4 x 1 minute
max reps
4 x 1 minute
max reps
2 x 1 minute
max reps
Week 5
Week 6
Week 7
Week 8
Day 3 Upper
Rest
Body Pulling
A. Weighted
Pull-Ups*
B. Fat Grip
Dead Stop
Dumbbell
Row
C1. Face Pull
C2. Rear
Delt Raise
C3. Scott
Curl
C4. Ab
Wheel
Rollout
Chris Smith
Sets x Reps
90 sec
3x5
4x3
5x4
3x3
60 sec
3x8
4x8
4 x 10
2 x 10
30 sec
3 x 15
4 x 15
4 x 20
2 x 15
30 sec
3 x 12-15
4 x 12-15
4 x 20
2 x 15
30 sec
3 x 12-15
4 x 12-15
4 x 15
2 x 15
60 sec
3 x 10
4 x 10
4 x 10
2 x 10
*If you can’t do weighted pull-ups do the prescribed number of sets for max reps instead.
Conditioning
Weeks 1 – 4
Work
Day 1
Day 2
2 mile run
¼ mile intervals
20 minute slow run
¼ mile fast, ¼ mile slow x 4
Day 1
Rest
Reps
Work
Week 5
30 sec
sprint
120
sec
4
¼ mile
fast
Week 6
30 sec
sprint
120
sec
5
¼ mile
fast
Day 2
Rest
¼ mile
walk/slow
jog
¼ mile
walk/slow
jog
Day 3
Reps
Work
4
1 mile
fast run
5
1 mile
fast
Day 3
Rest
¼
mile
slow
¼
mile
slow
Reps
2
2
195
The Tactical preparedness workout
Week 7
Week 8
30 sec
sprint
120
sec
20 minute slow jog
6
Chris Smith
¼ mile
walk/slow
jog
20 minute slow jog
¼ mile
fast
6
1 mile
fast
¼
mile
slow
REST
2
Final Thoughts
There are a few final issues I’d like to address about the above program. The last set of the day on primary and
secondary lifts should be taken within 1-2 reps of failure, regardless of the prescribed rep range. This allows you
to gauge your progress and will give you and idea of your current strength level, while taking into account daily
fluctuations in strength. Don’t do this with auxiliary lifts such as neck work or rear delt movements. The benefits
don’t outweigh the risks there. Weeks 4 and 8 should be treated as a deload – do not push for max reps on those
weeks and cut back the weight about 10%.
This program is designed to increase tactical preparedness while allowing maximum flexibility in scheduling and
can be done in almost any gym. Ideally the strength training days would be performed with a day in between to
allow for recovery, but as stated above you can perform them back-to-back if necessary. Schedule the conditioning
however works best for you. You can do these workouts after your strength training, or on separate days.
Good luck, good lifting and stay safe.
About the Author
Chris Smith is a strength coach from New York City and the founder of Train Better Fitness. Chris has experience in a wide variety of
sports including track, martial arts, strongman and powerlifting. As a competitive powerlifter, he holds several world, national and
state records.
Chris specializes in integrating strength training and body composition techniques to help clients become stronger and fitter.
Through a dedication to education he has earned certifications from the American College of Sports Medicine and the National
Strength and Conditioning Association (strength and conditioning specialist). He also holds Bachelor’s and Master’s degrees from
St. John’s University.
To learn more about Chris, visit him on the web at www.TrainBetterFitness.com, on Facebook (Facebook.com/TrainBetterFitness)
or Twitter (Twitter.com/TrainBetterFit).
Six-week Weightlifter’s
Program
Hank McDonald
5DAY/ 6WEEK
WEIGHTLIFTING PROGRAM
(PERFECT YOUR TECHNIQUE, ROUND-OUT YOUR SQUAT, FILL-IN
YOUR WEIGHT CLASS)
By Hank McDonald
but allowing the reps to decrease (ex. Set 1:10 reps, set
2:8 reps, set 3:6 reps, set 4: 6 reps), since my main goal
is to complete all 30 reps, not a specific rep/set scheme
like 5x6 or 3x10. I also limited my rest time to around
60 seconds between sets.
University of Hawaii at Manoa
Need to know:
Thought Process:
wrote this program after just completing a competition
•
6-week/ 5 day program
and determining that it was time to move up a weight
class. However, I was a very light 94kg and so I
•
The Olympic lifts, (clean variants/ had the goal of adding on some mass, especially to my
snatch variants/ and split jerk) stay
lower body, while going back to some technical work
relatively light 60-75%, the emphasis
for the snatch and clean & jerk. It was an experiment
is technique!
but the program worked great for me so I figured I
would share it with you.
•
I have a 1RM for most variants of the
Olympic lifts (ex. hang power clean,
I decided to experiment with the squat by going
power snatch, etc.), however you do
3 days a week utilizing the safety squat, front squat,
not need to if you don’t already know.
and back squat, while also incorporating something
similar to escalating density training for the squats
•
Olympic lift variants move from high
and accessory movements. Using a variation of
position to low position through the
Prilipen’s table (for hypertrophy & strength), I had an
course of the week.
ideal amount of reps that I wanted to hit for certain
percentage ranges (ex. 70-80% an optimal amount of
•
You squat 3x a week: safety, front, reps would be 30 for my specified loads). For working
and back squat. 70-85%
sets I would always perform a max rep for my first set,
with and each following set continuing to push myself,
•
Squat is set up to move from safety
I
197
Six-Week Weightlifter's Program
Hank McDonald
squat low int./ high vol.- front squat mod int./mod vol.- •
•
•
•
•
back squat high int./ low vol.
Accessory movements that I have 1RM’s for I used percentages which coincide with the squat percentages. Some movements I do not have a 1RM, so I just experimented with the load.
Some accessory movements varied week-to-week depending on what I felt like doing…. sin
gle leg, and sometimes hamstring, just so I could have some variation and not get bored.
Rest intervals for squats and accessory movements are no more than 60 seconds.
The first set of any squat or accessory movement is a max rep set.
SAVE YOUR MONEY SO YOU CAN AFFORD TO BUY SOME NEW JEANS!!!! (I wish I did…)
D1 WK1
SETS/
REPS/%
D2 WK1
SETS/REPS/%
D3WK1
SETS/REPS/%
D4 WK1
SETS/REPS/%
D5 WK1
SETS/
REPS/%
HANG
POWER
SNATCH
6/3/60%
HANG
POWER
CLEAN
6/3/60%
POWER SNATCH
6/3/60%
POWER
CLEAN
6/3/60%
SNATCH
6/3/60%
SNATCH
PULL
6/3/70%
CLEAN
PULL
6/3/70%
SPLIT JERK
6/3/70%
SPLIT JERK
6/3/60%
CLEAN +
JERK
6/3/60%
SAFETY
SQUAT
32
TOTAL/70%
RDL
30 TOTAL/70%
FRONT SQUAT
28 TOTAL/
70%
GOOD
MORNING
30 TOTAL/
70%
BACK
SQUAT
24 TOTAL/
70%
MILITARY
PRESS
30 TOTAL
POWER
JERK
6/3/ 70%
BEHIND NECK
PRESS
30 TOTAL
SINGLE LEG
ACC.
30 TOTAL
EACH LEG
HAMSTRING
ACC.
30 TOTAL
GLUTE HAM
RAISE
30 TOTAL
SINGLE
LEG
ACC.
30 TOTAL
EACH LEG
HAMSTRING
SLIDES
30 TOTAL
D1 WK2
SETS/
REPS/%
D2 WK2
SETS/REPS/%
D3WK2
SETS/REPS/%
D4 WK2
SETS/REPS/%
D5 WK2
SETS/
REPS/%
HANG
POWER
SNATCH
6/3/65%
HANG
POWER
CLEAN
6/3/65%
POWER
SNATCH
6/3/65%
POWER
CLEAN
6/3/65%
SNATCH
6/3/65%
SNATCH
PULL
6/3/75%
CLEAN
PULL
6/3/75%
SPLIT JERK
6/3/75%
SPLIT JERK
6/3/65%
CLEAN +
JERK
6/3/65%
SAFETY
SQUAT
30
TOTAL/75%
RDL
30TOTAL/75%
FRONT SQUAT
24 TOTAL/
75%
GOOD
MORNING
24 TOTAL/
75%
BACK SQUAT
18 TOTAL/
75%
MILITARY
PRESS
30 TOTAL
POWER
JERK
6/3/ 75%
BEHIND NECK
PRESS
30 TOTAL
SINGLE LEG
ACC.
30 TOTAL
EACH LEG
HAMSTRING
ACC.
30 TOTAL
GLUTE HAM
RAISE
30 TOTAL
SINGLE
LEG
ACC.
30 TOTAL EACH
LEG
HAMSTRING
SLIDES
30 TOTAL
198
Six-Week Weightlifter's Program
Hank McDonald
D1 WK3
SETS/
REPS/%
D2 WK3
SETS/REPS/%
D3 WK3
SETS/REPS/%
D4 WK3
SETS/REPS/%
D5 WK3
SETS/
REPS/%
HANG
POWER
SNATCH
6/2/70%
HANG
POWER
CLEAN
6/2/70%
POWER
SNATCH
6/2/70%
POWER
CLEAN
6/2/70%
SNATCH
6/2/70%
SNATCH
PULL
6/2/80%
CLEAN
PULL
6/2/80%
SPLIT JERK
6/2/80%
SPLIT JERK
6/2/70%
CLEAN +
JERK
6/2/70%
SAFETY
SQUAT
25
TOTAL/80%
RDL
25TOTAL/80%
FRONT SQUAT
20 TOTAL/
80%
GOOD
MORNING
20 TOTAL/
80%
BACK SQUAT
15 TOTAL/
80%
MILITARY
PRESS
30 TOTAL
POWER
JERK
6/2/ 80%
BEHIND NECK
PRESS
30 TOTAL
SINGLE LEG
ACC.
30 TOTAL
EACH LEG
HAMSTRING
ACC.
30 TOTAL
GLUTE
HAM
RAISE
30 TOTAL
SINGLE
LEG
ACC.
30 TOTAL EACH
LEG
HAMSTRING
SLIDES
30 TOTAL
D1 WK4
SETS/REPS/%
D2 WK4
SETS/REPS/%
D3WK4
SETS/REPS/%
D4 WK4
SETS/REPS/%
D5 WK4
SETS/REPS/%
HANG
POWER
SNATCH
6/3/65%
HANG
POWER
CLEAN
6/3/65%
POWER
SNATCH
6/3/65%
POWER
CLEAN
6/3/65%
SNATCH
6/3/65%
SNATCH
PULL
6/3/75%
CLEAN
PULL
6/3/75%
SPLIT JERK
6/3/75%
SPLIT JERK
6/3/65%
CLEAN +
JERK
6/3/65%
SAFETY
SQUAT
30
TOTAL/75%
RDL
30TOTAL/75%
FRONT SQUAT
24 TOTAL/
75%
GOOD
MORNING
24 TOTAL/
75%
BACK SQUAT 18 TOTAL/
75%
MILITARY
PRESS
30 TOTAL
POWER
JERK
6/3/ 75%
BEHIND NECK
PRESS
30 TOTAL
SINGLE LEG
ACC.
30 TOTAL
EACH LEG
HAMSTRING
ACC.
GLUTE
HAM
RAISE
30 TOTAL
SINGLE
LEG
ACC.
30 TOTAL EACH
LEG
HAMSTRING
SLIDES
30 TOTAL
30 TOTAL
D1 WK5
SETS/REPS/%
D2 WK5
SETS/REPS/%
D3 WK5
SETS/REPS/%
D4 WK5
SETS/REPS/%
D5 WK5
SETS/REPS/%
HANG
POWER
SNATCH
6/2/70%
HANG
POWER
CLEAN
6/2/70%
POWER
SNATCH
6/2/70%
POWER
CLEAN
6/2/70%
SNATCH
6/2/70%
SNATCH
PULL
6/2/80%
CLEAN
PULL
6/2/80%
SPLIT JERK
6/2/80%
SPLIT JERK
6/2/70%
CLEAN +
JERK
6/2/70%
SAFETY
SQUAT
25 TOTAL/80%
RDL
25TOTAL/80%
FRONT
SQUAT
20 TOTAL/
80%
GOOD
MORNING
20 TOTAL/
80%
BACK SQUAT 15 TOTAL/
80%
MILITARY
PRESS
30 TOTAL
POWER
JERK
6/2/ 80%
BEHIND
NECK PRESS
30 TOTAL
SINGLE LEG
ACC.
30 TOTAL
EACH LEG
HAMSTRING
ACC.
30 TOTAL
199
Six-Week Weightlifter's Program
Hank McDonald
30 TOTAL
GLUTE
HAM
RAISE
30 TOTAL
SINGLE
LEG
ACC.
30 TOTAL EACH
LEG
HAMSTRING
SLIDES
D1 WK6
SETS/REPS/%
D2 WK6
SETS/REPS/%
D3 WK6
SETS/REPS/%
D4 WK6
SETS/REPS/%
D5 WK6
SETS/
REPS/%
HANG
POWER
SNATCH
6/2/75%
HANG
POWER
CLEAN
6/2/75%
POWER
SNATCH
6/2/75%
POWER
CLEAN
6/2/75%
SNATCH
6/2/75%
SNATCH
PULL
6/2/85%
CLEAN
PULL
6/2/85%
SPLIT JERK
6/2/85%
SPLIT JERK
6/2/75%
CLEAN +
JERK
6/2/75%
SAFETY
SQUAT
20 TOTAL/85%
RDL
20TOTAL/85%
FRONT
SQUAT
15 TOTAL/
85%
GOOD
MORNING
15 TOTAL/
85%
BACK
SQUAT
10TOTAL/
85%
MILITARY
PRESS
30 TOTAL
POWER
JERK
6/2/ 85%
BEHIND
NECK PRESS
30 TOTAL
SINGLE LEG
ACC.
30 TOTAL
EACH LEG
HAMSTRING
ACC.
30 TOTAL
GLUTE
HAM
RAISE
30 TOTAL
SINGLE
LEG
ACC.
30 TOTAL EACH
LEG
HAMSTRING
SLIDES
30 TOTAL
Bio: Hank Mc Donald is an Assistant Coordinator for Strength & Conditioning at the University of Hawaii at Manoa. He has been
involved with collegiate strength and conditioning and competitive weightlifting since 2010. He holds certifications through the
CSCCA, NSCA, and USAW, as well as an exercise science degree.
Powerlifting
Program
K
nowledge is powerful! With the renewed
popularity in raw lifting recently, gear lifting has
not been getting the publicity that it deserves.
The push for lifting raw has really made a valid surge,
with the help of social media, the limitless eBooks
and current popularity of certain fitness methods.
With the general population working out more now
than ever, a lot of people perceive that veteran lifters
have put away their gear and have made the switch
over to raw lifting. Some have, but with most of the
general population working out in local health/
fitness clubs, at home or at their local cross-fit “box”,
the exposure to geared lifting is not relevant where
most of the general population trains.
The EliteFTS Powerlifting Experience has given
an opportunity for lifter who may never of had an
opportunity to be exposed to geared lifting, to get
out of there normal training arenas, expose them
to a different training environment and let them
feel what lifting on a team is really like. I think
the process not only let the attendants attempt
gear lifting but also, gave them the experience of
lifting in a powerlifting meet. Without the EliteFTS
Powerlifting Experience many lifter would not seek
out or give geared lifting a try. It really presented a
great opportunity for raw lifters that may of never
had an opportunity to try lifting in gear or be
coached by a team of professionals, experience just
that. That’s what coaching is all about, the process.
It’s the process of the exposure to something new,
the educational opportunity associated with it and
the ability to pass on the experience.
Just like EliteFTS Powerlifting Experience, my
John Patrick
travels as a Collegiate Strength & Conditioning Coach
have landed me in some the greatest educational
opportunities I could possibly think of. Not only
have I had the opportunity to learn from some the
best strength coaches at the collegiate/professional
level, but also during every move I would seek
knowledge from the best lifters/teams in that area.
You have heard it a thousand times…. “You can be
book smart, but under the bar experience is vital.”
I found this quote to be very true. Every team I
lifted with was a new opportunity for me to listen
and grow in knowledge. Some of the training went
against what I was taught by my education or my
mentors, but it was all a new learning experience
that I could pass on to others.
Gear lifting is truly something you have to experience
to be able to coach. I have had some great teammates
along my way:
Scott Warman’s Pro Gym – El Paso, TX
The Refuge – Middletown, CT
North Georgia Barbell – Kennesaw, GA
Mariettia Barbell – Marietta, GA
Khaos Barbell – Athens, GA
Team JAX – Jacksonville, FL
Steel Dungeon Barbell – Yulee, FL
They all educated me on so different component of
geared lifting. Weather it was single ply or multi ply,
this federation or that federation or the differences
in programing you would use when training for a
geared meet. You have to be an open sponge and soak
in as much info as possible. Through exposure with
elite, intermediate and novice lifters, I have been
Powerlifting program
201
able educate myself on the skill of geared lifting.
There are no books or cover all aspects of geared
training. Geared lifting is a process of hearsay, of
attempts and misses and the instruction of those
who have had success in the sport.
There are many different training method, every
one trains different but all train for one reason, to
compete. Weather you are a elite, intermediate or
novice lifter, there is a common question that arises
as every time a meet comes close.
“How do I taper my training to effectively lift well at
the meet?”
The following program is an example of how a geared
lifter might want to approach 4 weeks out from a
meet. The workout will follow a basic systematic
approach and slowly decrease volume as the meet
comes closer. Each workout contains prehab and
will explain what gear is to be used for that workout.
Weeks 1-3 will include restoration workouts, which
will help aid in recovery between sessions. This is
not a one size fits all taper for all training level. This
is merely a skeleton template that I created through
my experiences. Enjoy!
WEEK 1 – REALIZATION BLOCK
WEEK 2 – ACCUMULATION BLOCK
WEEK 3 – INTENSIFICATION BLOCK
WEEK 4 – REALIZATION BLOCK
Bio:
Patrick handles the strength and conditioning duties for all 18
YSU athletic programs, working primarily with the football
program on a daily basis.
He is a National Strength and Conditioning Association certified
strength coach. Patrick is also certified by the International
Sports Science Association and the United States Weightlifting
Association. He is also a member of the Collegiate Strength and
Conditioning Coaches Association.
John patrick
M2 Deadlift Program
Brian Schwab
T
his is a modified off-season Deadlift Program based off of a combination of the M2 Method and the
equipped M2 Method with speed pulls incorporated every third week. It’s designed to increase raw
top end strength, to maintain equipped strength, and to allow for a deload on the third week while
helping to maintain or improve speed.
Chains or bands can be incorporated throughout the program if desired. To determine the bar weight, just
subtract the weight of the chains or band tension from the bar weight on the initial working set. For the
speed work, I recommend performing the first two sets with the recommended percentage, the second two
with one set of chains or bands added, and the last two with two sets of chains added or the same amount
of band tension as the second two sets. Try to maintain the same speed throughout.
Following the main exercise I recommend performing one warm up and two working sets of upper back
using a combination of pull downs or pull ups and a form of rowing motion as well as hamstring and
weighted abdominal work.
I hope this program gives you some variety in your training and helps to take your deadlift to new levels!
Thanks for reading and Never Give Up!
Week
Excercise
1
4 “ Raw block pulls (or rack pulls from just below the knee)
(percentages are based off a raw max)
2
3
2 “ Block Pulls Equipped Block pulls (or rack pulls from mid shin) w/
suit, straps down
(percentages are based off an equipped max)
Raw Speed pulls (6 sets of 2 while adding chains or bands)
(percentages are based off a raw max)
Percent
Reps
85.00%
87.50%
5
5
87.50%
3
90.00%
3
52.50%
2
M2 Deadlift Program
203
Brian Schwab
4
4 “ Raw block pulls (or rack pulls from just below the knee)
5
2 “ Equipped Block pulls (or rack pulls from mid shin) w/suit, straps
down
87.50%
90.00%
4
4
90.00%
2
92.50%
2
6
Raw Speed pulls (6 sets of 2 while adding chains or bands)
55.00%
2
7
4” Block pulls (or rack pulls from just below the knee)
90.00%
92.50%
3
3
8
2” Equipped Block pulls (or rack pulls from mid shin) w/straps down
92.50%
95.00%
1
1
9
Raw Speed pulls (6 sets of 2 while adding chains or bands)
57.50%
2
10
4 “ block pulls (or rack pulls from just below the knee)
92.50%
95.00%
2
2
11
2 “ Equipped Block pulls (or rack pulls from mid shin) w/straps up
92.50%
95.00%
1
1
12
Raw Speed pulls (6 sets of 2 while adding chains or bands)
60.00%
2
-Brian Schwab, BS, CSCS
Brian has a Bachelor of Science degree in Exercise and Sport Sciences from the University of Florida. He also holds many certifications
including his Certified Strength and Conditioning Specialist through the National Strength and Conditioning Association. He has
been Personal Training for over eleven years and strength training for more than nineteen years, the last twelve of which he has
been competitively Powerlifting.
PROGRAMS
THAT WORK
THE END
Download